‘ TRANSACTIONS OF THE ROYAL SOCIETY OF EDINBURGH. Vor. VII. Pigs ear EDINBURGH : PRINTED FOR ARCHIBALD CONSTABLE & CO. EDINBURGH, AND CADELL AND DAVIES, LONDON. 1815. CONTENTS: or VOLUME SEVENTH... ——————————————— (Part First.) LE Some Account of a Boy born Blind and Deaf, collected fron: authentic Sources of Information; with a few Remarks. and Comments. By Dugald Stewart, Esq; F. R. S. Edin.. - - \ Page 5: Il. On the Vertical Position and Convolutions of certain Strata, and their relation with Granite. By Sir James Hall, Baronet, Pr. R.S. Edin. & F. B.S. Lond.. - - = IIL Remarks on the Transition Rocks of Werner.. By Thomas Allan, Esq; F. R.S. Edin. ¥ IV. On the Revolutions of the Earth’s pr ciee Part I. By Sir James Hall, Bart. V. On the Revolutions of the Earth's Swnfalee. Part II. By Sir James Hall, Bart. = VI. An Account of some Geological Facis observed in the Faroe Islands. By Sir George Mackenzie; Baronet, Pr. Ph. Cl. R. S. Edin. - VIL. An Account of the Mineralogy of the Faroe Islands. By Thomas Allan, Esq; F. R. 8. Edin. - 79: 109: 139: 169 213. 229 PART vi CONTENTS. (Part Seconp.) WILL. Account of the Structure of the Table Mountain, and other Parts of the Peninsula of the Cape. Dawn up by Pro- fessor Playfair, /rom Observations made by Captain Basil Hall, R.N. F. R. S. Edin. Ey, Page 269 IX. Comparison of the North Polar Dist.nces of Thir- ty-eight Principal Fixed Stars, on the \st of Ja- nuary 1800, as determined by Observations made at Greenwich, Armagh, Palermo, Westbury, Dub- lin, and Blackheath. By S. Groombridge, Esq. Blackheath, F. R.S. Lond. Communicated by Dr Brewster, ~ - X. On the Optical Properties of Sulphate of Girhon; Carbonate of Barytes, and Nitrate of Potash, with Inferences respecting the Structure of Doubly Re- fracting Crystals. By David Brewster, LL. D. F. R.S. Edin. & F..A.S. E. - XI. An Account of Observations made by Lord Webb Seymour and Professor Play air, upon some Geo- logical Appearances in Glen Tilt, and the adja- cent Country. Drawn up by Lord Webb Sey- mour, - 2 B XII. On certain Appearances observed in the Dissection of the Eyes of Fishes. By James L. Drummond, M. D. of Belfast. Communicated by Dr Thomas Brown, Professor of Moral Philosophy in the Uni- versity of Edinburgh, - ~ XIII. Observations on the Theory of Language. By Henry Dewar, M. D. Fellow of the Royal College of Physicians of Edinburgh, - - KIV. ‘On the Diffusion of Heat at the Surface of the Earth. By John Murray, M.D. F. B.S. Edin. 279 285 303 377 387 411 XV. On CONTENTS. XV. On a New Species of Coloured Fringes, produced by the Reflection of Light between Two Plates of parallel Glass of equal thickness. By David Brewster, LL. D. F. R. S. Edin. & F. A. S. E. XVI. An Analysis of the Mineral Waters of Cromiia, near Dunblane, and of Pitcaithly ; with general Observations on the Analysis of Mineral Waters, and the Composition of Bath Water and some others. By John Murray, M. D. F. R.S. Edin. - XVII. Biographical Account of the late John Robison, — LL. D. F. B.S. Edin. and Professor of Natural Philosophy in the University of Edinburgh. By John Playfair, F.R.S. L. & E. &e. -Aprenprx, containing Lists of the Office-bearers and Members elected since November 1812, “ vii 435 445 495 541 _ DIRECTIONS vo rue Binper. Plate I. II. II]. IV. V. to front page 108. —— VI. VII. VIII. IX. to front page 212. — X. XI. (marked on the engraving Geology of Faroe, Plate I. & II.) to front page 220. XII. Map of Faroe, to front page 229. XIII. Sketch of Peninsula of the Cape, to front page 270. a } Granite Veins, to front page 278. XVE. XVII. XVIII. XIX. XX. p64) ——— XXII, after page 444. after page 368. ja tatel klsletal SOME ACCOUNT BOY BORN BLIND AND DEAF, _ COLLECTED FROM AUTHENTIC SOURCES OF INFORMATION 3 WITH A FEW REMARKS AND COMMENTS. HE Memoir which I am about to submit to the conside- ration of the Royal Society, relates to the melancholy history of a boy who was born blind and deaf; and who, of consequence, has derived all his knowledge of things external from the senses of Touch, of Taste, and of Smell *. It is now considerably more than a year since I first heard of this case from my very ingenious friend Mr Warprop, Surgeon in London ; a gentleman whose scientific attainments and pro- fessional skill it is unnecessary for me to mention to this audi- ence. * Since this paper was read before the Society, I have been enabled, by sub- sequent communications, to enlarge it considerably. I have still reason to expect farther information on the subject; but various circumstances make it desi- rable, that so curious an article of philosophical intelligence should not be any longer withheld from the public. Vou. VII. A 3 ACCOUNT OF A BOY nece. The information which he then communicated to me was extremely general ; but more than sufficient to excite all my curiosity. “Ihave at present (says he) a patient under my care, whose case is, I believe, unique. It is a boy fourteen years old, who was born blind and deaf, and of course dumb. His senses of touch and smell have a wonderful degree of acuteness ; for by these alone he has acquired a very accurate knowledge of external things, and is able to know readily his old acquaintances from strangers. The powers of his mind are vigorous. He is evidently capable of reflection and rea- soning, and is warmly attached to his parents. He has a most delicate palate, and partakes only of the most simple food. I have couched one of his eyes successfully; and he is much amused with the visible world, though he mistrusts informa- tion gained by that avenue. One day I got him a new and gaudy suit of clothes, which delighted him beyond description. It was the most interesting scene of sensual gratification I ever beheld *.” The first idea which struck me on receiving this intelligence was, that so extraordinary a combination of circumstances might perhaps afford a favourable opportunity of verifying or of correcting, in an unequivocal manner, some of those de- tails in CHESELDEN’s celebrated narrative, about which consi- derable doubts have been lately entertained, in consequence of their disagreement with the results of Mr Ware’s experience f. A * This letter was dated October 4. 1810. + Mr Wane’s paper here alluded to, is to be found in the Philosophical Transactions for 1801. The argument which it has been supposed to afford against CurseLDEN (founded on the case of Master W.) has always ap- peared to me to prove nothing, in consequence of its aiming to prove too much. Of this patient, (a boy who was restored to sight at seven years of age, after he had been blind from very early infancy), we are told, that two days after the operation, BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 3 A repetition of such observationsand experiments as Cue- SELDEN made, would, I imagined, be greatly facilitated by the total deafness of the patient in question ; the judg- ments which a blind man is enabled to form of distances (at least of small distances) by iio ear, wee rae siesta (tA 2ol s point. operation, the handkerchief which was tied over his eyes having slipped upward, he distinguished the table, by the side of which his mother was sitting. ‘“ It was about a yard and a half from him; and he observed, that it was covered with a green cloth, (which was really the ease); and that it was a little far- ther off than. he was able to reach.” Mr Ware afterwards informs us, that ** he held a letter before his patient, at the distance of about twelve inches, when he told him, after a short hesita- tion, that zt was a piece of paper; that it was square, which he knew by its corners, and that it was longer in one direction than it was in the other..— “*T then (says he) shewed him a’small oblong band-box, covered with’red lea- ther; which ‘he said was red, and square, and pointed at once to its four cor- ners. ‘The observation, however, which appeared to me most remarkable; was, that yh related to a white stone-mug ; which he first called a white bason, but, soon after, ‘recollecting himself,’ ‘said a was a mug, because it had: a handle.” Of the. correctness and fidelity of this statement, I have not: the: slightest doubt, But the. only, inference which can, with certainty, be deduced from it’ is, that the patient saw too well before the operation, to make his perceptions af~ terwards of any. value for deciding the point in question. If he. was able to re- cognise a green cloth, and a piece of white paper, the very moment: that the ban- dage was removed, the degree of sight which he possessed previous to Mr Wanrr’s acquaintance with him, must have been such as to furnish him with a va- riety | of sensations, quite sufficient to serve as materials for an imperfect visual, language 3—a language, if not accurately significant of comparative distances from the eye, at least fully adequate to convey, through the channel of that. or- gan, the intimation of distance in general, or. of what Berxexey calls outness ;— perhaps, also, some indistinct perception of diversities of visible figure. ‘The slightest, and, to us, the most evanescent shades of difference in. these sensations, will, we may be assured, become in the case of such an individual, signs of, all the various changes in the state of surrounding objects, with which, they . have any connection. Having mentioned, on this occasion, the name of Mr Siang I ‘think it but justice to him to add, that he does not appear to me to be himself disposed to push f ACCOUNT OF A BOY point of accuracy, very nearly to those which we are ac- customed to form by means of the eye. I had once occasion to witness the precision with which Mr Goven of Ken- dal (by far the most intelligent and ingenious person, born blind, whom I have happened to meet with) guessed at the di- mensions of a large room, a few minutes after he entered it. The error he committed was a mere trifle ; not exceeding what might push his argument against Curseipen so far as has been apprehended by some later writers. In the following passages, he not only seems to admit the truth of that optical principle which he has been generally understood to contro- vert, but even points at the same explanation which I have already suggested, of the apparent inconsistency between his own experience and that of his prede- cessor. “ I beg leave (says he) to add further, that on making inquiries of two chil- dren, between seven and eight years of age, now under my care, both of whom have been blind from birth, and on whom no operation has yet been per= formed, I find that the knowledge they have of colours, limited as it is, is suf- ficient to enable them to tell whether coloured objects be brought nearer to, or carried farther from them; for instance, whether they are at the distance of two inches or four inches from their eyes. ers vie) eNeBe tehfall sae ste) Pe see «‘T am aware, that these observations not only differ from those that are re- lated of Mr Cuxsetpen’s patient, but appear, on the first statement, to oppose a principle in optics, which I believe is commonly and justly admitted, that the senses of sight and feeling have no other connection but that which is formed by experience; and therefore, that the ideas derived from feeling, can have no power to direct the judgment, with respect either to the distance or form of visible objects. It should be recollected, however, that persons who have ca- taracts in their eyes, are not, in strictness of speech, blind, though they are deprived of all useful sight. The instances I have adduced prove, that the knowledge they have of colours is sufficient to give them some idea of dis- tance, even in their darkest state. When, therefore, their sight is cleared by the removal of the opaque crystalline which intercepted the light, and the co- lour of objects is thereby made to appear stronger, will it be difficult or un- philosophical to conceive, that their ideas of distance will be strengthened, and so far extended, as to give them a knowledge even of the outline and figure of those objects with the colour of which they were previously ac- sjuainted ?” BORN BLIND AND-DEAF. 5 might have been expected from the practised eye of a joiner or of'an architect. It is not every operator, however dextrous in his own art, who can be expected to attend sufficiently to these collateral circumstances, or to be fully aware of the difficulty which a blind person, suddenly put, in possession of a new sense, must experience, when he attempts to distinguish, in his estimates of distances, the perceptions of the eye from those of the ear or of the nostrils. Something of the same kind, in- deed, or at least strikingly analogous to. it, happens. every mo- ment to ourselves, in the judgments we pronounce on the beau- ty or deformity of visible objects, without any suspicion, on our part, how much these judgments are influenced by co-ex- ‘istent impressions of odour or of sound. In consequence of this view of the subject, I had been led by the first general outline which I received of this occurrence, to indulge a hope that the peculiarities of the case might offer some facilities which had not been before experienced, for esta- blishing by palpable and incontestible proofs, the distinction between the original and the acquired perceptions of sight ; while, at the same time, the inability of the patient to an- swer, by speech, the queries which might be proposed to him _ with respect to the new world to which he had been so recent- ly introduced, would, I conceived, by drawing the attention of those around him to other signs of a less ambiguous nature, place the results of their observations | beyond the reach of controversy.—Not that, even upon this supposition, every diffi- culty would have been removed ; inasmuch as intimations con- cerning distance may be occasionally conveyed to a blind man, not only by the sense of smell, but by some of those /ce/ings which are commonly referred to the sense of Touch *. In ob- - - Serving, * The blind man of Puiseaux (mentioned by Divzror) judged of his dis- tance from the fire-place by the degree of heat; and of his approach to any so- lid 6 ACCOUNT OF A BOY serving, accordingly, the first visual perceptions even of a pa~ tient born deaf as well as blind, some very nice attentions would be necessary for ascertaining the truth. But what pro- portion do these bear to the numerous and refined precautions which become indispensable, where the patient is reminded by every query which is addressed to his.ear, of the distance and relative position of the questioner ? ala might Diprror say,—* Preparer et interroger un aveugle né, n "elit point été une occupation indigne des talens réunis de Newron, Dss- cartes, Locks, et Lerpnirz.”—I mention this, because, from the great degree of perfection to which this branch of surgery has been lately carried, the increasing number of such. eases may be expected to multiply daily the opportunities of philosophical experiment ; and it is of importance, that those _ who may have the good fortune to enjoy them, should be ful- ly apprized of the delicacy and the complexity of the pheno- mena which they have to observe and to record *. In giving way to these speculations, I had proceeded on the supposition, that the blindness of the patient was complete ; not sufficiently attending to (what was long ago remarked by CuzseLpen) the qualified sense in which the word blindness is understood’ by surgical operators. “ Though this gentleman was blind,” (says Onaerest speaking of the patient whose case he has so well described), “ as is said of all persons who * have ripe cataracts, yet they: are never so blind, from that cause, lid obstacle, by the action or pulse of the air uponshis face. The same. thing is recorded of Dr SannErson by his successor Mr Cotson. er t * For the assistance of those to whom such a subject of observation may oc- eur, some judicious hints are suggested in the Lettre sur les Aveugles a Pusage de ceux qui vorent. BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 7 cause, but that they can discern day from night ; and, for the most part, in a strong light, distinguish black, white, and scar- let ; but they cannot perceive the shape of any thing. Thus it was with this young gentleman.” The case I have since found to have been the same, and in a degree considerably greater, with the boy who has given occasion to this memoir; inso- much that his condition seems to have approached much near- er to that of Mr Warer’s patient than to that of CuzsELDEN’s. “ At the time of life’ (Mr Warprop observes) when this boy began to walk, he seemed to be attracted by bright and dazzling colours ; and though every thing connected with his history appears to prove that he derived little information from the organ of sight, yet he received from it much sensual grati- Jication. “ He used to hold between his eye and luminous objects, such bodies as he had found to increase, by their interposi- tion, the quantity of light ; and it was one of his chief amuse- ments, to concentrate the sun’s rays by means of pieces of glass, transparent pebbles, or similar substances, which he held between his eye and the light, and turned about in va- rious directions. These, too, he would often break with his teeth, and give them that form which seemed to please him most. There were other modes by which he was in the ha- bit of gratifying this fondness for light. He would retire to any out-house, or to any room within his reach, shut the win- dows and doors, and remain there for some considerable time, with his eyes fixed on some small hole or chink which admit- ted the sun’s rays, eagerly catching them. He would also, du- ring the winter-nights, often retire to a dark corner of the room, and kindle a light for his amusement. On these occa- sions, as well as in the gratification of his other senses, his countenance and gestures displayed a most interesting avidity and curiosity. 66 It 3 ACCOUNT OF A BOY “ It was difficult, if not impossible, to ascertain with preci- sion, the degree of sight which he enjoyed; but from the preternatural acuteness which his senses of touch and smell had acquired, in consequence of their being habitually employ- éd to collect that information for which the sight is peculiarly adapted, it may be presumed with confidence, that he derived little, if any assistance from his eyes, as organs of vision. The appearances of disease, besides, in the eyes, were such as to render it in the highest degree probable, that they enabled him merely to distinguish colours, and differences in the intensity of light.” From this history of the patient’s previous situation, it ap- peared evident that his case was not of such a sort as to afford an opportunity of bringing CursELprn’s conclusions to the test. On the contrary, his habits of observation, and even of experi- ment, on his visual sensations, combined with the singular acuteness and discrimination of his olfactory perceptions, ren- dered it almost certain that the results of a successful operation on his eyes would be similar to those described in Mr Wanr’s paper. Such, accordingly, has, in point of fact, been the issue of this new experiment ;—in describing which, however, I must remark, to the honour of Mr Warprop, as a cautious and philosophical observer, he has abstained from drawing the slightest inference to the prejudice of CuEsELDEN’s statement ; —a statement which nothing can disprove till a case shall oc- cur of a patient cured of total, or almost total blindness ; and till this case shall be observed and examined with all the nice precautions which so delicate and complicated a pheno- menon demands. BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 9 I shall not follow Mr Warpror through the details of the surgical operation ; in performing which, he was forced, by the peculiar circumstances of his patient, to employ a mechani- cal apparatus, for fixing his body and head in an immoveable posture. I flatter myself that he will soon communicate to the public a history of the whole case; and I should be sorry to deprive his memoir of any part of its interest. The general results alone are connected with the objects which I have at present in view; and these I shall take the liberty to state in Mr Warpror’s words. “ When the operation was finished, he expressed great sa- tisfaction ; gazed around him, and appeared to distinguish ob- | - jects. This, however, could not be ascertained in a manner quite satisfactory, as it would have been prejudicial to his re- covery to make any experiments; but it could be perceived from the change in the expression of his countenance. His eye, accordingly, being covered up, he was carried home, and put to bed in a dark room; after which he was bled in the “ On the fourth day I examined the eye accurately, and ob- served the state of his vision. I found that the crystalline lens (which had been pushed upwards and backwards) had altered its situation since the operation, and could be again di- stinguished, covering about one-fourth of the upper edge of the pupil. The other part of the pupil was quite transparent, _ and all the blood which was effused into the anterior chamber during the operation was now absorbed. On making trial if he could distinguish any object, he readily discovered a book, or any similar thing, placed on the coverlet of the bed ; and in many of his attempts, he seemed to judge pretty accurately of their distance. : Vou. VII. B “ On 10 ACCOUNT OF A BOY “ On the fifth day he got out of bed, and was brought into a room having an equal and moderate light. He walked about the room readily ; and the expression of his countenance was much altered, having acquired that look which indicated the enjoyment of vision. Indeed, he always walked about, before the operation, with much freedom ; and even on a very rugged and unequal road, he did not appear to suffer in the least from any jolting. “ He appeared well acquainted with the furniture of the room, having lived in it several days previous to the opera- tion; but though he evidently distinguished, and attempted to touch objects which were placed before him, judging pretty accurately of their distances, yet he seemed to trust little to the information given by his eye, and always turned away his head, while he felt accurately over the whole surfaces of ie bodies presented to him. “ On the sixth day he appeared stronger, and amused him- self a good deal with looking out of the window, seeming to observe the carts and carriages which were passing in the street. On putting a shilling on the middle of a table, he in- stantly laid his hand upon it. “ On the seventh day the inflammation was nearly gone, and he observed a piece of white paper of this size be) lying on the table. I took him into the street, and he appeared much interested in the busy scene around him; and at times seemed frightened. A post supporting a scaffold, at the dis- tance of two or three yards from him, chiefly attracted his no- tice, and he timorously approached it, groping, and stretching out his hand cautiously until he touched it.” Of these very valuable facts Mr Warpror has left us to form our own judgment. To myself, I must own, that, due allow- ances BORN BLIND AND DEAF. il ances being made, 1st, for the visual sensations which were fa- miliar to the patient from his infancy, and, 2¢/y, for the in- timate and accurate acquaintance which he had acquired of things external, by a comparison of the perceptions of sinell and of touch, the result appears, on the whole, as favourable as could reasonably have been expected, to the Berkeleian theory of vision: Nor am I able to observe a single circum- stance of any importance, which is not perfectly reconcilable with the general tenor of CuEsELDEN’s narrative *. B2 The * Ihave said, the “‘ general tenor of Curseipen’s narrative,”—for there are some expressions ascribed by him to his patient, which must, in my opinion, be understood with a considerable degree of latitude. And, indeed, if we reflect for a moment on the astonishment and agitation likely to be produced by the sudden acquisition of a new sense, we cannot fail to be satisfied, that the autho- rity of the narrative rests much more on the conviction which the whole circum- stances of the case had left on CursenpEn’s own mind, than on the verbal an- swers (intelligent and satisfactory as most of these are), which his patient gave to the queries of his attendants. It was for this reason, among others, that I before hinted at the advantages which he would have enjoyed, in observing and describing the facts before him, if his patient had been deaf as well as blind, like the subject of this memoir. Of one expression employed by Curseipen’s young man, I think it proper to take some notice here, on account of the stress which Mr Wane seems disposed’ to lay upon it, as at variance with the language used by his patient Master W. «* When the young gentleman first saw, (says Cuzszipen), he was so far from making any judgment about distances, that he thought all objects whatever touched his eyes, (as he expressed it), as what he felt did his skin.” It seems to me inconceivable, that CursELpEn could have meant this last phrase to be inter- preted literally ; for the thing which it implies is altogether impossible. The most obvious meaning which the words convey is, that the object seemed to be contiguous to, or in contact with, the cornea; whereas the truth is, that the office of the cornea is merely to transmit the rays to the retina, which it does without itself receiving any sensible impression of which we are conscious. Mr Smirx,. too, has objected to this mode of speaking, though on grounds somewhat different. “* When the young gentleman said, (I quote Mr Smirn’s words), that the objects which 12 ACCOUNT OF A BOY The strong impression which Mr Wanre’s paper has lately made on the public mind, and the support which it is probable many readers will imagine that the argument against Cursex- DEN derives from the observations of Mr Warprop, will ac- count sufficiently for the length to which the foregoing remarks have extended : Or, if any farther apology be necessary, I trust that which he saw touched his eyes, he certainly could not mean that they pressed upon or resisted his eyes; for the objects of sight never act upon the organ in any way that resembles pressure or resistance. He could mean no more than that they were close upon his eyes, or, to speak more properly, perhaps, that they were in his eyes +.” Mr Surrn’s idea in this last clause, was, I presume, that the local situation of the object was referred by the patient to the retina, where the image of the object is painted. Now, I confess, for my own part, that although I perfectly agree with Mr Smrrn in his criticism on Curseipven, I am by no means satisfied, that the emendation which he has suggested of the young gen- tleman’s description is unexceptionable; for it does not appear to me, that the impression of a moderate light on the retina, is accompanied with any perception of the part of the body on which the impression is made. Where the light, in- deed, is so powerful as to produce pazn, the case comes to be different ; for a sen- sation of touch is then united with the proper sensations of sight; and it is cha- racteristical of all sensations of touch, that they are accompanied with a percep- tion of the local situation of their exciting causes. This, however, it is well known, does not take place with respect to the sensations of smell and of sound ; nor do I imagine it to take place, prior to experience, with respect to the sen- sations received by the eye. And, therefore, if a patient, in such circumstances, should be led, by his first visual perceptions, to connect them locally with the or- gan by which they are received, I should be inclined rather to ascribe this to concomitant feelings of pain, (produced by the recent operation, or by the too sudden impression of a strong light), than to any of those sensations which are exclusively appropriated to the sense of sight. But this discussion it is un- necessary for me to prosecute at present, as the opinion we may happen to form with respect to it, (whatever that opinion may be), can never affect the truth of that clause in Cursepen’s statement, in which he asserts, upon the evidence of his own observations, that * when his patient first saw, he was unable to form any judgment about distances.” The remainder of the sentence is only a loose and unintelligible comment of the young man on this simple fact. + See an Essay on the External Senses, by Apam Situ, LL.D. (published among his posthumous papers.) BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 13 that allowances will: be made for my anxiety to obtain from the enlightened. Operators of the present times, an additional contribution of evidence in eonfirmation of one of the most beautiful, and, at the same time, one of the most important theories of modern philosophy. . Mr Waronrop afterwards enters into some circumstantial and very pleasing details with respect to an incident alluded to in a passage which I have already quoted from one of his let- ters ;—the joy manifested by his patient when he was first dressed in a suit of gaudy clothes... From this part of his me- moir I:shall only transcribe a few lines. “ His partiality to colours seemed. to depend. entirely on their comparative bril- liancy. He in general liked objects that were white ; and still more particularly those of a red colour. A white waistcoat or white stockings pleased him exceedingly ; and he gave always a decided: preference’ to yellow gloves. One day), I observed him to take out of his pocket a bit of red sealing-wax, which he had kept for the beauty of its colour. atl thin worst coat. : ipl ie rceviniplansen were given him, with a view of les- sening the influence of the bright sun on the still irritable eye; and from them also he derived great pleasure. | Indeed, wlien he first pet them mist he nici aloud with delighh' ff ay few! a re I had eset Gira bij Me Warpnror with his first communication on this subject, I learned, through a different channel, that his patient had left London ; and, as’ 1 had never happened: to. make any inquiries about his:connections,’ or the place of his: nativity, I had abandoned for many months all expectations of farther ‘intelligence with respect to him; when he was most unexpectedly and agreeably. recalled: to my recollection: by a letter which I received last week from Mr Professor GLenn1g, the very learned and worthy successor 14 ACCOUNT OF A BOY successor of Dr Brartiz in his academical chair at Aberdeen: In this letter Mr Giennir incloses “ An Account of James Mircnett, a lad in the county of Moray, born blind and deaf ;” drawn up, at Mr Grenwiz’s request, by a neighbour- ing clergyman. From the narrative it appears, that this is the very patient who was formerly under Mr Warpror’s care; and it appears farther, that although his blindness returned again, not long after the operation was performed, the peculiarities of his case still continue to present, under a new and very different form, a subject of examination and inquiry, not less interesting than if Mr Warnror’s exertions in his fa- vour had been rewarded with permanent success. A short extract from Mr Giennie’s letter will form the best introduction I can prefix to the history which is to follow. “ [ send you inclosed an account of a clergyman’s son who was born deaf and blind. The account is imperfect as yet ; but it is an accurate answer to a series of questions which I put to the clergyman who has taken the trouble to draw it up. As he has very obligingly offered to answer any more queries that I make, I have prepared a good many additional questions, that the present state of the young man’s mind may be ascer- tained with as much accuracy as possible. Much light might have been thrown on the mental faculties, if accurate experi- ments and observations ‘had been made on patients in such cir- cumstances as this unfortunate young man. I intend, if it be possible, to visit him during our summer vacation; but { am sensible, that little can be done in such a case, even in a visit of some days, compared with what may be ac- complished by his constant attendants, if we could teach them to make the proper experiments. For this purpose, the only thing I can think of is, to direct the mother and sister to have recourse to the narratives of some instances not dissimilar, BORN: BLIND AND DEAF. 15 dissimilar, that their attention may be drawn to their own me- thods of communication, which, having become habitual, escape their notice. But I must forbear entering on a minute discus- sion of this case, which appears to me very interesting.” .«. . ee e © © @ © @ © © ew ee we ew © ew Before I proceed to read the paper alluded to in the forego- ing extract, I think it proper for me to mention, that I have not been favoured with the name of the writer, and that I must therefore request, it may not be considered, in its present form, as a fair subject of discussion or of criticism. That it bears strong marks of uncommon intelligence and discrimination in the observer, must be universally acknowledged ; but it reached me so very lately, that I have not had time to solicit, through Mr Gienniz, the author’s permission to communicate it to the Society *. ak * I have since learned from Mr Gurnnie, that the paper in question was written by the Reverend Tuomas Macrarsane, minister of Edinkillie, in the presbytery of Forres. Mr Guewniz adds a sentence which I beg leave to quote, as some apology for the liberty I now take’ in mentioning Mr Macraruane’s name without his express authority. I certainly would not have presumed to do so, if I had not been fully persuaded, that all who are competent to form a judgment on such subjects, will feel much indebted to him for his very interest- ing and satisfactory statement. « As I communicated to Mr Macrartane your wish to print his memoir, I take for granted that he has no objection to your making this use of his papers, although he has not expressed his sentiments explicitly to this purpose.” Answers 16 ACCOUNT OF A BOY Answers to some Queries addressed to a Clergyman in the Coun- ty of Moray, by Mr Professor GLenNiE of Marischal Col- lege, Aberdeen, with respect to James. Mrrcuez, a lad size teen years of age, who was born blind ee deaf. “ The subject of this brief notice is the son of the Reverend Donatp Mrrcuett, late minister of Ardclach, a Highland pa- rish, lying on the banks of the Findhorn. He was born 11th November 1795, and is the sixth child of his parents, being the youngest except one. All his brothers and sisters, (as were also his parents), are perfectly free from the deficiency of sight and hearing, which occurs in his case; and are healthy and well formed. His mother, who is an intelligent and sen- sible lady, very early discovered his unfortunate situation : she noticed that he was blind, from his discovering no desire to turn his eyes to the light, or to any, bright object; and afterwards,’ (in his early ‘infancy also), she ascertained his being deaf, from the circumstance that no noise, how- ever ci awakened him from sleep. As he grew up, he discovered a most extraordinary acuteness of the senses of touch and smell; being very soon: able, by these, to di- stinguish strangers from the members of his own family, and any little article which was appropriated to himself, from what belonged to others. In his childhood, the most notice- able circumstance relating to him, was an eager desire to strike upon his fore-teeth any thing he could get hold of; this he would do for hours ; and scene particularly gratified if it was a BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 17 a key, or any instrument that gave a sharp sound when struck against his teeth. This would seem to indicate that the audito- ry nerve was not altogether dormant. ....... a OH PP “Tn 1808, and again in 1810, his father carried him to Lon- don, where operations were performed upon his eyes by the most eminent practitioners, with very little, or rather with no {permanent) success *; while an attempt that was made at the same time, to give him the sense of hearing, by piercing the tympanum, totally failed. “ Such is the brief history of this poor lad: it remains now to give some account.of his appearance, behaviour, the feelings by which he seems to be actuated, the manner in which he con- veys his desires, and the methods by which he is managed. “1. His countenance, notwithstanding his unfortunate de- fects, does by no means indicate fatuity ; nay, the lineaments of thought are very observable upon it. His features at times, (in church, for instance, and during the time of family prayer), are perfectly composed and sedate; when sensible of the pre- sence _ * That one of these operations was attended with considerable success in the Jirst instance, appears not only from the extracts already copied from Mr War- pror’s narrative, but from the following passage in a letter to that gentleman from the Reverend Mr Mircnexz. This letter is dated 5th October 1810, about a month after Mr Mircue and his son had left London, to return home by-sea. ; _ James seemed much amused with the shipping in the River, and till we passed Yarmouth Roads. During the rest of the passage, we were so far out at sea, that there was little to attract his notice, except the objects around him on decks, 6... sy Rn 20 LEB ASIC CEL ONO Bh ot ROR OCT Ht g SECU. His eye is now pretty free of the redness it had when he left town, and the cataract in the same moveable state, sometimes covering more and sometimes less of the pupil. Though his sight is not much increased since we left London, yet I am perfectly satisfied that what he has got is of essential service.” ~ Vou. VII. Cc 7 18 ACCOUNT OF A BOY sence of a stranger, or of any object which awakens his curio- sity, his face appears animated; and when offended or enra~ ged, he has a very marked ferocity of look. He is (for his age) of an athletic form, and has altogether a robust appear- ance. “2, He behaves himself in company with much more pro- priety than could be expected ; a circumstance owing undoubt- edly to the great care of his parents, and of his elder sister. He feeds himself: When a stranger arrives, his smell imme- diately and invariably informs him of the circumstance, and directs him to the place where the stranger is, whom he pro- ceeds to survey by the sense of touch. In the remote situation where he resides, male visitors are most frequent ; and, there- fore, the first thing he generally does, is to examine whether or not the stranger wears boots; if he does wear them, he im- mediately quits the stranger, goes to the lobby, feels for, and accurately examines his whip ; then proceeds to the stable, and handles his horse with great care, and with the utmost seem- ing attention. It has occasionally happened, that visitors have arrived in a carriage, and, on such occasions, he has never failed to go to the place where the carriage stood, examined the whole of it with much anxiety, and tried innumerable times the elasticity of the springs. In all this he is undoubt- edly guided by the smell and touch only, without any assist- ance from sight ; for, going to call lately for his mother, I pass- ed him, near to the house, within a few feet, without his no- ticing me in the least ; and offering him a. glass of punch after dinner, he groped for it, as one in total darkness. “ 3. The feeling by which he appears to be most power- fully actuated, (at least to a stranger), is curiosity, or an anxi- ous desire to make himself acquainted. with every thing that is new to him. He appears to feel affection to those. of his fa- mily BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 19 mily very strongly ;—diseovered extreme sorrow on account of his father’s death; laid: himself upon the coffin, after his fa- ther’s corpse was put into it, apparently in much grief; went frequently to his grave, and threw himself upon it, whilst he gently patted the turf, and bemoaned himself greatly. He is likewise capable of feeling mirth, and frequently laughs: hearti- ly. He is highly gratified by getting new clothes; and as tearing his clothes isthe most usual expression of his anger, so the punishment he feels most is being ‘obliged to wear them _after he has torn them. He: is en to anger, upon being crossed in any of his desires, or when he finds any of fs clothes, or articles with which he amuses himself, removed from the chest in which he keeps them. « 4, Respecting. the manner in which he conveys his feel- ings and desires, I am) much at a loss:to give the inforrmdtion * the might be: expected. It is certain: that those of his family know perfectly in what temper of mind he is, and what he wants to have;: arid these intimations he conveys to them: in the presence of strangers, without thiese last: being sensible of his doing so.. When he is hungry, he approaches his mother or sisters, touches them in an expressive manner, and ‘points towards: the apartment where: the victuals are usually’ kept. If he wants: dry stockings, he: points: to his legs; and-in a si~ milar way,.intimates his wishes upon other occasions. A pai of shoes were lately brought to: him, and on putting them on: he: found: them too small... His: mother then took them, and» put: them: into) a; small’ closet; soon after’ a thought seemed, to- strike» him, and he! coritrived. to obtain’ the key: of: the closet; opened: the door, took the shoes; and put them upom the: feét. of a young: lad: who! attends: him; whom they suited: exactly; This:action of his: implies con C2 siderable 20 ACCOUNT OF A BOY siderable reflection, and shews that he must have made some accurate examinations, though unnoticed at the time. When he is sick and feverish, which sometimes happens, he points to his head, or takes his mother’s hand and places it op- _ posite to his heart, seemingly with an intention that she may observe its beating more quickly than usual. He never at- tempts to express his feelings by utterance, except when an- gry, when he bellows in a most uncouth manner. Satisfaction or complacency he expresses by patting the person or object which excites that feeling, His smell being wonderfully acute, he is frequently offended through that sense, when other per- sons near to him smell nothing unpleasant; he expresses his dissatisfaction on such occasions, by putting his hand to his nose, and retreating rapidly. His taste seems also to be ex- quisite, and he expresses much pleasure by laughing and smacking his lips, when any savoury victuals are laid before ~ him. “ 5. His father, when alive, was at much pains in direct- ing him, as his mother still is; but his elder sister seems to’ have a much greater ascendancy over him, and more power of managing him than any other person. Touching his: head with her hand seems to be the principal method which she employs in signifying her wishes to him respecting his con- duct ; this she does with various degrees of force, and im dif-. ferent manners; and he seems readily to understand the inti- mation intended to be conveyed.. In short, by gratifying him when he acts properly, and withholding from him the objects: of his complacency when he has done amiss, he has been taught a sense of what is becoming in manners, and proper in. conduct, much stronger than it could be otherwise believed, that any person, in- his singularly unfortunate situation, could acquire.” SINCE BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 23 Since the foregoing narrative reached me, I have had the good fortune to receive a most important and authentic sup- plement to it, from Dr Joun Gorpon; a gentleman, on whose recent admission into our number, I beg leave to congratulate the Society. Having communicated to him, on the suggestion of our colleague Dr rf oun Tuomson, Mr Guennie’s letter with the saree statement, he most obligingly undertook, on a very short notice, to add to it whatever particulars relative to the same subject had fallen under his own personal knowledge. Of the ability with which he has executed this. task, amidst his various professional avocations, I have no doubt that the So- ciety will think as highly as I do. Supt to the for ezoing Account of James Mircue.t, by essai Joun Gorpon, M.D. fnew “ The boy. who is the subject of the above: interesting com-. munication, was brought by his father to visit me at For es in, the autumn of 1808. “ T found on ‘examination that he had a cataract in. n. each eye. _Tnrboth, the crystalline lens had a pearly colour, and appeared. to be ofa firm ¢ consistence ; but the pupils exhibited very per- ceptible contraction and dilatation; when the quantity of light was. suddenly increased or diminished. The auricle or exter- nal part of each « ear, and the tube leading from it to the tym- panum, ¥ were of their natural size and. form ; and nothing un-. usual: 22 ACCOUNT OF A BOY: usual could be discovered in the conformation of the parts about the fauces. “ From the motions which were produced in the iris, by va- rying the quantity of light admitted to the eyes, I should alone have been inclined to hope, that the retina was not altogether wanting, and to have urged the propriety of attempting to re- move the opaque lens from the axis of vision by a surgical ope- ration. But the following circumstances served to confirm this opinion. In the first place, Mr Mircuetux informed me, that he had often observed his son, sitting for an hour at a time, opposite to a, small hole in the south wall of a hut ad- joining to the manse, so as to receive the beams of the sun, which, shone through the hole during part of the forenoon, di- rectly on his eyes. The boy could have no other motive for placing himself in this situation, but to enjoy a certain agree- able sensation of light ; and it is not improbable, that. the par- ticular pleasure which he seemed to derive from the light of the sun, admitted in this manner, arose from the eyes having been rendered more susceptible to impressions, by being pre- viously directed to the darker parts of the hut. Secondly, I observed, that he very frequently turned his face towards the window of an apartment, and then pressed his finger forcibly backwards between. the eyebrow. and upper eyelid of one of his eyes, so as to occasion a slight degree of distortion, and a very disagreeable appearance of protrusion of the ball. I sup- posed, that when he compressed the eye-ball in this manner, either some change in the organ was produced, by which jhe obtained a more distinct impression from the light of the win- dow, or else that the pressure on the retina simply, occasioned the sensation of a luminous ring or spot, which he had plea- sure in contemplating. When I put my silver pencil into his hand, after turning it quickly round in the points of his fingers, and BORN®BLIND AND DEAF. 23 and applying it to his nose, lips, and the tip of his tongue, he rattled it smartly between his fore-teeth ; and his father as- suted me that he did so with every hard substance which he could convey to his mouth, and that he seemed to have pleasure in repeating this motion with metallic bodies in particular. This circumstance led me to conclude, that vibrations communicated through the solid parts of the head, were capable of producing in him, to a certain degree, the sensations of sound. But these sensations were obviously so very weak, when compared with those which persons who are affected with obstruction in the eustachian tubes, can at all times enjoy through the medium of the bones of the head, that [ could not but fear that the deafness in this case, depended not on any want of air in the tympanum, but on some great deficiency, or radical imperfec- tion. in. the structure of the auditory nerve. Although, there- fore, no harm could result from piercing the membrane of the tympanum, I did not expect that the sense of hearing would be much improved by this operation. “ With this opinion of the boy’s situation, I earnestly re- commended it to his father to carry him to London, and to place him under the care of Mr Warr and Mr Asriey Coo- PER, in order that the operation of couching or extraction. might be performed on one’ or both eyes, and that the mem= brane of the tympanum in each ear might be perforated. “ In the course of a few weeks, Mr Mrrcueti repaired with his son to. London. Mr Astusy Coorrr pierced the meni- brane of each tympanum, but without. the slightest benefit ; and, at the same time, the’late Mr Saunvers operated with ‘the needle on the left, eye; and; it is to. be presumed, used every effort which the violent struggles of the boy would: permit, to depress’ the cataract; but not the: least advantage resulted from the. umes ae Q4 ACCOUNT OF A BOY “ In the summer of 1810, several months after his return from London, young Mircuety was again brought by his fa- ther to visit me at Forres. When I placed him in a chair be- fore me, and took hold of his head, with 4 view to examine his eyes, his situation seemed immediately to recall to his memo- ry the painful operations with which this examination had been formerly succeeded, and he withdrew from me in his chair, panting as from a sudden alarm. By patting him gently on the cheek, however, his fears were quickly allayed. The cata- ract of the left eye, into which the needle had been introduced, had lost its white colour, and seemed as if broken down ; but still the lens remained opaque, and he was in every respect as blind as when I first saw him. The pupil, however, of each eye was very distinctly enlarged when I placed my hand before his face, and it again contracted when the hand was removed ; and I observed with great satisfaction, every time I practised this experiment, that when the quantity of light admitted to the eye was increased, the boy expressed his pleasure by a smile. The cataract of the right eye had the same appearance of firmness as before, and I therefore still entertained hopes, that it might be practicable to remove it entirely by the ope- ration of extraction. On stating this opinion to Mr Mrreuetz, to the honour of whose memory it ought to be remarked, that he displayed at all times the most earnest anxiety to alleviate the sad condition of his child, he immediately resolved to visit the metropolis once more ; and, in compliance with my request, to entrust the treatment of his son, entirely to the judgment and practical skill of my friend Mr Warpror. In a few weeks Mr Warpror wrote to me, that having resolved to attempt ex- tracting the cataract from the right eye, he had endeavoured, by means of powerful reuctesetyy) as well as the aid of nume- rous assistants, to fix the boy’s oe in a position sufficiently steady BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 25 steady for so delicate an operation ; but that his struggles were so violent as to render every effort for this purpose meffectual. The attempt at ‘extraction was therefore relinquished; but, soon afterwards, I had the satisfaction of being informed by Mr Warpror, that he had so far succeeded, by the use of the couching-needle, in breaking down the cataract, and removing it from the axis of the eye, that his young patient had been able to see a very small object of a white colour, when placed on a table before him. This partial success from Mr War- prop’s operation, led me to anticipate, with no small confi- dence, a still further improvement in young Mircuet1’s vision, from the gradual absorption of some of the broken fragments of the opaque lens or its capsule. But in this expectation I have been altogether disappointed. In the month of June last, I saw him repeatedly at his father’s house, and had ample op- portunity of observing his motions with attention. When he approached any object, such as a wall, a cart, or a carriage, so large as to be in part interposed between his eyes and the ho- rizon, he seemed to discover its vicinity by the interception of the light which it occasioned alone, and cautiously put out his hands before him, to feel for that with which he was already almost in contact. But he did not appear to be at all capable of perceiving minute objects, nor of distinguishing in the slightest degree between one colour and another. His powers of vision, therefore, so far from continuing to improve since the successful result of Mr Warpropr’s operation, have but too plainly undergone a degree of failure. A fragment of the sub- stance of the lens, or of its capsule, very white and opaque, may still be seen behind one-half of the pupil, and through the lower half, a slighter opacity is very perceptible in the parts situated farther back *. Vou. VII. D “ On Bis tsife ts. /s: 0 « You will perceive, from the account of the state of the cataract, immediately after the operation, that a part of the opaque body still hung over ; & 26 ACCOUNT OF A BOY “ On the whole, Iam of opinion, that if this unfortunate, but very interesting boy, should at any future period be indu- ced, either by being informed through the medium of some peculiar language, of the object in view, or from his increased knowledge in the kindness and good intentions of his relations, to submit patiently to the operation of couching or extraction, either of these operations ought to be repeated on one or both eyes. At the same time, it must be confessed, that, since the attempts of this kind already made, have not only failed to communicate to him the powers of distinct vision, but also the perception even of the more striking differences in the degrees and kinds of light, there is but too much reason to fear, that the optic nerve, although not entirely deficient, is yet imper- fect in its structure. “ [ have but little to add to the full account which is given in Mr Gienninz’s communication, of young Mircuett’s general ap- pearance and conduct. The knowledgewhich he has derived from the senses of Touch, Taste and Smell, seems fully as extensive, as what any person of the most perfect faculties might be sup- posed to acquire, if he could by any contrivance be prevented from using his eyes and ears for the same period of time, from the moment of his birth, and in the same retired situation of the country. The train of his thoughts seems to be regulated by the same principles as that of the soundest minds. His ac- tions neither indicate incoherence nor fatuity ; but every thing he does, appears capable of being easily traced to rational mo- tives. a portion of the pupil. I have been told lately, that he now sees little or none. If this be the case, I suspect it must have been from the cataract passing over the whole of the pupillar opening, instead of being altogether absorbed, or re- maining out of the way, as might have been expected.” Extract of a letter from Mr Warprop to Mr Stewart, (dated August 10. 1812.) BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 277. tives. His more pleasurable sensations are obviously enjoyed from the senses of Taste and Smell ; and, indeed, I have never observed any thing disagreeable in his manner, except the keenness and voracity with which he devours his food. But he derives amusement also from the sense of Touch. His fa- ther told me, that he had often remarked him, employing many hours in selecting from the bed of the river, which runs — within a few yards of the house, stones of a round shape, near- ly of the same weight, and having a certain degree of smooth- ness. These he placed in a circular form on the bank, and ~ then seated himself in the middle of the circle. “« There is a certain range around the manse which he has minutely explored by his organs of Touch, and to any part of this space he seems to walk, when he pleases, fearlessly and without a guide. I believe his range does not yet extend be- yond two hundred yards in any direction ; but there is proba- bly not a day elapses, during which he does not cautiously feel his way into ground which he had not explored before; and thus gradually extends his yet very circumscribed field of observation. It was m one of these excursions of discovery, that his father observed him with horror, creeping on his hands and knees along a narrow wooden bridge which crossed the river, at a point where the stream is deep and rapid. He was immediately arrested in his progress; and as his father wished to discourage him from hazarding so perilous an at- tempt again, a servant was directed to plunge him, as soon as he was secured, once or twice into the river. This measure has had the desired effect. “ From a similar solicitude about his safety, the servants had been enjoined to prevent him from visiting the stable, which he never fails to do, the instant he has discovered by D2 the 28 ACCOUNT OF A BOY the presence of an additional whip in the lobby, that the per- son who has arrived has brought a horse with him. I have been assured, however, that after his wishes in this respect had been repeatedly thwarted, he at last had the ingenuity to lock the door of the kitchen on the servants, in the hopes that he might then accomplish his visit to the stable unmolested. “ His father once told me an anecdote of him, which dis- plays in a very striking manner, both the retentiveness of his memory, and the benevolent feelings of which he is suscepti- ble. He had received a severe wound in his foot, and during its cure, he usually sat by the fire-side, with his foot resting on a small foot-stool. More than a year afterwards, a servant-boy with whom he used to play, was obliged to confine himself to a chair from a similar cause. Young Mircuetu perceiving, that his companion remained longer in one situation than he used to do, examined him attentively, and seemed quickly to discover by the bandages on his foot, the reason of his confine- ment. He immediately walked up stairs to a garret, sought out, amidst several other pieces of furniture, the little foot- stool which had formerly supported his own wounded limb, brought it down in his hand to the kitchen, and gently placed the servant-boy’s foot upon it *, “ The * Somewhat similar to the above anecdote, is the following very pleasing fact, eommunicated to Mr Guennte by Huew Irvine, Esq; (son of Mr Irvine of Drum). I give it in Mr Irvine’s own words. “© Mr Lesute of Darkland, a clergyman, called one day, and was taken by Miss Mrrcuetx to see something out of doors. When they returned, James Mrrt- eHeELt perceived (no doubt by the sense of smell) that his. sister’s shoes were wet: he then went and felt them, and would not let her rest-till she changed them.” BORN) BLIND AND DEAF. 29 “ The last time I saw young Mircuetr, was on the melan- choly occasion of his father’s funeral, in the month of June last. According to Mr Guennie’s communication, it would seem, that the boy, even before his father’s interment, had ex- pressed by sorrow and bemoaning, a knowledge of the irrepa- rable loss he had sustained. On this point, the deep distress under which the family then laboured, prevented me from ma- king any inquiries. But the poor lad’s, behaviour on the day of the funeral, seemed. to me so little expressive of grief, that I cannot help doubting in some degree the accuracy of Mr GLENnnNiz’s information. It will be regarded as a pleasing tes- timony of the sincere esteem in which Mr Mircueni. was held. for his moral worth and exemplary piety, that several hundreds of his friends and parishioners assembled together, to carry his remains to the grave. While this concourse of people waited the commencement of the procession. in, front of the, manse, young Mircuet at one time moved rapidly among the crowd, touching almost every body, and examining some very mi- nutely ; at another time, he amused himself opening and shut~ ting the doors, or turning down. and up the steps of the carri+ ages; or suddenly he would walk towards the coffin, which was placed on chairs before the door of the house, run his fin- gers along it with marks even of pleasure, and then trip light- ly away, without the slightest expression of sorrow. He ac- companied the procession, to the church-yard, and returned af- ter the interment, apparently. as much unmoved as before. But on the following morning, as I have since been informed, and on several mornings afterwards, he visited the grave, pat- ted gently the turf which. had been laid ovev it, and at last, as iar edasiiiailitaly wisi if 30 ACCOUNT OF A BOY if hopeless of his father’s return, became sorrowful even to tears *.” TuE * Soon after this memoir was read, I informed Mr Guennte of the difference in the accounts given by Mr Macrartane and by Dr Gornon, of young Mir- cuett’s behaviour on the day of his father’s funeral. In a letter with which he has lately favoured me (dated May 10. 1812,) there is a passage transcribed from a letter of Mr Macrartane’s (dated May 7.) which I think it proper to subjoin to the foregoing details, as an important document with respect to this interesting point ;—the only point of any consequence in which the two papers do not perfectly agree. <‘ In the account which I transmitted to you of James Mrrcnext, I mentioned. that he seemed much afflicted and very sorrowful the day of his father’s funeral ; and I now beg leave explicitly and. positively to state, that when the coffin which enclosed his father’s corpse was brought from the house, and placed upon chairs in the court before the manse, previous to the interment, I approached to the coffin, and soon after saw James Mrrcuenn come from the house in consi- derable agitation. He turned about his head rapidly, and snuffed very much, evidently guiding himself by the sense of smell. He directly approached the cof- fin, smelled it most eagerly for several seconds; then Jaid himself down upon the lid, on his face, and embraced the coffin, while his countenance discovered marks of the most lively sorrow. I stood close by him, and after a short time, patted his head once or twice ; upon which he-rose, and returned into the house. This occurred immediately upon the coffin being brought out, and about twenty minutes before it was lifted, in order to be.carried to the church-yard. As the accuracy of my information on this subject has been doubted, I purposely delay- ed writing to you, till I should have an opportunity of conversing with the Re- verend Pryse Campsenz, minister of Ardersier, brother-in-law to Mrs Mir- cHetL, who was present at the funeral, and by whose direction every thing was eonducted. I fell in with this gentleman on Tuesday se’ennight, at the meeting of our Provincial Synod. I took an opportunity there of asking him, if he ob- served any marks of sorrow about James Mircuett on the day of his father’s funeral. He replied, that he did observe the most unequivocal marks of grief in his countenance ; and added a circumstance which escaped my notice, that when BORN BLIND AND DEAT’. $1 Tur case described in the foregoing’ papers is said by Mr Warpror, in a letter of his already quoted, to be unique, to the best of his knowledge ; and that it really is so, am inclined to believe, as far as this can be inferred from the silence of scienti- fic writers *. That it is, at least, a very rare occurrence, is de- monstrated when the coffin was about to be lifted, in order to be carried to the church-yard, James Mircuext clung to it, endeavouring to prevent its being carried away, and that he (Mr Campzett) was obliged to remove him from it by force.” After quoting the above passage, Mr Guennie adds :—** Mr Macrarrane, in his remarks on the apparent inconsistence between Dr Gornon’s account of young Mrrcuext and his own, has expressed what occurred to me immediately. after I read your last letter. His words are: “‘ I would observe, that the cir- cumstances mentioned by Dr Gornon, of Mitcuext’s running through the crowd, and touching every person, do not, in my opinion, amount to a proof, that he was insensible of ‘the loss which he had sustained, and felt no grief on that account. In acting thus, Mrrcnexs (if the expression may be allowed) was merely viewing the assemblage of people around him. This he could not do by his eyes; but being eager to examine them, he did so by means of the senses of which he has the use. In short, he was grieved ; but, in this instance, his curio- sity overcame his grief.” The remark certainly does honour to Mr Macrar- LANE’s sagatity, and, in my opinion, goes far to reconcile the two narratives. I hope to be able soon, through Dr Gorpon’s means, who proposes to pass a part of this summer in that neighbourhood, to obtain from the mother and sister of the young man, a still more circumstantial account of his general behaviour, and of the apparent state of his feelings at this trying crisis of his life. Some very interesting particulars, with respect to these points, (which have been already communicated to me by this gentleman) may be found in an Appendix annexed to this memoir. (May 20. 1812.) * In Dipenor’s very ingenious and fanciful Letter on the Blind, there are va- rious allusions to the hypothetical case of an Aveugle-Sourd-Muet. In one pas- sage, 32 ACCOUNT OF A BOY monstrated by a passage in the Abbé Sicarp’s Course of In- struction for the Deaf and Dumb, where it is mentioned only as a hypothetical contingency, which had been contemplated by him and by his predecessor the Abbé de Err’, as a pos- sible, sage, he remarks, somewhat whimsically, that if a person born in these circum- stances, should begin to philosophize concerning man, according to the method of Descartes, he would place the seat of the soul at the tips of his fingers; and, in all probability, after an effort of profound meditation, would feel his fingers ache as much as we should do our heads. From the following sentence, one would be led to suppose, that Dineror had actually seen or heard of persons in the same condition with Mircuext; but if this really had been the fact, we may presume with some confidence, that he would not have contented himself with so yague and equivocal a reference to an occurrence at once so anomalous and so curious in the physical history of man. “ Faute @une langue, la communication « est enticrement rompue entre nous et ceux qui naissent sourds, aveugles, et muets : tls croissent, mais ils restent dans un etat @imbecillité.” In those valleys of the Alps, indeed, where the disease of Crétinisme is com- mon, examples are said frequently to occur of an almost total deprivation of all the senses ; but, in such instances, the individual presents invariably, in the low and humiliating state of his intellectual capacity, .a very striking contrast to the subject of this memoir. The universal torpor in the perceptive faculties of the Crétin, is plainly an effect of the same radical disorder which impairs his intel- lect; whereas, in the instance before us, (as in every instance where the intel- lect is entire), the mind, checked and confined ‘in the exercise of one class of her powers, displays her native strength by the concentrated energy which she exhibits in others. The following description relates to an extreme case of Créli- nisme; for it appears, that it admits of various gradations. It is taken from the most circumstantial, and apparently the most accurate, account of this local malady that has fallen in my way. « The sensibility of the Crétzn is extremely obtuse: he dreads neither cold nor heat, nor vermin; nor even those blows which would be insupportable to another. « The greater part are evidently deaf and dumb; although I have happened to see a few who would shudder at the report of a pistol. These last would seem to receive some passive impression from sound; but they are certainly in- capable BORN BLIND AND) DEAF: $33 - sible, and not, altogether as an improbable event, among the - various physical*calamities to which our species is liable. — It. - appears from the same. ingenious author, that the Abbé de - Err had even:gone so far, a few years before his death, as to offer, in some of the Continental Journals, with his charac- teristical benevolence, to undertake the charge and tuition of any child who might:be brought into the world in. these unfor- -tunate circumstances ; and M. Sicarp has not only taken the trouble to record the general principle on which the Abbé de _ Err intended, if this accident ‘should occur, to: have pro- - ceeded, in the education of his pupil; but has added some very judicious strictures of his own, on the imperfections of the plan which his predecessor proposed, in such an instance, to follow. These ~ capable of listening to what is passing around them. The organ of Smell is in- sensible; and the power of Taste but imperfectly developed. The sense of see- ing alone appears uninjured by the disorder ; but even from this they derive little benefit. They gaze with indifference on the spectacle of Nature ; and if they see, can hardly be said to perceive.” 2... ee ee ee, “« ‘This disease is peculiar to the human species. | All the classes of animals, from the oyster to the monkey, possess a sufficient degree of intelligence, to pro- cure the means of their own subsistence. The .Créin, on the other hand, would die of hunger, if his wants were not provided for by the attentions of ~ others.” (Tratté du Gottre et du Crétinisme, par F. E. Foderé, Ancicn Médecin des Ho- pttaux civils et militatres., ‘A Parts, an vit.) Since this note was written, I have received a letter from Mr Guennix, in which he remarks, and, in my opinion, very justly, that the case of Mrr- cHELL is probably not so very rare an occurrence, as we might, at first, be dispo- sed to imagine. “ Among the various merits (he observes) of this worthy fami- ly, their superiority to such prejudices as would have precluded our getting any information about the lad’s state of mind, is deserving of peculiar notice. . . . . _T have reason to believe, that there are others in circumstances similar to young _Mrrcuexx’s, whose cases are, at this day, kept so secret, that they are not so much as known to the inmates and members of the family to whom they belong,” Vou. VII. | E 34 ACCOUNT OF A BOY These strictures I cannot help taking this opportunity of re- commending to the attention of those who may attempt the far- ther instruction of young Mrrcurty. The following abridged translation * of a passage in the preface, may, in the mean time, suggest some useful hints. ces Seay “ But, if there should be found a ‘person deaf and dumb, in whose case the use of this visible language was imprac- ticable ; if, among the afflicting exceptions and mutilations of nature, an individual should occur, deaf and blind from his birth, to what class of signs should we have recourse in attempting is education? At what an immense distance from other men would a being so cruelly degraded be placed ; and how difficult to transport him across that gulf by which he is separated from the rest of his species? The means of instruction em- ployed in ordinary instances of dumbness, would here be ma- nifestly inapplicable ; all of these means presupposing the use of sight, to which a constant reference is made, not only in the communication of physical ideas, but in typifying the processes of thought, and in rousing the dormant powers of the under- standing. ' “ T flatter myself, I have already proved, that, from the be- ginning, Man possessed, in his own bodily organs, two differ- ent media for conveying his ideas; and that, instead of em- ploying oral speech, he might have had recourse to a manual language. Why, then, might we not, in the supposed case of a * In this translation, I have not only omitted several sentences in the original, which did not appear to bear upon my present object, but have not scrupled to interpolate a few clauses of my own, which J thought might be use- ful in conveying the author’s meaning more clearly to an English reader. The sense of the passage is rendered, to the best of my judgment, with perfect fide- lity. BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 35 a blind and deaf pupil, avail ourselves of the assistance of the latter, which, if not visible to his eye, would be, at least, tan- gible to. his hand. It is only extending farther the use of a species of signs already practised between Massizu and me, when, during the darkness of night, he sees by his own hands whatever mine would express to him. Why should not the blind and, deaf pupil be taught to converse in the same man-. ner, during the light of day? . “ Ah! if the experiment I should wish, to. make were to prove not altogether useless ; if, as, I have already done. for the deaf and dymb, I should be. the; instrument, of bestowing a mind on this still, more unfortunate object, I should myself en- joy a degree of happiness greater than any which he could pos- sibly derive from the success of my labours! “ My illustrious. predecessor had the: boldness to think, that even. this case, if it) should. be realised, would not, present un- ssurmountable obstacles; to an instructor. The following is an outline of the plan. upon. which, he told me, it was his inten- tion to proceed, “ An alphabet of polished steel was to be. employed! as the materials of his nomenclature for sensible, objects, and for those actions which might be brought under the cognizance of. the sense of. Touch. He hoped to be able to familiarise his pupil with these characters, so as to devolve upon his hands the of- fice of his eyes; and, for this purpose, he proposed to make ~ him feel the object, with one hand, while he was learning to distinguish its name. with the other. His inventive genius would doubtless have led him, in the course of his experi- ments, to whatever other means were necessary for the attain- ment of his end. _“ Tam perfectly aware, that difficulties would immediately present themselves at every step 5 for, how would it be possi- E2 ’ ble, 36° “ACCOUNT OF A BOY ble, without any intercourse either by the eye or by the ear, to establish, in the pupil’s mind, the connection between the object and its sign? “I apprehend, it would be necessary here to avail ourselves of some of his animal instincts ; to withhold, for example, the objects of his desires and wants, till he should recollect their names, and exhibit their characters *. This first step would perhaps be followed by a second; that of teaching him to distinguish the qualities and modes of ob- jects. Colours and sounds would, of course, be excluded from our lessons ; but the forms of bodies, which fall under the province of Touch, might be easily impressed on his memo- ry; and upon this basis, what should prevent us from proceed- ing to rear a metaphysical structure? If those qualities which strike the sense of Sight have gradually led the deaf and dumb to the knowledge of things intellectual and moral, why should not the qualities about which the sense of Touch is conversant, be made the channel to the same sort-ef information? In- stead of speaking to the eye, we have only to speak to the hand. In truth, the whole system of instruction explained in the following work, might be adapted to our new pupil, by presenting to him, in’relievo, the various delineations and dia- grams by ne it is illustrated ; those slight changes being § samciin * In the case of Mrrcuext, the difficulties here alluded to would probably be experienced in a comparatively small degree, in consequence of the previous use of those significant pressures on his forehead, of which his sister has taught him to comprehend the meaning. If this should turn out to be the fact, she has. al- ready got over, by her own ingenuity, the first and most arduous step in the whole process of his education. Mr Warpror takes notice, in one of his communications, of ‘his extreme do- cility, and of his obedience to the commands of his sister, who, during his stay in London, ‘* was his constant companion and guide.” ‘ It was astonishing (he adds) how readily she could communicate to him, by signs, her wishes.” BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 37. made in the method, which the circumstances of the case would readily suggest. This pupil, (as has often happened in the education of the deaf and dumb), would soon become the master of his teacher; and every step which was gained, would of itself, point out the next which was to be taken *. ““ May such a system of instruction remain always matter of pure speculation! Gon forbid, that a child should ever be brought into the world, without any substitute but the hand for the eye and for the ear! But as, unfortunately, such a deviation of nature from her usual course, is an event but too possible, let us con- sider beforehand what may be done, by way of remedy or of alleviation. To restore a Man to society, to his family, and to himself, would be an enjoyment too exquisite, and a conquest too proud, to permit us to abandon the undertaking in de- spair.” For a comment on the above observations, I must refer to the work at large. They who read it with attention, and who enter fully into the author’s views, will be at no loss to per- ceive the different modifications which his plan will require, ui * Tt is somewhat surprising, that the Abbé Sicarp should have overlooked the aid which the sense of Smelling seems so peculiarly calculated to furnish, for rearing his proposed Metaphysical Structure. Some of the most significant words relating to the Human Mind, (the word sagacity, for instance), are borrowed from this very sense; and the conspicuous place which its sensations occupy in the poetical language of all nations, shew how easily and naturally they ally themselves with the refined operations of the Fancy, and with the moral emo- tions of the Heart. The infinite variety of modifications, besides, of which they are susceptible, might furnish useful resources, in the way of association, for prompting the memory, where it stood in need of assistance. One of the best schools for the education of such a pupil, would probably be a well-arranged Botanical Garden. 88 ACCOUNT OF A BOY in applying it to such a case as that of Mircners. His fun- damental principles are general, and deeply philosophical ; being, all of them, deduced from a careful study of the steps by which children gradually and insensibly acquire the use of oral speech ; and of consequence, they are equally applicable to every species of signs by which one mind can hold inter- course with another. In the mean time, I beg leave to add to the foregoing quotation, the account given by Sicarp of his first lesson to Massreu, as it touches on a very natural mistake, which, with a few, if any exceptions, has misled all those who have hitherto undertaken the education of the deaf and dumb ; and which, in case any attempt should be made for the farther improvement of Mircue.1, it may be worth while to point out, by way of caution, to his instructors. “* My first lesson was employed upon the alphabet. I had not yet reflected on the imperfection of this method, which, from the first outset, counteracted that analytical procedure which is natural to the mind, and by which alone the mind can be guided to the use of its faculties. What information, in reality, (as I afterwards began to question myself), can the un- derstanding possibly derive from a series of abstract characters, arranged in a particular order by chance or caprice, and to which nothing equivalent can be exhibited in Nature? But it was thus that my illustrious Master began, and every step in his system seemed to me then indispensable and sacred.” In a subsequent passage, M. Srcarp takes notice still more explicitly, of the absurdity of teaching a pupil in such circum- stances to read or to copy isolated letters, in that order which our alphabet exhibits. ‘“ What interest, (he asks), could Mas- sizu have felt about characters signifying nothing, and occupy- ing, without any conceivable reason, a certain place in an arbi- trary series? Accordingly, I directed his attention at once to words, BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 89 words, without attempting to explain to him that the elements of these words were letters, and still less that these letters were consonants and vowels. Indeed, how was it possible for him to annex any notion to the technical terms of grammar, when che was not yet in possession of a language, and when he had only a few fugitive notions to fix and to express ?” In these extracts, M. Srcarp describes, with great candour, the process of thought by which he was conducted to (what I consider as by far the most important of the many improve- ments which he has introduced into his art) the simple, yet luminous idea, of copying his plan of instruction, not from the example of a schoolmaster teaching a child to read, but from the example of the child itself, in acquiring the use of its mother-tongue. Of these two methods, the former, it must be owned, is by far the more obvious; and where mere articula- tion is the chief object of the teacher, it will probably be found the more easy and effectual in practice. But Sicarp’s aim was of a different, and of a higher nature ;—not to astonish the vulgar by the sudden conversion of a dumb child into a speak- ing automaton ; but, by affording scope to those means which Nature herself has provided for the gradual evolution of our intellectual powers, to convért his pupil into a rational and moral being. The details of his lessons, accordingly, are not more interesting to the few, who may attempt the education of such unfortunate exceptions as Massizu or Mrrcuerz, than to all those who delight in tracing to their elementary principles the materials of human knowledge, and in marking the first openings of the infant mind *. In * See the Note at the end of the Memoir. 40 ACCOUNT OF A BOY In order to complete the history of Mircurtr, I am aware that a variety of curious points still remain to be ascertained ; and, if I had not been anxious to bring it forward to public no- tice, even in its present imperfect state, without any farther delay, I should have been inclined to retain it in my own hands, till my information on the subject should have been a little more ample. My wish, I must acknowledge, is, That some plan could be devised for removing the young man to Edinburgh ; or rather (as he has been accustomed hitherto to enjoy the air and the freedom of the country), to some quiet residence in the neighbourhood ;—to some situation, in short, where an opportunity would be afforded for examining and re- cording, under the eye of this Society, the particulars of a case, to which it is to be hoped, that nothing similar will again-oc- cur in our times. Something, it would appear from Dr Gor- pon’s statement, may perhaps, at a future period, be attempted for the extraction of his cataracts,—in which event (should the operation succeed), I need not say, what an accession would at once be made to his own enjoyments, and to his va- lue as an object of philosophical curiosity :—But even on the supposition that this hope should be disappointed, a subject of inquiry not less interesting than any question connected with the Theory of Vision, will still remain,—to ascertain how far it might be possible, by following out the Abbé Srcarv’s hints, to cultivate the intellectual and moral faculties of a human be- ing, destitute of the two senses which are the ordinary vehicles of all our acquired knowledge. Nor do I apprehend that this experiment would be attended with such insuperable difficul- ties BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 41 ties as might at first be suspected ; as I am assured by the best authority, that his eldest sister, whose good sense has already devised some imperfect modes of communication with her un- fortunate brother, possesses talents which fully qualify her to carry into execution any plan that may be proposed for his farther improvement. | His age, at present, only exceeds by two years, that of Stcarp’s celebrated pupil Massrev, when his education was begun ; and at that period, Massizv, though he had the inestimable advantage of possessing the sense of Sight, seems to have had his rational faculties as imperfeetly develo- ped as those of Mircnext. - Imust, at the same time, observe here, in justice to myself, that my expectations of the future improvement of the latter, are’ by no means 'so sanguine as those which the Abbé Sicarp: would probably have indulged in similar circumstances. Were it possible, indeed, to place him under the immediate tuition of that eminent man) I have little doubt that much more would be accomplished than:appears to us to be practicable; but the difference between his ‘situation and that of Massiru is so im- mense, as to render all our conclusions founded on the history of the one, quite inapplicable (except with great modifications) to the case of the other. . The slowness with which the sense of Touch proceeds; in collecting information concerning the exter- nal world, when compared with the rapid perceptions of the Eye, would, on the most favourable supposition, retard infinitely the rate of his progress,in acquiring even the first elements of know- ledge. This, however, furnishes no argument against the attempt; nor'does it even tend to diminish the value of the results to which. it might lead. . The slightest. addition that could be made to, his present range of ideas, by means of an iaproyed system of anWoad VA: onimisoh oom Hao ei L of botemn : Signs.3 pill’ ! asl 40 dnet oft of coijsaubo t [ fh: ee oe hebyols 42 ACCOUNT OF A BOY” signs; and still more, the slightest developement that could be given to any of his dormant powers, might afford not less im-. portant data for philosophical speculation than the most ex- tensive acquisitions. Havixc mentioned more than once the name of Massrev, ‘I think it proper to subjoin to the preceding remarks, the de- scription of him given by Srcarp, at the time when their ac- quaintance commenced. It may serve to shew, that the idea of attempting the education of Mrronexn, even at the age of sixteen, is not altogether chimerical. . thoes “ The reader will easily form an idea of the character and manners of Massrev, when he is told, that he was born in a cottage, six leagues from Bordeaux; and that his relations. (who were the only individuals with whom he ever had any intercourse) had not even taken the trouble to communicate to him the slightest information about material objects. His child- hood had been spent in tending a flock ; and all his ideas were confined within the narrow circle which had fallen under his. random observation. Massrev was a Man of the Woods; untine- tured with any habits but such as were purely animal; astonished and terrified at every thing. In coming to Bordeaux, he had believed that he was only changing his place of abode; and that he would be employed there in keeping another flock : but it was towards the beloved scene which he had left, and which had witnessed the first sports of his infancy, that his imagination was incessantly turned. In every thing he saw, he apprehended some danger ; in every step he was directed to take, he suspected some snare. How far was this simple boy, accustomed as he was to consider himself on a level with. the animals entrusted to -his care, from dreaming that he was about to be raised by education to the rank of Man! His clouded BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 48 clouded and inexpressive countenance ; his doubtful and shift- ing eye; his silly and suspicious air,—all seemed to announce, that Massrev was incapable of any instruction. But it was not Jong till he began to inspire his ‘Teacher with the most flatter- ing hopes.” bidisoatitiey lchatines, entirely from all conjectural specula- tions with respect to Mircuex.’s possible attainments in future, the particulars already in our possession afford data for some important conclusions concerning the capacities of the Human Mind, considered in contrast with the instincts of the Brutes. For these I do not think that the Transactions of this Society afford a proper place ; and I have accordingly, all along, confi- ned myself to the detail of facts, leaving the philosophical inferences to which they may lead for future consideration. _ Nor is it, in this point of view alone, that his case is an ob- ject of curiosity at the present-moment. The examination of his powers of external perception (considered merely as articles of natural history *) promise, under the peculiar circumstances of Of Mav _tees Foi ley. isi wai¢gae, Beni iyo joa. i900) ol asa his Aus. = : ® r pen sin quoting shere a very curious. pris of Mr ‘Warprop's, ‘with wespeet to the jpartiglities and dislikes conceived by Mircnext, in conse- quence of the moral expression, (if I may be allowed,such a phrase), which he seems tohave attached to particular sensations of smell. ‘ When a stranger(says he) approached him, he eagerly began to touch some,part,of his body, common- ly taking hold of his arm, which he held near his nose; and after two or three strong inspirations through his nostrils, appeared decided in his opinion. If it happened to be unfavourable, he suddenly went to a distance with the appear- ance of disgust ; if favourable, he shewed a disposition to become more intimate, and expressed, by his countenance, more or less satisfaction.” 44 ACCOUNT OF A BOY liis condition, a field of study, of which, if it has ever occurred before in the annals of our species, no scientific use appears to have been made. How much the simultaneous exercise of our different senses obstructs the perfection of each, may be infer- red from the delicate touch, and acute hearing of the blind. It remains to be ascertained, to what degrees of improvement, the perceptions of Feeling, of Taste, and of Smell, may attain in an individual possessed of these senses alone *. * In one of the communications which I have received, it is said, that «* Mir- cnett has been known to follow the footsteps of another person for two miles, guided merely by the sense of smelling.” As this circumstance, however, is sta- ted only on report, I have not introduced it into the text; and mention it here chiefly in the hope of obtaining more precise and authentic information upon the subject. It would be desirable also to Jearn something more circumstantial and speci- fic, both with respect to the discriminating powers of his palate, and his predi- lections in the article of food. Neque inutile foret, neque ab honestissima sapientia alienum, novisse quo- modo hic miserandus, jam puber factus, se habuerit quod ad res venereas ; hunc appetitum an senserit necne; qua forma, quibus indiciis se prodiderit ; foemina- rum an virorum consortio adolescenti magis placeat; socii sexum an olfactu dig- noscere videatur. Hee et similia bene multa, dictu parum decora, scitu vero non indigna, si modé observandi copia data fuerit, unicuique in.mentem venient cui Natures Humane scientia est cordi, quique infelicissimum et pené singularem illius statum rité contemplabitur. BORN BLIND AND DEAr. 45 I shall only add farther, before concluding this memoir, that, in submitting it to the Royal Society, I was partly influenced by the hope, that it may possibly be the means of securing a decent provision for the individual to whom it relates ;—per- haps, also, a competent independence for those members of his family on whom he has been so long a burdensome and expen- sive charge. I allude, not merely to his mother, whose claims ~ must immediately force themselves on the notice of every one, but more particularly to his eldest sister, on whom the duties of superintending and educating him have chiefly devolved from his infancy. To the painful and incessant attentions which his helpless condition required, the best years of her life have been hitherto devoted ; and so essential is the continua- tion of the same affectionate cares to his comfortable existence, that, independently of what is due to her own singular merits, | she must, of necessity, be included in any arrangement, of which his improvement and happiness are the principal ob- jects. For the purposes already mentioned in this paper, the funds of the Society, I am well aware, are altogether inade- quate ; but if they shall be pleased to recommend the business to the consideration of their Council, I have no doubt, that something may be suggested for the accomplishment of a mea- sure, which, even if it should fail in adding materially to the stock of useful knowledge, would at least prevent the regrets which might, afterwards be felt, if so rare an opportunity for philosophical. observation and experiment should be suffered to pass before our eyes, without any attempt being made to gurn it to the advantage of science. NOTE, 46 ACCOUNT OF A Roy NOTE, p. 39. I wave been led to insist at some length on the philosophi- cal merits of Sicarp’s plan of instruction for the Dumb, not only because his fundamental principles admit of an obvious application (mutatis mutandis) to the case of Mrrcxert ; but be- cause his book does not seem to have attracted so much notice in this country as might have been expected, among those who have devoted the eshves to the same profession. Of this no stronger proof can be produced, than the stress which has been laid by most of our Teachers, on the power of articulation, which can rarely, if ever, repay, to a person born deaf, the time and pains necessary for the acquisition. This error was, no doubt, owing, in the first instance, to a very natural, though very gross mistake, which confounds the gift of Speech with the gift of Reason ; but I believe it has been prolonged and con- Fa in England, not a little, by the common union of this branch of ¢r ae with the more lucrative one, of professing to cure organical impediments. To teach the dumb to speak, be- sides, (although, in fact, entitled to rank only alittle higher than the art of training starlings and parrots), will always ap- pear to the multitude, a far more wonderful feat of ingenuity, than to unfold silently the latent capacities of the understand- ing ;—an effect which is not, like the other, palpable to sense, and of which but a few are able either to ascertain the exist- ence, or to appreciate the value. It is not surprising, there- fore, that even those Teachers who are perfectly aware of the truth of what I have now stated, should persevere in the diffi- cult, but comparatively useless attempt, of imparting to their pupils. BORN BLIND AND DEAT. 47 pupils that species of accomplishment, which is to furnish the only scale upon which the success of their own labours is ever likely to be measured by the public. The example of Dr Wauus of Oxford, the most eminent English author who has yet turned his attention to this study, has probably had considerable influence in misleading his suc- cessors. His thoughts (as he tells us himself) were originally led to it by his analytical inquiries concerning the mechanical formation of articulate sounds, a subject which he appears.to have very deeply and successfully meditated ; and. accordingly, the first step which he took with his two most distinguished pupils (Pornam and Wuaxey) was to teach them ¢o speak. He also informs us, that he had in various instances applied the same principles, in curing organical impediments. _ Indeed, it was evidently on this branch of his art, that he valued himself chiefly as an instructor of the dumb. _ In cultivating the intellec- tual powers of these, his success does not seem to have been such as to admit of comparison with that of the Abbé Srcarp ; and it is remarkable, that the pupils, of whose progress he speaks most highly, are a few with whom he carried on all his intercourse by means of writing, without wasting any of their time in communicating to them the gift of oral speech. “ A- “ lios aliquot, surdos, loquelam docere non agressus sum, sed “ solummodo ut res scriptas mediocriter intelligerent, suaque “ sensa scripto quadantenus insinuarent : Qui tempore non lon- “ go progressus e0s fecerint, rerumque plurimarum notitiam ac- “ quisiverint, multo ultra qaam quod putabatur fieri posse a quo- * quam in eorum circumstantiis posito; fuerintque plane capaces acquirendi (si plenius exculti) ultiorem cognitionem que pos- “ sit scripto impertiri.” See Waxxisu Opera Mathemat. vol. iii. p: 696. See also his letter to Mr Brvertey, in the Transac- tions of the Royal Society of London for 1698.—I am obliged MOS 2 5 to 48 ACCOUNT OF A BOY to quote from the Latin version, not having the Philosophical Transactions at hand. After having thus paid the tribute of my sincere respect to the enlightened and benevolent exertions of a celebrated fo- reigner, I feel myself called on to lay hold of the only oppor- tunity that may occur to me, of rescuing from oblivion the name of a Scottish writer, whose merits have been strange- ly overlooked both by his contemporaries and by his suc- cessors. The person I allude to is Grorce Datearno, who, more than a hundred and thirty years ago, was led by his own sagacity, to adopt, @ priori, the same general conclu- sion concerning the education of the dumb, of which the expe- rimental discovery, and the happy application, have, in our times, reflected such merited lustre on the name of Srcarp. TI mentioned Da1carno formerly, in a note annexed to the Phi- losophy of the Human Mind, as the author of a very ingenious tract entitled Ars Signorum, from which it appears indisputably that he was the precursor of Bishop Wimx1ns im his specula- tions concerning a Real Character, and a Philosophical Lan- guage ; and it now appears to me equally clear, upon a farther acquaintance with the short fragments which he has left be- hind him, that, if he did not lead the way to the attempt made by Dr Wazuis to teach the dumb to speak, he had conceived views with respect to the means of instructing them, far more profound and comprehensive than any we meet with in the works of that learned writer, prior to the date of Darcarno’s publications. On his ‘claims in’ these two instances I forbear to enlarge at present; but I cannot deny myself the satisfaction of transcribing a few paragraphs, in justification of what I have already stated, with respect to the remarkable coincidence between some of his theoretical deductions, BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 49 deductions, and the practical results of the French academi- cian. “ IT conceive there might be successful addresses made to a dumb child even in its cradle, when he begins—risu cognoscere matrem,; if the mother or nurse had but as nimble a hand, as commonly they have a tongue. For instance, I doubt not but the words, hand, foot, dog, cat, hat, &c. written fair, and as of- ten presented to the deaf child’s eye, pointing from the words to the things, and vice versa, as the blind child hears them spo- ken, would be known and remembered as soon by the one as _ the other. And as I think the eye to be as docile as the ear ; so neither see I any reason, but the hand might be made as -tractable an organ as the tongue ; and as soon brought to form, if not fair, at least legible characters, as the tongue to imitate and echo back articulate sounds.” .......... ed “ The difficulties of learning to read, on the common plan, are so great, that one may justly wonder how young ones come to get over them. ..... Now, the deaf child, under his mother’s tuition, passes securely by all these rocks and quicksands. The distinction of letters, their names, their powers, their order, the dividing words into syllables, and of them again making words, to which may be added Tone and Accent; none of these puzzling niceties hinder his progress....... It is true, after he has past the discipline of the nursery, and comes to learn grammatically, then he must begin to learn to know let- ters written, by their figure, number, and order, &c. &c. The same author elsewhere observes, that “ the soul can ex- ert her powers, by the ministry of any of the senses: And, there- fore, when she is deprived of her principal Secretaries the Eye and the Ear; then she must be contented with the service of her lackeys and scullions, the other senses; which are no less true and faithful. to their mistress, than the eye and the ear ; but not so quick for dispatch.” Vou. VII. G I 50 ACCOUNT OF A BOY I shall only add one other sentence, from which my readers will be enabled, without any comment of mine, to perceive with what sagacity and success, this very original thinker, had anticipated some of the most refined experimental conclusions. of a more enlightened age. “ My design is not to give a methodical system of gramma- tical rules ; but only such general directions, whereby an indus- trious Tutor may bring his deaf Pupil to the vulgar use and érs of a language ; that so he may be the more capable of re- ceiving instruction in the 0 ov: from the rules of grammar, when his judgment is ripe for that study: Or, more plainly ; I intend to bring the way of teaching a deaf man to read and write, as near as possible, to that of teaching young ones to: speak and understand their mother-tongue.” In prosecution of this general idea, he has treated, in one very short chapter, of a Deaf Man’s Dictionary; and in ano- ther, of @ Grammar for Deaf Persons ; both of them contain- ing (under the disadvantages of a style uncommonly pedantic and quaint) a variety of precious hints, from which, if I do not deceive myself, useful practical lights might be derived, not only by such as may undertake the instruction of such pupils as Mrrenevt or Massteu, but by all who have any concern in the tuition of children during the first stage of their educa- tion. . The work from which these quotations are taken, is a very small volume, entitled “ Didascalocophus, or, The Deaf and “ Dumb Man’s Tutor, printed at the Theater in Oxford, 1680.” As I had never happened to see the slightest reference made to it by any subsequent writer, I was altogether ignorant of its existence, when a copy of it, purchased upon a London stall, was a few years ago sent to me by a friend, who, amidst a mul- tiplicity of more pressing engagements and pursuits, has never lost BORN BLIND AND DEA?. 31 lost sight of the philosophical studies of his early years. I have been able to learn nothing of the author, but what is contained in the following slight notice, which I transcribe from Anruony Woop. “ The reader may be pleased to know, that one Grorcr Dacarno, a Scot, wrote a book, entitled, Ars Signorum, &c. London, 1660. This book, before it went to press, the author communicated to Dr Witxins, who from thence taking a hint of greater matter, carried it on, and brought it up to that which you see extant. This Datcarno was born at Old Aberdeen, and bred in the University at New Aber- deen ; taught a private grammar school with good success for about thirty years together, in the parishes of S. Michael and S. Mary Mag. in Oxford ; wrote also, Didascalocophus, or, the Deaf and Dumb Man’s Tutor; and dying of a fever, on the 28th of August 1687, aged sixty or more, was buried in the north body of the church of S..Mary Magdalen.” (Ath. Oxon. ~ vol. ii. p. 506-7.) The obscurity:in which Datcarno lived, and the complete oblivion into which his name has fallen, are not a little wons derful, when we consider that he mentions among the number of his friends Dr Sera Warp, Bishop of Sarum ; Dr Jon Wit- KINS, Bishop of Chester; and ‘Dr Jouw Waxuis, Professor of Astronomy at Oxford. It is still more wonderful, that no no- tice of him is taken in the works either of Winxis or of Wat- 118, both of whom must have derived some very important aids from his speculations. __ This ‘unfairness on the part. of Winxins, has not escaped the animadversion of one of his own biographers.“ In the prefa- tory epistle (he observes) to the Essay towards a Real Charac- ter, Dr Witxins mentions several persons who assisted him in this work, particularly Wioveusy, Ray, and Dr Witu1aM Lioyp and others ; but. it is remarkable, that he does not men- waive | G2 tion 52 - ACCOUNT OF A BOY tion Datcarno, and the more, because Dr Witxkrns’s own name is printed in the margin of King Cuarues II.’s letter pre- fixed to Dauearno’s book, as one of those who informed his Majesty of Dalgarno’s design, and approved it, as a thing that might be of singular use to facilitate an intercourse between people of different languages ; which prevailed with his Majes- ty to grant his said letters of recommendation to so many, of his subjects, especially of the Clergy, as were sensible of the defectuousness of art in this particular.” Biog. Britan., Art. Witxrys *.. That Datcarno’s suggestions with respect to the Education of the Dumb, were not altogether useless to Dr Wats, will, I think, be readily admitted by those who take the trouble to compare his letter to Mr Brverty (published eighteen years after Datcarno’s treatise) with his Tractatus de Loquela, pu- blished in 1653. In this letter some valuable remarks are to be found on the method of leading the dumb to the significa- tion of words ; and yet, the name of Datcarno is not once mentioned to his correspondent. If some of the details and digressions in. this note should be censured, as foreign to the principal design of the foregoing memoir, I can only plead in excuse, my anxiety to do justice, even * In Graicer’s Biographical History of England, mention is made of a still earlier publication than the Ars Stgnorum, entitled, “‘ The Universal Character, by which all Nations in the World may understand one another's conceptions, reading out of one common Writing their own Tongue. By Cave Back, Rec- tor of St Helen’s, in Ipswich, 1657.” This book I have never seen. | , The name-of Dalgarno (or Dalgarus, as: it has been sometimes written) ‘is not altogether unknown, on the Continent. His Ars Signorum is alluded to by Leisnirz on various occasions, and also by Fonrenetee in the Eloge of Lur- nitz. His ideas with respect to the education of the Dumb, do not seem to have attracted any notice whatever. The truth is; ‘they were much’ too refined and enlightened to be duly appretiated at the period when he wrote. BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 53 even at the distance of a century, to. the memory of an ingeni- ous man, neglected by his contemporaries, and already in dan- ger of being totally forgotten by posterity. To those whose curiosity may lead them to study his book, the originality of his conceptions, and the obvious application of which some of his principles admit to the peculiarities of the case now before- us, will of themselves suggest a sufficient apology. : APPENDIX, Te ae) oe at Say Ps Laks st hel a ’ ahd aa : ‘ : i“ 4 . S 1 Aa press ttle 2 ieee - ‘ Sa Hi shh see : ' AE itl le - ser ; is df sa Sau o h ons Pe.) : ae Be As: erie ct ts saint sfibinfalay Moai ao é ‘ Wha er. hk er tie ; a u ain. nave iy arya 10% M chi >t ae a \ { av a ; aye, gO ig tie vey bai pete a > * ; . is pec ’ ° . or ea ‘, os Ace F aha aa py 2 ’ on ae Py 4 a a 3 APPENDIX, containing some additional Commu- nications relative to James Mircue.t. No. Ji, Extract of a Letter from Dr Gorvon to Mr Srewart. Edinburgh, March 30. 1812. Br: iN few days after you returned to the country, I wrote to a friend of mine near Forres, putting several queries re- specting Mircuext, which I requested him to get answered by Miss Mircuett if possible. I wished in peeianias to be satis- fied as to the lad’s behaviour on his father’s death, as what I had myself seen of his conduct at the funeral, had led me to differ from Mr Guewnie’s information on this point. From Miss Mrrcuetu directly, I have obtained the following curious particulars : At his sister’s request, Mircuett was allowed to touch his father’s body. As soon as he felt it, he shrunk away. This was the first time he had ever touched a dead human bo- dy. He has been seen amusing himself with a dead fowl ; placing it repeatedly on its legs, and. laughing when it fell. He has not shewn any signs of grief in consequence of his father’s death. When 56 ACCOUNT OF A BOY When a tailor was brought to make a suit of mournings for him, the boy took him into the apartment where his father had died, stretched his own head and neck backwards, pointed to the bed, and then conducted him to the church-yard, to the grave in which his father had been interred. Being lately very ill, he was put into the same bed where his father had died. He would not lie a moment in it, but be- came quite peaceable when removed to another. On one occasion, shortly after his father’s death, discovering that his mother was unwell, and in bed, he was observed to weep. Three months after the death of his father, a clergyman be- ing in the house, on a Sunday evening, he pointed to his fa- ~ ther’s Bible, and then made a sign that the family should kneel. Lately, his mother being from home, his sister allayed the anxiety he shewed for her return, by laying his head gently down on a pillow, once for each night his mother was still to be away; implying, that he would sleep so many times before her return *. Whilst * It would appear that this is the sign which Miss Mrrcuett usually employs on similar occasions ; and the ready interpretation of it by her brother, implies, on his part, no inconsiderable a share of shrewdness and of reflection. I copy the following parallel incident from a paper of Mr Warprop’s now before me. (D. 5.) “ When his new clothes were all made, I solicited his father not to allow him to put them on, until I was present. It was signified to him accordingly, that in two days he should have them, This was done by shutting his eyes, and bending down his head twice, in order to intimate to him, that he must first haye two sleeps,” BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 57 Whilst he was last in London, he happened to be in the house of a friend of his father’s, who was in the habit of smoking; and a pipe being given him, he smoked it, and ae much delighted. Some little time ago, a gentle- man came on a visit to Ardclach, who was also in the habit of smoking, and having tobacco, wished for a pipe. Miss Mrr- cHELL gave the boy a halfpenny, and permitted him to smell the tobacco. He understood her signs; went out to a shoe- maker’s house in the neighbourhood, where pipes were to be had, and returned with one only in his hand. They suspected that he had another about him,: and» giving him to understand as much, he at last unbuttoned his waistcoat, and, laughing heartily, brought out the second pipe. The Sunday after this occurrence, when his. sister gave him a halfpenny, as usual, in church, to put into the poors’-box, he immediately placed the halfpenny between his teeth, like a: pipe, and laughed ; but his sister checking him, he dropped it:into the box. He is still fond of the trick of locking people into the onde or the stable. The patron of the parish, Mr Dunsar Bron, (a gentleman who, I have reason to believe, has exceeded all others in acts of substantial kindness to the Mircnext family), happening lately to visit Ardclach, young Mrrcuext contrived to make him a prisoner in this manner for a few minutes, laugh- ing and jumping about all the while. On this particular occa- bie it was noticed, that he applied. his eye to an aperture in the door of the stable, as if to observe the motions of the person within. But although my friend writes me, that the other day upon holding out his hand to Mircuexz, the boy took hold of it; it cannot be conceived, that his sight should have suddenly so much improved, as to enable him to see any object in a dark stable, through a hole in the door, without . the improvement being extremely obvious in other instances. “i #$$|. # i No. IL 58 ACCOUNT OF A BOY IG.) TE A Series of Questions respecting James Mircuety, proposed by Mr Guewniz, and answered by Miss Janz Mircuetx *. Q. 1. Did Mr Warnror operate on the = i, ? or on the ears also ? A. Mr Warprop operated only on the ‘ight eye. Q. 2. Were the drums of the ears plied sends the first or the second visit to London ? A. The drums of the ears were pierced during the first visit; the one by Mr Astiey Cooper, the other by the -“ ~ Saunpers of the London Dispensary. Q. 3. Was it the case, that a musical instrument was play- ing in the room when his ears were pierced ? and did he at- tend to it ? A. Some days after his ears were pierced, in a friend’s house, he applied his ear to a violin, and the sound seemed to afford him neon t. A. * Although some of the information contained in this paper has been already anticipated in the communications of Dr Gorpon and of Mr Warpnop, I have thought it proper to insert it here at full length ; on account not only of the new light which it throws on various very interesting and important points, but of the high authority which it derives from Miss Mircuexr’s name. (D.S.) + The following particulars are mentioned by Mr Warpror with re- spect to the state of Mrrcuext’s deafness at the time when he saw him in London. (D.S.) ayclo ..... “ When a ring of keys was given to him, he seized them with great avidity, and tried each separately, by suspending it loosely between two of his fingers, BORN: BLIND AND DEAF. 59 Q. 4. Does the shew a strong desire to examine all objects ‘by feeling? bo A. He does: small ajert he ilies, to his teeth, and. feels with the tip of his tongue : lergar objects he feels with his fin- “ carefully. ‘ . Q. 5. Is he much gratified with a new object ? eng A. Some objects do not seem to attract his attention ; others do; and, where there is any mechanism, he endeavours, by handling them, to find it out: he discovers a particular fond- ness for locks and keys Q. 6. Does he discover any ipicfontmad toi, the handling of smooth, rough, or pointed things? _ A. If he does any, it is to smooth objects ailied he worn a bit of rough wood, he endeavours to smooth it with his teeth, or causes the boy who. attends him to smooth it with a knife. - Q.7., Is he fond of bodily exertion? ) Aw He inemtsemelgforid, of running, walking, and riding. nocd oved enaekd wobitiy WH Rirneas: wyniinge How guQbeBh eer micedw ad, dual..¢ edasland! a ot, oF ranhsisass ob b sph Pia ott LA Ae vie ‘ aiald Jeon AAI OF Sige ona irdeto, sSeesly vent after tingling all of them anne rie ah ‘APSE he, generally, selected one from the others, ch ses o please ae most. This, indeed, was one of his tes favourite amusements, and it was surprising how long it would arrest his attention, and with what ad plates would on all occasions renew it. ‘Mr box (a Fre arias can this circumstance, brought to him a musical snuff- e nin BA ue nall musical instrument, which played airs ur ma OH s : sod placed peapigiins his teeth. This seemed not ouly Fea. Ay o afford bi m exquisite delight, and his father and sis- we cond were’ pil ieiankae, r bs hua had never seen him so mueh in- terested on any former occasion. - Whilst the instrument ¢ontinued to play, he kept it closely between his teeth, and even when the notes were ended, he con- inued to ee a La f°, his mouth, and to exeinine it minutely with his fins ers eX] ressing i Raat and fy his countenance great “curiosity.” id eosles a by es Bee dud ¢ edeontroansgs old OA et aia yod , 60 ACCOUNT OF A BOY Q. 8. Does he discover any sense of danger ? A. He discovers a sense of danger from fire, water, and sharp instruments. Q.9. Is it necessary to follow him, to keep him from harm ? A. It is only necessary to follow him, to prevent him from wandering. Q. 10. Bins he the knowledge of the use of things ? A. He knows the use of all common things, and is pleased when the use of any thing with which he is not acquainted is communicated to him. Q. 11. Has he learned to do any kind of work ? A. He has not; further than to assist any of the farm-servants, for whom he may have conceived an attachment, in any work in which they may be engaged; particularly in cleaning the stable. He has endeavoured to repair breaches in the farm houses; and has attempted to build small houses with turf, leaving small openings resembling windows. Means have been used to teach him to make baskets; but he wants application to finish any thing. Q. 12. Does her go from home? and is he fond of doing so ? A. His greatest pleasure seems to consist in wandering from home ; but he always returns to his meals. Q. 13. Is he uneasy when separated from his friends or at- tendants ? A. He discovers much uneasiness when aeatariede from his friends, but does not, now, discover uneasiness when he chan- ges his attendants, though he did, very early in life. Q. 14. Does he love to associate with boys, and engage in play ? A. He never associates with boys, nor discovers any incli- nation to join in their amusements ; but sometimes wishes the boy BORN BLIND) AND DEAL. 61 boy who attends him, to assist him in floating objects on the water, &c. He is, however, fond of young children, and takes them up in his arms. -Q.15. Has he any uneasy feeling of his unfortunate situa- tion ? _A. He is sensible that his|sight i is imperfect, but lees not dathan any uneasy feeling of his situation. ' Q. 16. Is he sensible of loud sounds ? or prvissrse: 2.) ‘ A. OF, wery loud sounds he. is, and seems. came at the time.. ont ~Q17., rane 7 pendanteriry the. distinction i ranks i in socie- ty? |, rh dyhoel Mhritertibowrvy «@ 5xR res _ A. He prefers persons. prudent well eth to ins who . jare not ;-and would not, willingly eat any food in the kitchen. I Q.18.. Has he the sense of ridicule? _ Os to ethos . A. In some degree he no doubt has ;) for, veaees he es, pleasure in locking the door on people, and confining them ; _and, if treated in the same manner. sian rss sede but if too much.teazed, is irritated. . Q 19. Has he any devotional feelings >... ee oiaeer ales m . He cannot possibly have any ; but sits asl in, ahaa, ee ti ey otltopd vin -.Q.20. Has he the|sense a hit Ap sain oulAs'Eléundoubtedl yihaap and ifigentle means ave used to. cn _ him sensible. of his having done wrong, he shews sorrow ; but if | spi int treated, i is irritated. ee en) te cee a anes as No. III. Mme kkle 62 - ACCOUNT OF A BOY No. III. Tue foregoing sheets were not only printed but cast off be- fore the following letter reached me. I subjoin it, without any comment, to the papers on the same subject which I have already laid before the Society ; and have only to return my thanks to the Author, for the trouble he has sojudiciously ta- ken in recording a variety of minute details, which, to-a su- perficial observer, may appear of trifling importance, but which will be considered in a very different light by all who are able to perceive, how strongly they bear on some of the most interesting questions which relate to the characteristical endowments es the Human Mind. © Solitary as Mrrcuett is in the midst of society, and ‘confined, in his intercourse with the material world, within the narrowest conceivable limits’; what a contrast does he exhibit,—in those rudiments of a ra- tional and improvable nature, which we may trace even in his childish occupations™ and pastimes; and more particularly, in that stock of knowledge, scanty as it is, which he has been prompted to acquire by the impulse of his own spontaneous curiosity,—to the most sagacious of the lower animals, though surrounded with all the arts of civilized Man, and in the fullest possession of all the powers of external perception! — Letter BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 63 ~~ Letter from Dr Gorvon fo Mr Srewarr. epee IMI Ae ToeD Joayve 96 enue Seer ene ne Seneres. October 26. 1812. + agile LAU DO x weer | Pik . Duin my menien awe in 1 Morayshire, in August. last, I did not fai “oe rare myself of of 1 my vicinity to Ar ‘delach, to visit the ; MikeneLt family. Thave now to. communicate to you, accord- ing | Co) Sra OF the additional particulars 1 respecting the subject of is memoir, which this. visit has “enabled 1 me to collect. So rug these, Ls ree easily perceive, are the result of my own hig did yed ‘on the boy ‘himself; others were obtained from (cOnveteations with "hig eldest: sister, ‘whom I considered myself extremely ; fortunate in finding | at home. "Brevidudly 06 my. att, fig ort had given me reason to ex- a that I should find ; young Mrrenext’ s vision considerably ohne yand I had not been Tong i in his | company, before I Te CHEE atte? proot that this was the ‘case. ‘Ac. cc rdingly, I was Ted to examine his eyes with attention. Twelve month: S$ ago, § as I have stated in the’ supplement’ to Professor pains “Account, | one could perceive fragments of the lens very ‘white and ‘epaiae habia” Bite Hall SPE pu- pil of. cioh 4 eye; and through the other ‘half, a slighter opa- city, or a sort’ of greyish: 7 appéatatice, in “the 2 panes? situa- ia Learvdtlesilisa Sunil pits oly eh ane rat? Teouild discover; ufficient | to aecount for: the improvement | which has taken ae in his vision, isa diminution in this slighter opacity in, both eyes. At’ present, there is a very white fragment of the lens, deh it la upper half of the pupil of the right‘eye ; and Béliing’ the’ lower half, the humours appear “almost perfectly black. In the’ left e eye, , there isa - dusky-white opacity behind the he lower and inner half of the pupil ; and behind the upper ' and 64 ACCOUNT OF A BOY and outer half, the humours are of a dark grey. The pupils contraet and dilate as usual, on varying the. quantity of light. It is not easy to determine the exact degree of vision which he now enjoys.. He sees those bodies only which have consi- derable brightness, or dark-coloured bodies placed on a bright ground. Consequently, of the various objects which usually surround him, he sees such only as are not very minute, and are placed within a short distance of his eyes. He could distinguish a crown-piece at the distance of two or three feet, and a person’s face at the distance of six. But it seems obvi- ous, that he does not perceive distinctly the /imits of any ob- ject, however bright. For as soon as, guided by his own ob- scure vision, he has reached any thing with his hands, he no longer regards it with his eyes; but, as if he were yet totally blind, examines it solely with his fingers, tongue, lips, and nose. That he can now distinguish differences in the kinds of light or in colours, seems very evident from an amusement in which, his sister told me, he sometimes indulges,—matching bodies of the same colour together. One day, for example, having a bunch of the flowers of wild mustard in his hand, he was pried nia to approach an officer who was near him, and, with a smile, placed the flowers in contact with the yellow part of his epaulette. Frequently, too, he is seen gathering in the fields a number of flowers of the same kind ; the blue-bot- tle, for example, or the corn-poppy, or the marigold. It ap- pears, however, that it is only the brighter colours he is capa- ble of distinguishing ; and of these red seems to be his favou- rite. A red object attracts his notice more, and he looks at it longer, than any other. Of the female parishioners who pass the manse on their road to church on Sunday, he is most apt to follow those who are dressed in red cloaks. Miss Mrr- CHELL BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 65 cHELL is of opinion, that he rather dislikes darkness ; for she has observed, that in moving from one part of the house to another after night has come on, his step is hurried; and that he seems happy in reaching an apartment where there is a candle ora fire. I observed, that he judges of the direction of a body by sight, with invariable accuracy ; but when an object. whose real magnitude is not known to him, is placed before his eyes, he does not seem capable of estimating its distance, for the first time, with any degree of correctness. When I held a silver snuff-box about two feet from his face, he put out his hand exactly in the direction of the box, but moved it forwards very gradually until it came in contact with it. These circum- stances are just what we should before-hand have expected to find ; and such also, I imagine, as may be remarked of all per- sons who are nearly blind, from a similar cause. The per- ception of the direction of bodies, which obviously depends on the particular part of the retina which is affected by the rays they emit, may be obtained equally (if the bodies be seen at all) from the weakest as from the most perfect vision. But Mircuet’s vision is too obscure to enable him to perceive those minute differences in the colour and intensity of light, by which persons having perfect sight, judge of the relative dis- tance of luminous bodies. _ On the whole, it appears obvious, that his sight, although yet far too imperfect for any attempt to address him in a visi- ble language, is considerably improved within these last twelve months. Did the boy’s dispositions admit of it, I should now be inclined to recommend still more earnestly than before, that another attempt should be made, to remove the cataracts from his eyes, and I am much less disposed than formerly to fear, that there is any radical imperfection in the optic nerves. I Here 66 ACCOUNT OF A BOY Here it may not be improper to mention, that his sister is convinced, that he sees some objects better by moon-light than during the day; a circumstance which seems to shew, that the opacity in his eyes is, as in other cases of cataract, merely local ; so that when the pupil is much dilated, some rays of light reach the retina, through those more transparent parts of the humours which are farther distant from the axis of vision than the portion that is opaque. His powers of Hearing remain as imperfect as ever. He still continues the practice of striking hard bodies against his teeth ; but on further reflection, I think it not unlikely, that he may have another object in view in this experiment, be- sides that of procuring a sensation of sound. It is not at all improbable, that he discovers differences in the hardness of bodies in this manner. For there is a very distinct sensation felt towards the roots of the teeth themselves, when they are struck with a hard substance, resulting probably from an affec- tion of the nerves of the membrane lining their inner cavity, and this sensation is different according to the hardness of the body. Ihave little doubt, that he could by this kind of feel- ing alone, very easily discover that lead was softer than steel, and steel harder than ivory; although all these substances would feel equally hard to his proper organs of touch. But even supposing that he does not avail himself of this sensation in the teeth themselves, it is probable that he strikes bodies against these organs, not so much to try whether they will cause sound at all, as to observe what kind of sounds they will emit ; from which he may infer various other properties, which experience has taught him, are invariably connected with the particular sounds emitted. His manner of examining any object that is new to him, is. precisely the same now that it was four years ago, when I first saw him. When it is put into his hand, he runs it over with the BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 67 the points of his fingers ; then applies it to-his mouth, and in- sinuates his tongue into all its inequalities, thus using it as an organ of Touch as) well as Taste; and, lastly, if it is a body that admits of it, he rattles, it between his teeth. All this is done with singular rapidity. In fact, he loses but little time, in discovering, by the actual use of his organs of touch, taste, and smell, those qualities of bodies which we are content to in- fer from their visible appearance alone. . His sense of smell is unquestionably extremely acute. But I have not been able to learn any fact which could lead me to believe, that he could, in a room at least, discover a person by this sense alone, at the distance of twelve feet. It has been said, that he could follow the footsteps of another person for two miles, guided merely by smelling. But his sister assures me, that there is no foundation for this report. As to a power of determining the direction of an object, by some distinct qua- lity in-its odour, like that quality in sound by which we disco- ver the direction of a sounding body, I could not perceive that he enjoyed any such power more than other persons. Indeed it is not likely that his faculties should differ in kind from our own, however much they may in number and degree *. ’ Since his sight has begun to improve, his excursions have be- come bolder and more extensive. He has sometimes wandered . upwards * Hic Adolescens, annum nunc agens xviii, et optima semper usus valetudine, vegetus est, et admodum robustus : quin et solita ztate pubescere visus est, par- tibus genitalibus ut in viris se habentibus; neque dubitari potest quin brevi fu- turus sit twyey, labiis et mento dens4 jam inumbratis lanugine. . Curiosé autem percontanti famuli et amici (masculini scilicet sextis, quos solos de his rebus in- terrogare’ fas erat) omnes mihi testabantur nihil se observasse, unde colligerent illum Veneris stimulum unquam sensisse, vel differenti sexs notionem ha- buisse. _ 12 68 ACCOUNT OF A BOY upwards of three miles from home. In all these expeditions, he proceeds in a great measure without a guide. But a boy is appointed to follow him, and keep him constantly in view ; and Mrrcnett has the good sense, when he perceives any thing which he imagines to be a serious obstacle in his way, to wait until his little follower comes up to his assistance. Lately, on the road near the manse, he met a person, riding on a horse which had been bought a few weeks before from his mother ; and on coming up to the animal, and feeling it, he seemed instantly to recognise it. The person immediately dismounted, in order to see how Mircuett would behave ; and he was much amused to find, that he led the horse to his mo- ther’s stable, took off his saddle and bridle, put corn before him, and then withdrew, locking the door, and putting the key in his pocket. When he wishes to communicate his ideas to any one near him, he uses natural signs; and it is curious to observe, that most of these signs are addressed to the sight of those with whom he converses. This fact, it appears to me, shews very clearly, that he is aware that the powers of vision enjoyed by others are superior to his own; and hence it is not unrea- sonable to hope, that his reflecting on his inferiority in this respect, when his reason has become more matured, may be the means of inducing him to submit, more placidly than he has hitherto done, to any endeavours for the improvement of his sight. The following are a few examples of his signs. As soon as I began to examine his eyes, opposite to a window, he turned towards his sister, and stretched out his arm to its full extent laterally from his body. This, his sister informed me, is his usual sign for London. It is obviously the natural expression of distance ; and there is no need of pointing out the associa- tion which must have led him to use it on this occasion. When BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 69 When he would express that he has -been on horseback, he raises his foot, and brings the fingers of each hand together un- der the sole, in imitation of a stirrup. He places his hand on his mouth to signify his wish for food ; and when he would go to bed, he inclines his head sideways, as if to lay it on a pillow. When J arrived at Ardclach, young Mircuetu was not at home; he had wandered to the shoemaker’s, several hundred yards distant, where he was sitting in anxious expectation of a pair of new shoes. He was brought to the manse; but after he had remained with us contentedly in the dining-room for about half-an-hour, he shewed an anxiety to get away ; and as he mo- ved towards the door, he made use of a sign, from which no one could fail to discover whither he was going. It was, an exact imitation with his arms, of a shoemaker’s motion when he pulls his thread. All the signs employed by others in order to convey, ideas to him, are addressed to his organs of touch. The most im- portant, certaialy, of these signs, are those which his sister has invented, to express her approbation or disapprobation, her as- sent or dissent. Miss Mrrcuett’s explanation of them is ex- tremely satisfactory. Her brother has always been particular- ly attached to her, and she has always had most influence over him. He courts her good opinion. When she would signify to him her highest approbation of his conduct, she pats him much and cordially on the head, back, hand, or any other part of the body. This expression more sparingly and less fer- vently bestowed, signifies simple assent ; and she has only to re- fuse him these signs of her approbation entirely, and to repel him gently, to convey to him in the most effectual manner the notice of her displeasure. When I suggested to Miss Mrrcuex that it would be a highly interesting task, though doubtless a difficult and tedious one 70 ACCOUNT OF A BOY one, to teach her brother the meaning of writéen words, and mentioned briefly the outlines of a plan for that purpose ; she expressed the utmost willingness to undertake any attempt of this kind, but anticipated the chief obstacle to the design from his want of application. Still I cannot help thinking, that this obstacle would probably diminish, as soon as he felt the magic power ofa few words. Perhaps a trial might be made ac- cording to some such plan as the following. First, young Mrrenert might be provided with a horn-~ book, on which the letters of the alphabet have been cut in relief, His sister might then begin, by tempting him with the prospect of some article of luxury, a piece of sugar for ex- ample, or a toy ; but before gratifying him with the possession of it, she might take hold of his fore-finger, and conduct the point of it over all the letters composing the name of the ar- ticle. This being frequently repeated, I have little doubt that he.would soon point to the same letters when the same object was held in prospect ; and at last, use the sign to procure the luxury. Were one step of this kind gained, it is not un- reasonable to expect, that he might in time be made to un- derstand the meaning of every word in our language, whether expressive of one or many ideas. Such words are of course excepted, as express ideas which he cannot possibly have ex- perienced, from the imperfections of his sight and hearing. An advantage would attend the use of the dortisBbiok proposed, that if the letters were painted black, Mrremeri might com- municate by means of it with persons at a considerable dis- tance. Supposing him to have acquired a language of this kind, two others, if necessary, might afterwards be connected with it. The first would consist in tracing the letters of words on the palm of his hand, with the point of one’s finger ; and the BORN BLIND AND DEAF. ral the second, of the common speech on the fingers. But how great an acquisition would. the principal language alone be, without any such auxiliaries ! Several circumstances occurred, during my visit, which shew, how perfectly susceptible he is of pleasure from joking, or playing with him, or from any thing ludicrous in the ideas communicated to him. Twice or thrice when his sister per- ceived that he was crossing the room to go away, she stepped to the door unperceived by him, to prevent his escape. When he found her there before him, he stepped back smiling, and seemed to take this sort of teazing in perfect good jak out I had given him my whip, with which he seemed pleased ; and once or twice his sister took him by surprise, and pulled it smartly out of his hand. He immediately shewed by his smiles)that he knew who had robbed him ; and quickly catch- ing his sister, he endeavoured to wrest the whip: from. her. The joke, obviously, amused him very much; but Miss Mrr- CHELL assured, me, that it would have given him offence to have. repeated it more) frequently. An uncommonly large Newfoundland dog, belonging to a: gentleman who accompa- nied, me, had got, into, the room; and nothing could bé more expressive, of surprise than young Mrrcuexx’s éountenance, when he first felt, this animal. His sister observing this, im- mediately, with, great, quickness, took hold. of his arm, and stretched it above, his head, a sign which, it seems, he uses to denote mounting a horse., He instar ly understood her mean- ing, and laughing, made a motion as if he would bestride the dog. : - Ota) New clothes, are still among Mrrcuztx’s greatest sources of delight... Afterhis» measure has been taken, it would seem that every hour is full.of anxiety until the new suit is in his j possession. 2 ACCOUNT OF A BOY possession. Nothing else appears to occupy his mind. He literally persecutes the tailor or the shoemaker, until his shoes or his coat is finished. He is their guest morning, noon, and night, until the last stitch is drawn. Before leaving Ardclach, I took an opportunity of conver- sing very fully with Miss Mircnetx relative to her brother’s conduct at the period of his father’s death. Her answers to my inquiries on this point, corresponded exactly with the in- formation she was so kind as communicate to me through my ” friend Mr Lauper Dick of Relugas, in March last, and which I transmitted to you immediately on receiving it. She told me, that when her brother was permitted, by her direction, to touch his father’s dead body, he shrunk from it with surprise, but without expressing the slightest signs of sorrow. She assures me also, that he felt the body after it was placed in the coffin, but without betraying any emotions of grief. On the evening, however, after her father’s funeral, she herself saw him go down to the grave, and pat the turf with both his hands ; but whether he did this from affection, or intended it merely as an imitation of beating down the turf, she feels unable to decide, as she was not near enough to him to discern the expression of his countenance. For several days afterwards, it would appear that he returned repeatedly to the grave ; but gradually discontinued his visits. It is worthy of remark, how- ever, that he has regularly attended every funeral that has since taken place in the same church-yard. The report, therefore, which I have stated at the conclusion of the supplement to Professor GienNnim’s Account, of his having shed tears over his father’s grave, seems entirely without foundation. Miss Mrr- CHELL authorises me to say, that neither on this nor on any other occasion, has she herself seen her brother shew any une- quivocal marks of sorrow for his father’s death. Yet her friend, BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 73 friend, the Reverend Mr Campzett of ‘Ardersier, lately inform- ed her, that he saw her brother standing in the porch shedding tears, immediately after quitting the apartment in which his father’s body was lying, previous to the funeral. On the whole, however, I have not been able to discover the slightest reason for. altering the opinion I have always entertain- ed respecting the state of young Mircuetu’s feelings on the day of the funeral. It was my strong conviction of the truth of this “ opinion, and thinking that Professor GLenNniz might have been furnished with the materials of his Account from some one who had not enjoyed the same opportunity of judging as myself, that led me, in the, supplement to that, Account, to doubt in some degree the accuracy of his information on this point, I have since found, however, that. the whole of Professor GiEN- NIE'S Memoir was communicated by my friend Mr Macrar- LANE, who was present, as well as myself, on that melancholy occasion. I would now observe, therefore, that though I am sorry to, differ in opinion from a gentleman who has written so able a detail of some other parts of Mrrcuet1’s history, my perfect ~ knowledge of his candour and liberality embolden me to say, that I think hel is mistaken in this particular ; and that he has inter- preted i into expressions of grief i in young Mireuen, wha were merely expressions of curiosity. On this subject I have com- municated with my friends Mr Lavprr Diex of Relugas, Mr Smytu of Earlsmill, and the medical attendant of the family, Mr Srrairu, surgeon at Forres,—gentlemen who also were pre- sent at the funeral, and who are more familiar even than I am with young Mircnet1’s countenance and expression ; and I find, that their opinion ‘coincides exactly with mine. His mo- tions at the: coffin» were equally visible to us all. But we did not:attribute his placing his arms around it, to any emo- tion of sorrow, of which there appeared to us not the slightest » Vou. VIT. K trace 74 ACCOUNT OF A BOY trace in his countenance, but to the same motive that led him the very next moment, to trip lightly towards us, and smiling- ly feel our clothes all over—the pleasure he experienced in the examination of objects that were new to him. My friend Mr Lavper Dick, who has accompanied me in all my visits to Ard- clach, and whose interest in the family, and kindness towards them, have been equally great, has favoured me with a few re- marks, in a letter on this subject, which appear to me so just, that _ I shall take the liberty to quote them. “ From my observations,” he writes, “ made at the time, with all the attention which an ex- “ treme interest in the boy could excite, my opinion certainly “ is, that he was occupied with the coffin merely as being a “ body of a shape and surface different from any thing he had “ before met with ; and that he betrayed no emotions of grief. “« When the procession moved onwards, all his gestures seem- “ ed more those of a playful boy in good spirits, than those “ of an afflicted youth, conscious of the awful change which “« had taken place upon his parent. As it is certain that he “ had never felt a dead body, nor had any opportunity of “ learning the object of burial before; it appears to me, that “ we,cannot imagine him to have experienced any emotion of “ ovief at his father’s funeral, without also supposing him to have had an innate idea of death.” I am, my dear Sir, with great regard, yours truly, Joun Gorpon. s . Postscript. Before sending you this letter, I transmitted a copy of it to Miss Mrrcnect, for her perusal and correction ; and I have much pleasure in adding the following extracts from her very obliging and satisfactory reply. “ Acreeably oe BORN BLIND AND DEAF. 75 “ Aoreeably to your request, I have read your letter to Pro- fessor Stewart with as much attention as the short time it has been in my possession would admit of; and I certainly think you have stated those facts I informed you of, respect- ing my brother, ‘most correctly. »“ My brother seems to be very well pleased with his change of residence *, and goes on much in the same way he did at Ardelach ; that j is to say, wandering for several miles round the small town we live in, or amusing himself by visiting the different carpenters’ or other tradesmens’ shops within his reach, and handling their implements, or trying to discover what they are engaged.about...| He: has. not yet discovered any anxiety to return to Ardclach, and is, I think, quite as happy as when there.’ ~ Mrs Mircuext and, her. family have within these feyy path left Ardclach to reside at Ngirn. K 2. NO. IV. 76 ACCOUNT OF A BOY No. IV. Wurtz employed in revising this concluding sheet, I had the pleasure of receiving the following letter from my friend Sir James Macxinrosu. It is unnecessary for me to mention the satisfaction I feel in attracting that notice to the Subject of my Memoir which his name cannot fail to ensure. Letter from Sir James Macxintosu to Mr Stewart. Edinburgh, 5th November 1812. My dear Sir, In consequence of our conversation at Kinneil in August, L called on Mrs Mrrcuett after my arrival in Nairnshire, and on the 9th of October I had an interview with James Mircnett, and his sister Miss Mrrcuexx, which lasted for several hours. I directed my inquiries to every point which seemed important, in the corporeal or mental state of this unfortunately interest- ing young man. The result, however, is little more than a needless corrobo- ration of the accounts which you have already received ; espe- cially those from Dr Gorpon, who seems to have conducted his observations with much philosophical discernment and ac- curacy. During the vacancy in his father’s parish, the parishioners assembled on Sunday for public worship and mutual instruc- tion, and one of the elders prayed with a loud and shrill voice, which was observed to give great uneasiness to Mrr- CHELL. BORN. BLIND AND DEAF.- 771 cHEtu This occurred’ several ‘times; so that there ‘appears no reason to consider it as an accidental ‘coincidence. Though his ordinary conduct be decorous, it seems to be in- fluenced by habit and instruction rather than by feelings of de- licacy.. When the females of his family are undressing, he has been observed'to'turm aside. There areno males in the house. But in an opportunity which ‘has lately’ occurred, he has been thought to shew a similar disposition in the case of males. I have seldom:seen an imperfection ofthe senses attended by so little an air of defect.in the countenance. Singular as it may seem, I should even venture to call his features intelli- gent. He handled every part of the room in which we sat, with indications of an inquisitive mind. His sister is a young woman of most pleasing appearance and manners, distinguished by a very uncommon degree of modesty, caution, and precision, in her accounts of him; and probably one of the most intelligent, as well as kindest com- panions, that ever guided a being doomed to such unusual, if not unexampled privations. You will not think me fantastic for adding, that the ha- bitual exercise of ingenious benevolence seems to me to have left its traces on her countenance, and to have bestowed on her naturally agreeable features, an expression more de- lightful than beauty. Her aversion from exaggeration, and her singular superiority to the pleasure of inspiring wonder, _make it important to the purposes of Philosophy as well as of Humanity, that she should continue to attend her brother. Separation from her would indeed be an irreparable calamity to this unfortunate youth.. By her own unaided ingenuity, she has conquered the obstacles which seemed for ever to preclude all intercourse between him and other minds; and what is still more important, by the firm and gentle exertion of her well-earn- ed 78 ACCOUNT OF A Boy, &cv ed ascendant over him, she spares him much of the pain whick he must otherwise have suffered from the occasional violences of a temper irritated by a fruitless struggle to give utterance to his thoughts and wishes; disturbed still farther by the vehe-: mence of those gestures which he employs to supply the defi- ciency of his signs, and released from that restraint on anger’ which we experience when we see and hear its excesses disap- proved by our fellow-creatures. I am, my dear Sir, with the truest esteem, Yours most faithfully, J. Macxintosu. IL On the pened asia and rhea ie 6 certain Strata, and their relation with Granite. . By Sir James Hatt, Bart. Pr. R. S. Ep. & F.R.S. Lonp. [ Read Fi urn '8..1812.] SHE: tract of country extending across this island, from the sea-coast of Galloway to that of Berwickshire, con- sists, with little interruption, of that species of rock, which has of late been most generally known _by the German name of Grauwacke. But as this rock does not differ essentially from what in Cornwall is called Killas, I am disposed, in, concur- rence with several members of this Society, i in particular with Mr Arian, who has of late been i in Cornwall, and has paid particular. attention to that subject, to reject the uncouth term to our r language. The continuation is sO unbroken, that I believe it would be practicable to walk from one sea to the other, without tread- ing upon any rock but killas ; and as its character i is identical throughout, we seem to be authorised, in every view of mine- ralogy, to look upon the whole | as one with respect to origin and 80 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, and history ; so that observations made at any one part of the range, may, with confidence, be applied to the rest. . There are but few exceptions to this general rule, which have come to my knowledge. At the Rae Quarry in Peebles- shire, near the Crook Inn, a Limestone containing shells oc- curs, interstratified with killas ; and in the stewartry of Kirk- cudbright, there are three Granitic districts in the midst of this rock, whose relations with it exhibit some interesting facts, which will occupy the second part of this paper. A granite mass also occurs within the range of this same mass of killas, at Priestlaw on the Water of Fasnet, in the mountainous part of East Lothian. The killas consists everywhere of an assemblage of strata of various thickness, from several yards to the minutest leaf of slate. It is in general of a dark-blue colour, and, when exa- mined, is found to consist of a congeries of fragments, which bear the most undoubted proofs of having been deposited in an horizontal position. The strata lie parallel to each other, but are everywhere far from being horizontal, their pre- vailing and best known position being vertical, or nearly so. They are often bent, however, at various angles, fre- quently very acute, and sometimes with the strata nearly doubled upon themselves. In all the inland part of this range, the rock appears so partially, shewing itself only in ri- yer-courses, of in quarries, that it is difficult to obtain any correct information as to the position of the strata, which fre- quently exhibit great seeming irregularity, and which cannot be described, without making use of language which at first sight bears an appearance of contradiction in terms. Thus it not unfrequently happens, that one set shews itself in a position, at the surface, nearly erect, but having a decided dip to the east; and that in the immediate neighbourhood, another AND PHEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. $1 another set occurs in a position similar to the first, but having a no less decided ‘dip to the west. On the shore of the sea; however, where these rocks are bare, and exposed in such a manner, that our view can em- brace at once a considerable extent of the mass, the general structure becomes apparent, and we are enabled to give a ra- tional account of these seeming anomalies. This opportunity of observation, occurs with peculiar ad- vantage on the coast of Berwickshire, where the lofty cliffs which extend from Fast Castle eastward to Gun’s Green near Eyemouth, present to view a cross section of these strata, by which their position is seen to possess much’ more method and regularity than the inland rocks would have led us to expect. The strata here exhibit a succession of regular bendings, and powerful undulations, reaching from top to bottom of the clitfs, two or three hundred feet in height. These are occa- sionally interrupted, as might be expected, by the irregulari- ties of the coast, by shifts and dislocations of the beds, and sometimes, as happens at St Abb’s Head, by the intervention of whinstone ; or occasionally of porphyry. ‘Notwithstanding these interruptions, I reckoned, (in an excursion to that coast, made last summer with my son Lieutenant Bastin Hatt of this Society), sixteen distinct bendings, in the course of about six miles, each of the largest size, and reaching from top to bottom of the cliffs, their cur- vature being alternately concave and convex upwards. Plates I, II and II. are from drawings made on the spot. Fig.1. Plate I. shews a general view, taken at sea, at some distance off the - point of Fast Castle, which appears upon the right hand. Plate II. shews a near view of part of the same scene, representing a spot called the Brander Cove, in which one of these convolu- tions, concave downwards, is conspicuously seen. The rock Vor. VIL. L he. 82 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, upon the right, on which Fast Castle stands in fig. 1. Plate I., exhibits also one of the cunvolutions concave downwards, and similar to that of the Brander Cove, seen on the left. Plate III. represents another rock of the same coast, at a place called Whapness, near Gun’s Green, in the neighbour- hood of Eyemouth.. Here there are four bendings ; two con- vex upwards, and two convex downwards, lying close to each other; and fig. 2. Plate I., represents a rock in the same neigh- bourhood, in which a variety of convolutions are distinctly seen. We have thus a specimen of that part of the coast which con- sists of killas; the whole being a succession of similar bendings, alternately concave and convex upwards ; and the curvature of the mass is, in general, (as Mr Piayrarr has well obser- yed, Lllustrations, art. 204.) simple ; that is to say, these bend- ings are performed in one direction only, and round axes that seem to lie horizontally, and parallel to each other. These strata, in common with all those of killas, seem to have been originally deposited in a position nearly horizontal, and many of the particular beds represented in these sketches, possess that peculiar undulation on their surface which we meet with on a sandy beach, when the tide has left it, and which affords the most unequivocal indication of aqueous de- position. There is reason to believe also, that the strata, con- stituting these convolutions, though now detached from each other, have at one period lain in continuity, and horizontally ; that by the exertions of some powerful mechanical force, they, have been compelled to assume their present contorted shape ; that their continuity still exists below, and would be seen, could we penetrate into the mass under the level of the sea; the in- terruption of their continuity upwards, having arisen from ‘a removal of part of the rock, by some of those revolutions which have & AND’ THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 83 have every where agitated and corroded the surface of our globe. In order more fully to illustrate this arrangement, I have drawn in figure 1st, Plate IV. an ideal portion ofa coast similar to that which we have been describing ; and in figure 2d, the same has been exactly repeated in black lines. But in this last figure, I have introduced a‘ continuation of each of the strata in dotted lines; so that every one of them is rendered completely continuous from end to end. This theoretical completion of these forms, may be of ser- vice in accounting for the anomalous circumstances already mentioned, as belonging to the strata of killas. In particular, we may thus readily account for the abrupt change of dip from east to west. Thus, in figure 1. Plate IV. we see the strata a b, and ¢ d, dipping rapidly to the east, and those at ef, and gh, as rapidly to the west ; yet, at their outgoings, or appearances at the surface, they are very little removed from each other ; and if the middle point, where the convolu- tion takes place at m, were hid from the view or removed, the appearance would be completely paradoxical. Making allowance for shifts, and various interruptions, great part of the coast may be thus explained : but this simple curvature, though general, is by no means universal in the killas ; as appears in some places upon this coast, to the east- — ward of Eyemouth, at Gun’s Green, where the axis of convo- lution is very: irregular, and is sometimes vertical ; and also in Galloway, where the strata present. to view much more ‘irre- gularity. . But these anomalies, though more complicated, seem all to be of the same class, and to denote the influence of similar actions, as I shall endeavour to shew in the course of this paper. atet) L2 In 84 ON: THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, In reducing these irregular forms into system and connec- tion, one object, of no small consequence in geology, seems to be obtained ; but it would be desirable, if possible, to go a step farther, and to discover by what means this peculiar arrange- ment has been brought about. For this purpose, it will be necessary to shew, first, That this peculiar conformation may be given to a set of horizontal beds by a mechanical force of sufficient strength; and, secondly, That there are rational grounds for believing, that such a force has been actually exerted in this case. I have now, and formerly, tried to esta- blish the first point by experiment ; and I shall endeavour to vindicate the second by a train of geological reasoning, found- ed upon some volcanic phenomena. In the year 1788, when I had the pleasure of visiting the coast of Berwickshire, in company with Dr Hurton and Mr Prayratr, it occurred to me, that this peculiar conformation might be accounted for, by supposing that these strata, origi- nally lying flat, and in positions as nearly level as might be expected to result from the deposition of loose sand at the bottom of the sea, had been urged when in a soft, but tough and ductile state, by a powerful force acting horizontally ; that this force had been opposed by an insurmountable resistance upon the opposite side of the beds,—or that the same effect had been produced by two forces. acting in opposite direc- tions; at the same time that the whole was held, down by a superincumbent weight, which, however, was capable of being heaved up by a sufficiently powerful exertion. By either of these modes of action, I conceived, that two opposite extremities of each bed being made to approach, the intervening substance, could only dispose of itself in a succes- sion of folds, which might assume considerable regularity, and would consist of a set of parallel curves, alternately convex and concave AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 85 concave towards the centre of the earth *. At the same time, no other force being applied, any two particles which lay with respect to each other, so that the straight line joming them were horizontal, and at rignt angles to the direction of that active force, would retain their relative position, and of course that line would maintain its original straightness and horizontality ; and thus the forces exerted being simple, or, if compound, tending, as just stated, to produce a simple result, the beds would acquire the simple curvature ascribed to them by Mr Prayratr, and which belongs to them, in the imme- diate neighbourhood of Fast Castle; whereas, in Galloway, and in some parts of our coast, particularly near Gun’s Green, to the eastward of Eyemouth, where the curvature deviates from that simple character, and becomes in the utmost degree irregular, we must conceive thie force to have been more com- plicated, or most probably to: have acted at successive pe- riods. This conjecture no sooner occurred, than I endeavoured to illustrate my idea by the following rude experiment, made with such materials as were at hand. Several pieces of cloth, ‘some linen, some woollen, were spread upon a table, one above the other, each piece representing a single stratum ; a door (which happened to be off the hinges) was then. laid above the mass, and being loaded with weights, confined it under a considerable pressure, (fig. 5: Plate 1V.), two boards being next applied vertically to the two ends of the stra- ~ tified * Tam aware, that this expression of parallel curves is irregular ; but I can find no other mode of conveying the idea. It is not easy to trace, a prior?, what form would-be assumed by these beds, supposing the whole to be held down by a force so powerful as to prevent any yacuity. It is enough, however, for our present purpose, that the forms of nature correspond with those obtained in an. experiment soon to be mentioned. 86 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, tified mass, were forced towards each other by repeated blows of a mallet applied horizontally. The consequence was, that the extremities were brought nearer to each other, the heavy door was gradually raised, and the strata were con- strained to assume folds, (fig. 4. Plate IV.), bent up and down, which very much resembled the convoluted beds of killas, as exhibited in the craggs of Fast Castle, and illustrated the theory of their formation. I now exhibit to the Society a machine, by which a set of pliable beds of clay are pressed together, so as to produce the same eflect, fig. 5.; and I trust, that the forms thus obtained will be found, by gentlemen accustomed to see such rocks, to bear a tolerable resemblance to those of nature, as shewn in “fig. 6., copied from the forms assumed in the machine, by an assemblage of pieces of cloth of different colours. It still remains for us to consider how this horizontal thrust may have been produced. It will be found, I conceive, to arise, as a natural consequence from Dr Hurron’s original hypothesis, according to which our continents have been rai- sed from the bottom of the sea, and elevated to their present positions, by the internal action of the same heat which shews itself externally in volcanoes, The most obvious mode of investigating these internal ac- tions, in pursuance of the Huttonian view, is to study the ex- ternal voleanic phenomena, and to consider what variations and modifications would be produced upon these last by the circumstances attending the subterranean action of the same powers. With this view, I beg leave once more to solicit the atten- tion of the Society, to a scene which I have mentioned in for- mer papers, and to refer to some plates representing it, which I have given in the sixth volume of our Transactions, in my paper AND THEIR MEEETING WITH GRANITE. 87 paper ‘ On the Effects of Heat modified by Compression.” This scene, as viewed in the Atrio del Cavallo, (Plate V. volume vi. figs. 41, 42, 43, and 44.), exhibits in nature a.com- plete section of the old volcano of Vesuvius, now called Som- ma. The mountain is there seen to be composed of a succes- sion of beds of lava and of cinders, the lava occupying only a fourth or a fifth part of the mass, which is traversed vertically, but irregularly, by numerous rents filled with solid lava ;. these rents, as 1 have endeavoured to prove, having undoubt- edly served. as. the pipes. through which lateral eruptions have been discharged. . Each of these rents would continue open during the course: of the particular eruption by which it was formed, and the la-. va would flow freely through it; but when the eruptive im- pulse ceased, it would remain full of the liquid lava, which would congeal, so as to leave the rent, as it now appears, completely filled with hard and solid rock.. This new sub-. _ stance welding itself firmly to the extremities. of. the beds. of lava which-had been broken across, would bind them. toge-. ther into a species of net-work, and thus the injury done to. the mountain by the formation of-the rent, would be repaired,. and much more than repaired ; so that when a new eruption. _ was directed to the same quarter, it would be less able to pe- netrate than before, and the eruption would be restrained ‘till. a fresh rent was effected in some other part of the mountain.. A new eruption must thus, in every case, be an act.of. vio-- lence ; and we see how a lateral eruption may. be followed, as- frequently happens, by a discharge of lava from the summit of the mountain, which could not have taken place, had the: first lava continued fluid, since it would never have ceased in: that case to flow through the lowest aperture, whereas, in: consequence: 88 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, consequence of the congelation of its upper part, that aperture is closed. What is true of volcanoes, must be no less true of those internal operations, which, according to the Huttonian theory, have been the means of raising all the rocks and mountains from the bottom of the sea into their present situation; and by which the unstratified substances have penetrated the stra- ta, and filled the rents formed in them, producing the veins or dikes so common in this country, just as we have seen the lava of Mount Somma filling the rents through the beds of lava and of cinders. It cannot be doubted, that the secondary strata must have been greatly strengthened in this way. We may be sa- tisfied of this, by looking at any great dike of whinstone (such as that of twenty or thirty yards in breadth, now opened on the north side of Edinburgh, as a quarry for pavement), crossing and connecting substances of every variety of hardness; also at the two small dikes which appear crossing the loose shale in the bed of the Water of Leith, close to the two mineral springs. The introduction of this new substance, and the heave of the superincumbent mass, which is its necessary consequence, have been productive of several very important results, which shall be the subject of a future communication to this Socie- ty. Let us confine ourselves at present, however, to the con- volutions of the killas. According to the Huttonian theory, that loose assem- blage of sand of various qualities, which was destined to give birth to strata of every sort, from gneiss to sandstone, lying originally in a position nearly horizontal, as deposited in beds at the bottom of the sea, and being acted upon from below, on successive occasions, by a heat of great intensity, must be conceived, AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 89 conceived, in consequence of the progress upwards of that heat, to have possessed at any particular moment a great va- riety of intermediate temperatures, between that intense pitch and the ordinary heat of the sea. Owing to these varieties of substance and of temperature, the utmost diversity of charac- ter in point of tenacity, from firmness and brittleness, to the most perfect pliability and ductility, must have belonged to the assemblage in various parts. Let us now suppose a rush to have taken place from below upwards, of any of those bodies in a state of liquid fusion, which on cooling have constituted all our unstratified substances, from granite to whinstone inclusive, and that this fluid was ur- ged by an irresistible force ; the consequence must be, that the stratified mass would yield in various modes. Such beds as were in a frangible state, would yield by the formation of rents, and the sthets, by having their substance forced through and partly dragged upwards. Into these rents and openings the un- stratified matter in.fusion would enter, and would proceed up- wards more or less, according to its fusibility. Whinstone, the most fusible of the set, would flow the farthest, and would even perhaps arrive at the surface, and there discharge itself in the open air as a real lava, or, breaking through the bottom of a deep sea, might constitute a submarine lava, like one of those observed in Iceland by Sir Georce Mackenzie, which, with the characteristics of a lava, have their cavities studded with calcareous spar*, When I met with this ob- . Vou. VII. doy ML servation * M. vz Luc, in his Elementary Treatise on Geology, p. 365. art. 311. has undertaken to shew, that my experiments with compression are not applicable to Dr Hurron’s hypothesis. ‘ When calcareous substances,” (he says, p. 365.) «© are calcined in open air, the fixed air which is produced immediately escapes, “ce and 90 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, servation in Sir George Macxenzir’s work, it recalled to me what I had seen in Sicily, where the Cyclopian Islands, at the | “* and it continues to form until the substance is deprived of its ingredients ; but ‘¢ when a solid body prevents its escape, the particles first formed acquire a de- ** gree of condensation proportional to the resistance which they experience, “* and they oppose in their turn the same resistance to the formation of other ‘* particles. Under such circumstances, therefore, if the heat he increased, it «© produces other combinations of the fixed air with the calcareous earth, as in “* the experiments of Sir James Hatz. But, under water, which the particles ‘“* of that gass can easily penetrate, in which, collecting in bubbles, they will “ rise rapidly, on account of their inferior specific gravity, there can be no im- ‘* pediment to their formation, any more than that of the aqueous vapour in wa- ‘* ter, under the pressure of the atmosphere, when the heat is sufficiently in- « tense.” When M. ve Luc says, that in my experiments a solid body preventing the escape of the fixed air, “‘ the particles first formed acquire a degree of condensa- * tion proportional to the resistance which they experience,” he must conceive, that during the first application of heat, some fixed air has separated from the lime, and has accumulated in the cavity left in the barrels. But if he will look again into my paper, he will find that I had foreseen this inconvenience, and had guarded against it; that being under the necessity of leaving some cavity, in order to allow for the liquid expansion of the fusible metal, I introduced some water into the barrel, which assuming the gaseous form, and reacting with great power, before the heat had risen to the calcining point, effectually prevented the separation of any fixed air, And the same thing would happen at the bottom of a sea that was deep enough. In some of my experiments, made with a compres- sing force equal to 171 atmospheres, equal to 5693 feet, or about a mile of sea, the carbonate bore the heat of melting gold without calcination, and entered in- to fusion. Now, it is obvious, that the same result must take place at the bottom of a sea of this depth, and that a shell lying on its bottom, if met by a lava whose heat was equal to that of melting gold, would enter into fusion, and no fixed air would be separated in the form of gas. M. pe Luc’s objection, there- fore, which is founded on the levity of the substance in that gaseous form, must fall to the ground. In those experiments which I have made, with a compressing force applied by means of a known and regulated weight, the carbonate has been placed exactly in AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. gl the foot of Mount Etna, are possessed of that same character. M. Dotomrev considers these and others as having been covered by the sea. Other unstratified substances would attain, in a liquid state, to positions less and less elevated, as they were more and more refractory; and the granite would be the soonest congealed, being the least fusible of the whole set. In any of these cases, when the opening above was stopt by congelation, the force from below being irresistibly power- ful, the liquid, as we have said, must have found room for it- self among the strata. 'This must have been done in one of two modes. ; Either, Ist, when the strata were in a hard and inflexible state, in which case, the liquid must have forced itself be- tween stratum and stratum, by flowing horizontally among them, by which means an arrangement would be produced, similar to that of great part of the group in this neighbour- hood, consisting of Arthur’s Seat and Salisbury Craigs, as well seen from the south-west, where thick beds of uniform basal- tic matter, emanating on both sides from the vast massive block in the middle, which rises highest of any, are interposed between thin beds of freestone, lying parallel to each other, and inclined to the horizon at an angle of about thirty de- grees. Or, 2dly, where the strata were soft and pliable, and pos- sessed of considerable toughness. In this case, they would yield on both sides, so as to allow the vein to become wider M2 and in the predicament ascribed to it by Dr Hurron, when exposed to the same heat under a sea whose pressure is equal to that force. The fusions, then, which have taken place in my experiments, confirm Dr Hurton’s theory, in so far as it-depends upon the action of heat on limestone. 92 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, and wider to an indefinite extent, producing a solid unstrati- fied mass. At the same time, they must have made room for that yielding, partly by heaving up the superincumbent mass, and partly by prepagating the motion horizontally along their own beds; which Jast motion will be opposed by their friction and inertia. We should then have three forces more or less opposed to each other ; the force of elevation of the liquid, the superincumbent weight, and the friction of the strata. The consequence would be, that the strata, to a certain limited ex- tent, would be thrust horizontally ; and so far as that action reached, would be placed in the exact predicament of the pieces of cloth in the old experiment, or of the clay in that be- fore us, (figs. 4. and 6. Plate IV.) We have every reason to ex- pect, then, that our experiments have been a faithful repre- sentation of what would happen in a similar case in nature. And the results we have obtained, bearing an exact resem- blance to the peculiar forms of the strata of killas, seem to justify that conclusion. If we suppose two such invasions of matter in fusion, to rise parallel to each other, and both un- der the circumstances above described, their influence exerted in parallel, though opposite directions, would conspire, and the space between them would be still more completely con- voluted than where one action alone took place; or would be carried to a greater extent, than merely the double of one of them. Were the neighbouring veins inclined at any angle to- wards each other, the amount of the effect produced, and the situation of the axes of convolution, would-be difficult to cal- culate ; but it is certain, that their effects would still conspire. The complication would be still farther increased along with the amount of the action, if a third vertical burst of liquid matter occurred, so as to enclose a district of the stratified mass within a triangle. We are not possessed of data by which AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 93 which the extent of such a triangle may be limited. It seems clear, however, that the greater the superincumbent mass, and the deeper the bed of ductile strata, provided that the force from below were sufficiently powerful, the more extensive would be this influence. And the influence of such a force upon .a mass which had, by previous actions, acquired a simple curvature, will account for any deviation from that simplicity. By acting upon a set of beds previously rendered vertical in part, it might thus produce convolutions having a vertical axis, as at Gun’s Green. Let us now suppose, that, after the strata had cooled to such a pitch as to lose their pliability, a fresh quantity of matter in liquid fusion was impelled against them; the whole penetra- tion would, now be effected, by rents traversing the convolu- tions in all directions, and the liquid stone would flow into them, the temperature of the strata not having yet fallen so much as to occasion its immediate consolidation. Some of these rents might penetrate the mass in directions horizontal or nearly so; and these, swelling by the infusion of liquid from below, would form great unstratified masses, and contribute powerfully to the general elevation. All the junctions of stratified with unstratified matter, which took place during this second stage, would possess a dif- ferent character from that in the first. In the first, the axes of convolution would of course be parallel to the neighbouring boundary, between the two substances ; whereas, in the second case, no such parallelism need be looked for, since the liquid stone would flow in rents, and along surfaces which were pro- duced by the laceration of a frangible mass, in which the axes of convolution would act no part. _. According to this view, as all the substances concerned must have lain very deep at the time of the first operation, and as the mass by which this powerful horizontal thrust was performed, Q4 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, performed, must have been of great bulk and consequent soli- dity, it seems probable, that the convoluted mass, together with the matter in a liquid state which it had received after its consolidation, would, upon a subsequent application of the elevating cause, be more easily raised than the solid unstrati- fied mass, by whose swellings the convolutions were first ef- fected. It is natural, then, to expect, that in the various rents and. agitations which these masses have evidently undergone, the original mover of the convolution, and the scenes of its meet- ing with the stratified mass, may very frequently have been left in the deep abyss. In an account which I am now pre- paring to lay before the Society, of circumstances relating to the revolutions of the earth’s surface, I shall have occasion to state a fact, which seems to prove, that the particular mass of killas of which we have been speaking, has undergone one palpable revolution of this sort, by which the mass in its im- mediate neighbourhood has been left at a considerable distance below it. I must hope, however, that on some occasions, scenes exhibiting the junction of the prime mover with the strata, and in which the axes of convolution shall be found parallel to that junction, may hereafter be discovered, in situations raised up, and well exposed to view; and I recommend this as an object of great interest to geological observers. Our attention is naturally turned in this case to Granite, as far surpassing in importance every other species of unstrati- — fied body ; and I have little doubt that it has in fact been the agent of these convolutions. I have not, however, been able to discover any case in which it has performed this function. All the junctions which I have seen belong decidedly to the se- cond class mentioned, and bear marks of an infusion of the li- quid granite into hard and brittle strata; and the peculiar junction AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 95 junction we haye in view, if it does occur at the surface, will most. probably be found where.granite meets with gneiss or mica-slate, not where it. meets with killas*. I have no scrupie, however, in presenting these speculations to. the Society, al- though I cannot produce direct evidence in support of them, because I trust that the conjecture is sufficiently plausible to merit some attention; and, above all, because it may be the means of giving rise to much interesting observation, in a de- partment hitherto overlooked, or in which, for want of any connected system, the observations of travellers have been lost. It will be an object of consequence, that future travellers should attend to this. circumstance in the Alps, where a very long ridge of granite is bordered on both sides by strata. The ideas just stated, not having occurred to me till long after I had left that country, I can form no judgment with respect to what inferences may be drawn from the state of facts which are there to be seen. It is certain, that the strata of the Alps are very much convoluted, as mentioned in various places by M. pz Saussure; but whether these forms could reasonably ; be * Gwetss is found to pass by insensible degrees into granite; that is, speci- mens of every conceivable intermediate step have been found. We may then conceive one stage more advanced towards granite than the rest, in which all character of the original stratification is removed, and the mass may have be- come wholly crystalline, but in which the peculiarity of each stratum may still have left a trace of its character, in the quality of the granite thus produced from it. This seems to explain the nature of a great part of the internal ridge of the Alps, which is possessed, as Saussure mentions, of a stratified character. This mass may, again, be traversed from within by granite in higher heat, and in a state of complete liquidity, which would be more ready than the mass first described, to penetrate into the neighbouring masses, Accordingly, Saussure observes, that those veins, and other masses which, project from the central _ ridge, and penetrate farthest into the neighbouring strata, are devoid of that stratified character. 96 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, be ascribed to the elevation of the central granitic ridge, or whether its arrival at its present place has been connected with their formation, does not appear from any of the facts which I have read an account of, or recollect to have seen. It is probable that the point will not be decided, till that country is visited by a person previously aware of the theore- tical views which we have been considering. A case of such convolutions is mentioned by M. DE Saussure, at a spot which I remember well, the cas- cade called the Nant d’Arpenaz, on the road to the Gla- cicrs of Chamouni. The strata there consist of limestone, and are bent in such a manner, as to have struck that valuable observer with the utmost astonishment; yet, in our view, they may easily be accounted for by a lateral thrust. In reasoning upon this subject, he finds himself for- ced to contemplate the possibility of those convolutions ha- ; ving been the work of subterraneous forces, occasioned by in- ternal fire; but he abandons the idea almost as soon as he has formed it, from the reflection that this mountain, and its neighbourhood, shew no indications of the action of fire. Af- ter a good deal of argument, he at last (though with seeming reluctance), submits to the idea, that these great results may have been the work of crystallization ; the insufficiency of which reasoning, Mr Prayrarr, in his Illustrations, art. 207. has clearly pointed out. Since this paper was read in the Society, I have met with a very interesting account of a set of rocks in Argyleshire, whose position and arrangement greatly resemble those which I have been describing, and among which, one fact occurs which seems well worthy of notice. .(This account is contain- ed in the Edinburgh Encyclopedia, under the article Ar- GYLESHIRE, and was written by Mr ArcurBatp Campe- BELL, AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 97 BELL, whose recent death is much to be lamented). The strata there described occupy a great extent of coast, near- ly forty miles; they consist of strata of slate and limestone, sometimes alternating, and seem to belong to the class of killas. Their convolutions are less elevated and less abrupt than those we have been describing, but in all other respects exactly resemble them. One circumstance is mentioned by the author as a simple fact, and without view to theory, but which seems, in a striking manner, to accord with what we have endeavoured to establish. ‘ Where the strata (he says) “ consist chiefly of limestone, with few, or very thin stra- ta of slate intervening between them, the thickness of a stratum is frequently five or six times greater at the sum- “ mit of the wave, and at the hollow where it begins ascend- ‘ ing to form the next wave, than at the intermediate point, ‘ where the contrary flexure takes place.” I recollect no such difference as to thickness among our strata; but the circumstance might be expected, upon our theo- ry, to take place, when the beds acted upon by the horizontal thrust were not only flexible and tough like cloth, but also ductile, and capable of being elongated by pressure. For supposing the thrust to have continued, after the folds had, to a certain extent, been accomplished, it is evident, that the ho- rizontal pressure acting in some degree at right angles to the beds, where the contrary flexures took place, and of course where their position was most erect, would tend to elongate and thin them at those places, and would have a contrary ef- fect, if any, at the summit and hollow of each arch, where the stratum for a short space occupies an horizontal Position, This unexpected fact tends then, I conceive, in a striking manner, to confirm our theory. Vou. Vi. N “ce “ee wn oe When 98 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, Wuen we undertake to account for the convolutions of the killas, by the forcible invasion of granite, one material point is to show, contrary to the opinion entertained as yet, I believe, by all geologists but those of the Huttonian school, that gra- nite has been the latest formed of the two. The scenes in Galloway, where these substances meet, prove this, I conceive, beyond dispute; but they prove it over much in one point of view, since they show the arrival of the granite at its present place, to have been posterior, not only to the formation of the strata of killas, but also to their convolutions when in a state of softness, and to their subsequent consolidation. It must, therefore, be admitted, that this mechanical effect cannot have been produced by the particular granite there exhibited ; but the circumstances which the junction presents to view, autho- rise us to believe, that another granitic mass, acting in a for- mer period, with the same powers, but when the killas was in a soft state, has been the agent of these convolutions. It be- comes, therefore, of great importance in this inquiry, to make a clear statement of the mode in which the introduction of the granite into its present place has been effected in this authen- tic instance. In that view, I shall ask permission to lay before the Socie- ty, the details of some observations, which, in general terms, ‘ mentioned in a former communication. In the year 1790, I read an account in this Society of my observations on one of those granitic masses which reaches from Loch Ken to the valley of Palnure, a short abstract of which has been published in the History of the Society at that period. It is there stated, that I had traced the junction of this mass with the neighbouring rock, in a complete circuit of it, which I made in company with the Honourable Tuomas Dovetas AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 99 Dovcras (now Earl of Selkirk), and that in “ all this extent, *« where the junction of the granite with the schistus was vi- “ sible, veins of the former, from fifty yards to the tenth of * an inch in width, were to be seen, running into the latter, “and pervading it in all directions, so as to put it beyond all ‘© doubt, that the granite of these veins, and consequently of “ the great body itself, which I observed forming with the ‘* veins one continued and uninterrupted mass, must have “« flowed in a soft or liquid state into its present position.” I have since, on many occasions, visited the same place, and every fresh observation has confirmed my first impression, and has served more and more to convince me, that the gra- nite is posterior in formation to the killas, and has flowed into its present position from below upwards, in a liquid state, whilst the stratified mass was hard, or at least sufficiently so as to break with sharp angles, and to allow the liquid granite to mould itself upon its fractures. I observed every circumstance that essai be expected in such a case. I saw the granite meeting the strata in every possible angle. In one case, which occurs in the bed of the river, at the High Bridge of Dee, I saw the bounding surface of the granite dipping at an angle of 45 degrees from the centre of the granitic mass, and the strata lying upon it, in what (in the Wernerian language) is called a conformable posi- tion to the granite, and corresponding exactly to what they have held out as the mode in which the granite always meets the strata. The Hill of Lauren, which occupies the south-west of Loch Ken (on the side of the granitic mass, nearly opposite to the spot last mentioned) presents a junction of these bodies, whose character is as completely different as could well be conceived. At the southern extremity of the ridge, the junc- tion is well seen, characterised by large features. The strata N2 are 100 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, are here nearly vertical, stretching from north to south. The line of junction, which occurs on the face of the hill, towards its summit, cuts the strata at various angles, sometimes nearly at right angles; and the strata thus abutting endwise against the granite, the two substances are, as it were, spliced into each other. The granite enters among the strata in several large dikes or veins, which at first are a hundred yards in wideness, but which rapidly taper away to a small breadth. Along the whole line of junction, from this point north- ward to the burgh of New Galloway, at a distance perhaps of two miles, a scene of almost perpetual interest presents itself, being a repeated display of the penetration of the stratified mass by the granite ; and the rock being but thinly covered with soil, these circumstances come frequently into view, and particularly at the spots known by the name of Sight Knoll, and the Hog Knoll. In 1788, I had seen an instance of/a dike penetrating the strata, and distinctly emanating from the mass of granite, in such a manner as to convince me that it constituted with that mass one uninterrupted and identical substance. On my return in 1807, when the subject had ac- quired a peculiar degree of interest, in consequence of the dis- cussions carried on in this Society, the progress of vegetation had been such as to conceal it entirely ; but being well con- vinced of the reality of its existence, I determined to recover it, and employed several workmen to clear away the earth and vegetable matter from the most interesting spots. At various distances, within fifteen or twenty yards from the main gra- nitic mass, several masses of granite, or portions of veins, made their appearance, which I conceived to be emanations from the great mass, although their junction with it was con- cealed. I was anxious to trace some of these to their source ; and after the labour of several days, I at last succeeded with one AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 101 one of them, though I cannot tell whether or not this was the same which we saw in 1788. Having in this instance traced the communication between the vein and the main mass, I al- most exclusively devoted my attention to it, and, I trust, not fruitlessly. Besides exhibiting by a drawing, (Plate V.), the appearances of this very interesting spot, which is called the Windy Shoulder, I procured a more expressive representa- tion of it in the form of a model, which now lies before us *, The Windy Shoulder is situated nearly opposite to the point on the other side of the loch, at which the Shirmers Burn enters it ; the — bearing from it E..10 N. by true bearings. | _ The strata, whieh continue here in a vertical position, meet the granite on the surface at an angle of about 45 degrees. The dike runs for about twenty-three or twenty-four feet be- tween two of the strata; it then starts across them, and re- sumes nearly its first direction, which it pursues for a consi- derable aenegne more ; a in all. eer feet from the granite. Bt iy idle heed ‘pains to examine vith circumstances om tending the exit of the vein. The earth and vegetation were carefully removed. Some parts of the surface of the rock were dressed by a mason, and a powerful temporary polish was given to that surface by water dashed upon it. All these pre- cautions tended to confirm the identity and continuity of the two rocks, which appeared more and more conspicuously after every fresh exertion that was made to remove the influence of external actions. SE’ tro to enews vod 4 Several Sst BIORTE SrTParoeial f f * L have also carne one ‘of these models to the Geolopicel Society of London, 102 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, Several small veins were found to cross from the dike to the main mass, having an identity of substance throughout. That which is represented in the model, incloses a triangle of killas, whose sides are seven feet by five; the strata being here moved by a small shift. Many other smaller veins oc- curred of the same kind, and in the same position, which have been omitted as too minute. The dike, near its exit, also ex- hibits a fine example of another most important and instruc- tive circumstance in geology. ‘The granite actually contains a mass of the stratified body included in its substance, and surrounded on all sides with granite. In the immediate neighbourhood of the granite, to the dis- tance of a foot or two, and not more, the stratified matter has in many instances assumed a highly micaceous character, so as to deserve the name of Mica-slate, and perhaps of Gneiss. Every thing seems to indicate that those dikes, which ap- pear on this hill in such abundance, and which have been shewn in this case to be continuations of the same mass, have come from below; and this opinion seems to be strengthened by the fact, that on the north-west side of the same Windy Shoulder, the granite at the junction seems to dip under the kcillas. From the shape of the ground, sinking rapidly below the line of junction, I expected easily to reach the granite, by blowing up with gunpowder the killas at some point beneath this line. The first blast did not succeed ; but a second, near. the junction, was very effectual. It rent the mass at right angles with the junction, by which the granite is seen actually to dip under the killas, as at first supposed, with an irregular line. The surface being dressed at the emergence of one of the small veins from the great mass, the following curious fact presented itself. To the distance of about three inches with- in AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 103 in the junction, the progress of the granite vein was visible through the outer part of the granitic mass ; the substance of which last was there in a confused and undefined state: far- ther in, the vein spread wider, and in the space of a few inches more, was quite lost in the general mass. I account for this by supposing, that the granite near the junction being partly cooled, and partly contaminated chemically by the contact of the strata, is rendered less liquid than elsewhere, and that a quantity of more thoroughly liquid matter occasionally and subsequently forces its way through this barrier, and through the contiguous substances. . We have thus a representation in miniature of one of those events which I conceive to have happened on a large scale in the formation of that mass, which, in its present elevated si- tuation, constitutes the body of our island. One portion of liquid granite, forcing its way among the strata of killas, then lying low and flat at the bottom of the sea, and in a state of softness and pliability from semifusion, has, by its swelling, pressed them into a convoluted shape, and has taken its station among them. By the progress of cooling, this whole assem- blage, both stratified and unstratified, has become susceptible of laceration, and has been rent by subsequent forces acting from below. A fresh stream of liquid granite has penetrated into the rents so formed, and has swelled and spread among the convoluted and broken killas, so as frequently to occupy an extent of many miles, constituting one of our external gra- nitic masses. But this last-mentioned invasion, though doubt- less producing a comparative elevation, has still, I conceive, taken place at the bottom of a deep sea, where our sandstone strata have since been deposited, on the rock both of killas and. of granite; and where the fragments composing that sandstone have undergone the moderate heat by which they vile have 104 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, have been converted into stone. The whole assemblage of granite, killas and sandstone, having been raised into the posi- tion which they now occupy, by revolutions of a still posterior date. The present order of things may thus be accounted for, by a set of progressive steps of elevation, without the necessity of supposing, everywhere, an interposed submersion. Not that I am disposed to deny the occasional occurrence of such submersions; which may naturally be expected to have taken place, in consequence of the voids, which could not fail to be produced by so many undoubted elevations. The circumstances thus stated are different, as may be ob- served, on the Hill of Lauren, from those of the junction on the bed of the Water of Dee, as described above; but such differences are perfectly consistent with our view of a liquid forcing its way among a set of beds previously consolidated and indurated. 1 The conformable junction at the Water of Dee, is the only one which, being ambiguous, does not contradict the Werne- rian view of the general system ; a view that is completely ex- cluded by the perturbed junction at Lauren. Now, both of these junctions are consistent with the Huttonian theory, ac- cording to which, a diversity of this sort was to be expected in such circumstances. It is very obvious, that the substance of a vein must be of newer formation than the rock through which ihe vein passes ; and it is no less obvious, that where the angu- lar fragments of one substance are contained in another, the substance thus contained must be the older of the two. In these observations, we have seen that two veins of granite, which penetrate the killas, do constitute one continuous mass with the great body of granite which lies below, and are of course of contemporaneous formation with it. The conclu- sion, AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 105 sion, then, is irresistible, that the granitic mass of Lauren is posterior in formation to the killas which lies above it. This admits of no other rational solution, but by supposing, as Dr Hourtron has done, that the granite, in a liquid state, has flow- ed in its present position, and that emanations from that li- quid penetrating into the rents of the strata, have formed the veins. The same general facts which have been observed with re- spect to the granite of Lauren, and the district of which it makes a part, occur also in the other two granitic masses of Galloway, as I have found by a particular examination of cane junctions with the strata. I was convinced of this as to the mass which crosses Loch Doon, by a circuit which I made of that mass in 1807, accom- panied by Mr Jarprne of this Society. In the island upon which the Castle of Doon stands, a fine example occurs of an- gular fragments of killas, included in the granitic mass near the junction. The dressing which this stone has received from the hand of nature, ietales this very conspicuous, as I shall have occasion soon more particularly to state to this So- ciety. I have at different times, though not with the same regula- rity, examined various places, where the third granitic mass in Galloway, of which the Mountain of Criffel makes part, meets the surrounding strata ; and I have seen dikes of granite near the junction, and other circumstances leading to the same conclusion, particularly on the sea-shore, at a place known by the name ef the Needle’s Eye, which approaches to the granite boundary; and also on the side of Criffel, — lies directly opposite. ' According to a rough computation, are of these three granitic masses occupies a space of about six miles by four. Vou. VII. "iO 3 Their 10 6 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, Their positions, and bounding lines, which are very irregular, are laid down, as nearly as we could guess, in the map of the stewartry of Kirkcudbright, now ‘om the table. There is good reason, I conceive, to suppose, that all granitic masses are related in a similar manner to the neighbouring strata, where such strata are found penetrated by granitic veins. Such veins were first observed, I believe, by M. pvr Saus- surE, in the Valoisine, and also at Lyons and Semur. Dr Hurron examined them with great care in Glentilt, in Arran, and in other parts of Scotland, and upon these obser- vations founded his bold and original theory with respect to granite. Mr Prayrare has not failed to make ample use of those which he has more recently discovered at St Michael’s Mount in Cornwall. All the appearances which I have wit- nessed in Galloway, as to the relative situation of granite, and the contiguous rock, accord with the doctrine of Dr Hurron, and tend, I conceive, to confirm his views. It might be rash to extend universally to all granite those conclusions which have been established by particular obser- vations ; yet as no instance warranting a contrary inference has occurred since the subject began to be inquired into, enough seems to have been done to contradict the generality of that leading maxim of the Wernerian doctrine, that the order of position which rocks maintain with respect to the centre of the earth, denotes the order of formation. It is an important circumstance to observe, that the sub- stance whose formation is thus proved to be prior to that of the granite of Galloway, is the killas, or grauwacke of the German school, which, holding only a middle station among stratified bodies, as to antiquity, is considered, according to their doctrines, or of formation long subsequent to that of any kind of granite. The quality of this. stratified mass, from AND THEIR MEETING WITH GRANITE. 107 from one side of the island to the other, seems to be uniform throughout, except in the immediate neighbourhood, or con- tact of the granite, where it assumes a micaceous character, approaching to the nature of gneiss or mica-slate. This fur- nishes a most notable indication of the action of heat ; since the granite, by its local intensity, has performed the very ef- fect which Dr Hurron ascfibes to the general heat below, as acting upon the lower beds, and converting them into gneiss. Another cireumstance of - importance is, that at the Rae Quarry in Peeblesshire, nearly in the middle of this mass of killas or grauwacke, a a bed of limestone occurs, interstratified with the killas, and of course coeval with it, which bed con- tains shells in abundance. Now, as this mass of killas has been proved to be of older formation than the granite of Gal- loway, it is obvious that granite is here found to be of a for- mation posterior to the existence of living animals. The relative age of granite and of sandstone has not been decided in any case that I have had occasion to observe, and is a point of considerable importance in geology. Nothing Seems as yet to prove, that granite may not have flowed up against a stratified mass, possessing, in some of its parts, the properties of sandstone ; I conceive, however, that these pro- perties will nowhere be found to belong to that part of the stratified mass which lies close to the granite. For we have seen, on the Lauren, that killas near the junction has been changed into gneiss or mica-slate by the heat of the granite, as we conceive ; and there is still stronger reason for believing, that a similar change would take place on sandstone in the same circumstances. We ought, therefore, to find, that while a remote portion of the stratified mass retains the properties of sandstone, that which lies but at a little distance from the 02 granite, 108 ON THE CONVOLUTIONS OF STRATA, &c. granite, has been converted into gneiss or mica-slate, or at least into killas; and this view is confirmed by the circum- stance, that no example has been produced of granite veins traversing sandstone. I expect, then, that granite and sandstone will not be found to occur in immediate contact, unless where the latter has been deposited upon the former. In the junction which is seen in the bed of the river near Jedburgh, and in that at the Siccar point, on the coast of Berwickshire, we see that the sandstone has evidently been deposited in the state of loose sand, on killas then existing as a hard and shivered rock. We may easily conceive, that sandstone has been deposited in a similar manner on the granite of second invasion ; and that, in a similar manner, it has been consolidated and ele- vated. I have not met with an example of this; but such may be looked for, and will be interesting in geology. I have just learnt from a young friend, member of this Society, who has spent a few days in the course of this year at the Cape of Good Hope, that upon the side of the Table Mountain, a junc- tion occurs of granite with killas, and that, higher up on the hill, the same granite actually meets with sandstone. I hope soon to have the means of laying before this Society the details - of these observations. II. TAC TYR | Se Cy an la be ji f ; Uys & \ A 7/ / | DP ESE NN TERN NAIR GUD ee *. eQen Ree il: ie . = : >... bu ml “y] mar Ree ; an are atte TR. SRS V\4 fe ey a —— BAST NL. im PUN Dy Co ~~ Ai) TT Moria Neu T. Morhat Seuip= N A TE, Lo af hay ars Wy ree GEE V4 j nh } S _ } AIK 1) eas III: Remarks on the Transition Rocks of WERNER. By Tuomas Atian, Esa. F.R.S. Enry. vad [Read Feb. 17. 1812.] . Lruovcu we have many writers on geological subjects,. whose works are distinguished by ingenuity of doctrine, and novelty of opinion, and, among them, some who have made advances towards arrangement ; it was reserved to the celebrated Werner, to introduce means, by which rocks might be described with some degree of precision. Many ingenious theories were invented, to account for. their formation ; but - little or no attention was paid, to the acquirement of an ac- curate knowledge, either of their composition, or their relative position in nature ; although these certainly appear to be the - bases, on which such speculative opinions ought to be found-. ed. But while we acknowledge these obligations to the Professor of Freyberg, we cannot extend our unqualified approbation to the systematic arrangement he has introduced. It was not to be expected, that the labours of one individual, who, from peculiar circumstances, was confined within certain limits *, were suffi- ; cient * In Werner’s Preface to his Theory of Veins, he states, that his limited for- tune, and the nature of his present situation, prevented him from travelling into more distant countries. AnpErson’s Translation, xxi, 110 REMARKS ON THE cient to attain perfection ; nor could it reasonably be supposed, that any district, however extensive, should be so singularly: favoured, as to contain all the variety of facts, that occur in other parts of the world, from which deductions are to be drawn, and elucidations afforded, investing phenomena. with characters which they do not present elsewhere, In forming his arrangement, Werner may have exhausted the means he possessed; he, therefore, ought not to be reproach- ed, for although his conclusions are more general, than are war- ranted by the circumscribed field to which he was confined, yet he has formed a groundwork, on which the labours of fu- ture geologists may rear a system, more capable of affording sa- tisfaction. It is greatly to be wished, that arrangements of this kind were less dictated by theory. The pupils of the Wernerian School have been peculiarly fettered, by an ideal necessi- ty of supporting the principles of their master ; but the blend- ing of theory with description, is an error common to all spe- culative geologists ; the support of preconceived opinions being very generally the principal object in view. Hence we find, that collections of those facts which are supposed favourable to certain doctrines, have been eagerly pursued, and others, equally interesting in themselves, entire- ly overlooked ; while that minute detail, which is alone capa- ble of placing the student in a situation to draw conclusions of his own, has been totally neglected. The part of the Wernerian System, which it is my inten- tion to notice at present, is the class of rocks termed Tran- sition. After stating the grounds on which this distinction has been established, and the particular rocks of which the series is composed, with their extent and importance, I shall endeavour TRANSITION ROCKS. IITt endeavour to shew, that those which constitute its principal members, are similar in different districts ; and, finally, that they are of an older date than Granite, which maintains the first place in point of priority in the system of Werner. i It is well known, that one of the principal arguments bicaaba forward by Dr Hurrton, is drawn from the penetration of the stratified rocks, by veins extending ‘from the mass of granite, which he considered as affording a decisive proof, of the subse- quent formation of that rock. It must not, therefore, be sup- posed, that I aim at any thing original in the above assertion, or that I even wish to limit the term Alpine Schistus, as ap- plied: by that ingenious philosopher; there can be no doubt; that, under this name, he ineluded both the Primitive and Transition stratified rocks of Werner; but in his time no di- stinction had been drawn between them: it is only Jater disco= veries that have imposed the necessity of more specific lan- guage, which may at once account for that want of precision by which his writings are so much obscured, and the deficien- cy of mineralogical flemawladgd, with which he has been so fre-. quently ‘huvvored: Wenner, in the construction of his systematic arrangement, thought that he perceived grounds for considering all ‘rocks, from Granite down to Clay-slate, as bearing marks of having been deposited from the original chaotic fluid, in a certain de- terminate order. In them no detritus, or anything like organised nature, was to be observed; and to this point every rock re- mained exactly in the same state, in which it was at the period when it first acquired — To these alone the title of Primitive was attached. In the rocks immediately following, of which Limestone is said to’ be the first, he remarked an essential difference; the limestone not only abounded in organic remains, but other members 112 REMARKS ON THE members of the series were composed of fragments, which must have existed previously in a different state: hence he inferred, that these rocks were formed at a subsequent period, which, from their constituent parts, he concluded, must have been after the creation of living animals, and nearly at the time when the earth passed from its chaotic to its habitable state *; and on these grounds he distinguished this class by the name of Transition. To this another class succeeded, also presenting new and di- stinct characters, one of the most remarkable of which is posi- tion. They are never found conformable with the transition rocks; while these present an uneven or serrated outline, ei- ther from the natural contortions of the strata, or the bro- ken edges of the highly inclined beds ; the rocks which suc- ceed, fill up the inequalities, and assume an_ horizontal posi- tion. To them he gave the name of Fleetz rocks. Thus the system is divided into three great classes, the Pri- mitive, Transition, and Floetz. Although the Transition has been known in this country as a separate class, only within a few years, yet it occupies a lar- ger superficial extent in these islands, than any other rock-for- mation. But before I proceed to trace its limits, it may be proper to explain what is understood by the Transition Se- ries. In doing this, and, indeed, in whatever else I have stated, with respect to the Wernerian Geognosy, I beg to be under- stood as having taken it from that work, which I consider as containing the most authentic account of the system taught at Freyberg; I mean the third volume of Professor JamEson’s Mineralogy. As Werner has published no account of it himself, it is only from the works of his pupils that we can become ac- quainted with his system. After the intense labour which has been * Jameson’s Mineralogy, vol. ur. p. 146. TRANSITION ROCKS. 118 been bestowed on bringing it forward *, it cannot be supposed to contain any errors, according to the strict notions of Wer- NER ; and if his pupils find it necessary to introduce any ma- - terial alterations, and so to mould it, as to suit their own subse- quent observations, it will no longer be the system of that phi- losopher,—which the arguments in the present paper are alone intended to meet. The Transition Series is composed of Limestone, Grauwacke, and Grauwacke-slate, Trap and Flinty-slate. Limestone is pla- ced first, as being the oldest member, and is said to rest im- mediately on the newer clay-slate +. Of this we have no in- stance which I am acquainted. with in Scotland, where, indeed, transition-limestone may be considered as rather of rare occur- rence. Grauwacke, and grauwacke-slate are with us the princi- pal members. The first of these is a stone usually of a bluish colour, passing into grey, and sometimes greyish-red ; it is composed of fragments, often of considerable size, but some- times so minute as to be scarcely distinguishable; these fragments are quartz, clay-slate, flinty-slate, and occasionally jasper, which are agglutinated by a basis of clay-slate, through which minute particles of mica are also sometimes dispersed. Grauwacke-slate differs from the fine-grained grauwacke on- ly in its minute stratification, and fissile character ; it bears so strong a resemblance to clay-slate in hand-specimens, that even an experienced eye cannot distinguish it; in the rock it is not so easily mistaken: it usually alternates with grauwacke, and is often remarkably contorted. Both substances are traversed by quartz veins, which are sometimes of enormous dimen- sions, but generally very minute and abundant. Vor. VIL. P The * Werner, “ after the most arduous and long-continued investigation, con- ducted with the most consummate address, discovered the general structure of the crust of the globe,” &c. Jamuson’s Mineralogy, vol. m1. p. 42. + Jameson’s Mineralogy, vol. m. p. 147. 114 REMARKS ON THE The only limestones of this class that I know of, are three : First, that of Rae Quarry, near Crook in Peeblesshire, where it is interstratified with grauwacke, and contains abundance of shells. The second is that of Cumberland, on the lakes of Windermere and Coniston, which also contains organised bo- dies. The third is the Plymouth limestone, which, according to the account of Professor PLayrair, corroborated by Dr Brr- GER, is also transition-limestone; and in it Mr Prayrarr states, that he found a petrified shell*, I have not my- self visited the spot, but it is of consequence to observe, that the limestones of all these different districts exhibit traces of organic remains. The other transition-rocks, are Trap and Flinty-slate +; but I have had no opportunity of observing either of them in their natural position. Such, according to Wrerngr, is the extent of the Transition series ; but it does not compre- hend all the rocks which occur in some of the transition dis- tricts, particularly that of Cumberland, although, with little ex- ception, it is adapted to the south of Scotland, in a very remark- able manner. I may now notice the extent of country occupied by rocks of this description ; but such is our limited acquaintance even with our own island, that it can be done only in an imperfect manner. We know too little of the north of Scotland, to be able to say, what rocks occur beyond the Moray Frith ; but it is by no means improbable, that when these regions have been more fully examined, the transition series will be found among them. Indeed I have learnt from Dr Maccuttocu, that it oc- curs in great abundance in the north, i * Illustrations of the Huttonian Theory, p. 165. + I suspect. both these abound in the mountains of Cumberland, from speci- mens I have picked up among the loose fragments. TRANSITION ROCKS. 115 - J am inclined to consider, that it occupies a large propor- tion of Forfarshire ; and if I be correct in an observation made on the banks of Loch Katrine several years ago, the transition rocks extend in that direction. I have likewise found traces of them on the right bank of the'Clyde, near Dalnotter Hill in Dunbartonshire. But the transition country we are best ac- quainted with is that of the south of Scotland, which stretches entirely across the island. On the one side, it begins near the boundary between East Lothian and Berwickshire, and continues along the coast, to a little beyond the river Tweed. Extending a line from the first, to a point on the west coast, between Girvan and Ballantrae; and from the second, another which shall pass, by Langholm, to a point between Annan and Carlisle, we shall find nearly the whole of the intermediate space to be Transition, excepting where granite comes in, and some partial deposites of later strata, which occupy the lower parts of the valleys of Nith, Annan, &c. The mountainous ister of Cumberland, Westmoreland, and the north of Lancashire, which is divided from the Teesiriai tion of the south of Scotland only by a small proportion of pa- rallel strata*, belongs to the same, at least we know of none other with which it can be classed, although it contains a variety of rocks, which cannot be referred to any in the series of WERNER. Adjoining to this, in the western part of Yorkshire, the same rocks occur: it is on these that the limestone of Ingle- borough and Whernside rests. To this succeeds the extensive 2) ours district * This term has been applied to distinguish the sandstone strata, and in that sense I now use it; it is objectionable, however; for all stratified rocks present the phenomena of parallelism, consequently, without qualification, this term af- fords no distinction. 116 REMARKS ON THE district of parallel strata, including the coal-fields of Warring- ton and Wigan, and the great alluvial deposite of Cheshire. These bring us to the neighbourhood of the Welch mountains, which I believe are all of the same nature, some specimens ha- ving been given me by a member of this Society, taken from the summit of Snowden. Grauwacke, according to Mr Arkin, makes its appearance at Church Stretton in Shropshire * ; and near Hay, on the border of Hereford, I observed it my- self. A great part of Somerset, and, finally, the whole of Devon and Cornwall, again excepting the granite, and a small por- tion of serpentine, and some other rocks, are all composed of Transition strata. Thus, by extending a line almost due south, from Berwick to the English Channel, we shall find a large proportion of the country to the west composed of Transition rocks ; while, so far as I know, none occurs to the east of it; al- though it is probable, that at Mount Sorrel in Leicestershire, some of the same series may be found. We are still less acquainted with the precise limits of its ex- tent in Ireland: we know, however, that it occupies the coast, from Belfast Lough to the mountains of Morne, which are of granite; it also extends westward as far as Monaghan, and probably much beyond that point. From what Mr Wetrp states, in his account of Killarney, it appears to be the princi- pal rock of the Kerry mountains, and I know it occurs in great abundance in the county of Cork. Hence, even with the little information we possess respect- ing its exact limits, we have enough to know, that the transi- tion rocks form a very large proportion of the superficial ex- tent of Great Britain and Ireland, and also comprehend the principal mining districts. Having * Geological Transactions, vol. 1. p. 212. TRANSITION ROCKS. 117 ‘Having thus imperfectly chalked out the boundaries, or ra- ther localities of the transition districts in these islands, I shall endeayour to shew that some of the rocks of Cornwall are grauwacke, in all respects similar to some of the south of Scot- land ; and if strata may be compared to the leaves of a book, a few decided and indisputable specimens are sufficient to cha- racterise a district. It was in consequence of some observations during a tour through Cornwall and Devon last summer, that I was led to suspect this class stood in a very different relation in point of period, with respect to granite, from that which I had hitherto conceived ; greater experience, or perhaps sufficient attention to the writings of Dr Hurron, might have pointed out this before. . Had I looked more attentively into his description of the granite district of Galloway, and at the same time attended to the na- ture of the stratified rock of which that country is principally. composed, this fact would not have been new to me now. There were other circumstances, however, which severally contributed to prevent me from supposing that grauwacke: could occur in this position. First, The unlimited use to which Dr Hurron applied the: term Alpine Schistus, left us quite uncertain with respect to the species of rock he meant: secondly, the alteration induced. on grauwacke,near its junction with granite,—a circumstance so- strikingly exemplified in Galloway, that I own it deceived my-. self; and, lastly, the assertion I have so often heard repeated by the Wernerian geognosts, that granite veins never occurred excepting in rocks formed of the same constituents, alluding to. gneiss and mica-slate. _ Before I visited Cornwall, I knew that granite abounded in the Stannaries, and that tin and wolfram, metals which are con- sidered nearly of the highest antiquity, were there common: productions.. 118 REMARKS ON THE productions. I therefore expected to meet with a perfect epi- tome of the Wernerian System, containing the usual series of primitive rocks, descending from granite, through gneiss, mica- slate, and clay-slate, with all the e¢ ceteras of serpentines, traps and porphyries ; but in this I was mistaken. On my approach to Exeter through Somerset, I first obser- ved the transition strata. between Bridgewater and Taunton ; (Nos. 1. &2.*) and from thence traced them,more or less distinct- ly, till I crossed the river Teign, which bounds Dartmore on the east. Thus far great part of the country is very flat, some of it extremely hilly as a road, but none of it mountainous. The transition strata are by no means continuous, and in many places appear only in small projections above the surface. On the right bank of the Teign, the road winds up the side of a steep hill; and where the rock is cut, there is a consider- able display of strata, having all the external appearance of grauwacke. On examining it, I found some of the strata coarser than others; but, in general, the grain was extremely fine, (Nos. 5,6, 7.) the texture solid and compact, the colour very dark-grey: it was very tough under the hammer, it broke with a smooth, and somewhat conchoidal fracture, and did not split into the thin lamine of the grauwacke-slate. This appearance puzzled me at first; the rock presented all the external characters of grauwacke, and yet internal- ly it was different. I had not proceeded many paces, how- ever, when I came upon Granite, (No. 8.) the proximity of which, as before mentioned, is always marked by a very material alteration in the consistence of the adjoin- ing rock. This alteration, I observe, was not unnoticed by Dr Bence, in his interesting paper + on the physical structure of * The numbers refer to the Appendix, at the end of this paper. + Geological Transactions, vol. x. p. 112. TRANSITION ROCKS. 119 of Devon and Cornwall. In mentioning grauwacke, which he distinguishes from grauwacke-slate only by its compactness, he says, “ It is found higher up than the grauwacke-slate, it *“ may be supposed to have been precipitated more slowly, and “ under less powerful pressure ; whereby the mass has been al- “ lowed to contract, and to assume a kind of crystallization. It “ rests immediately on granite.” The conclusions he draws are different from mine; but from the above quotation it appears, that the circumstance I observed at Teign Bridge is usual in similar situations all over Cornwall. Near St Austle, on the road leading to Carclaze mine, I found grauwacke, (No. 23.) in my opinion extremely well cha- racterised; also on the road to Cambourn, not far from Dol- coath, (No. 31.) ; likewise on the shore near Penzance (No. 42, 43.). Here it is also fme-grained, and tough under the hammer, and at no great distance from granite. Near Oak- hampton, I found it along with grauwacke-slate, in the most unequivocal state, (No. 57.) ; and on the shores of the Bristol — Channel, near Ilfracombe, the rocks are all of the same mate- rial *. Here, on the beach, to the west of the town, I spent some hours the evening before I crossed to Swansea ; and found no- thing among the rocks, to lead me for a moment to question, that they were wholly composed of grauwacke. Indeed I even remarked some of the contortions which are so common in this rock. Next morning, however, when walking down to the boat, under a point where a small battery is built, I found on the * The specimens alluded to, were examined by the gentlemen present when ‘this paper was read, who considered those from the road leading to Carclaze mine, and from near Oakhampton, as Grauwacke; and those from the vicinity of Penzance as Greenstone. 120 REMARKS ON THE the trodden surface of the rock, an appearance very similar to mica-slate, for which. substance it might readily be mista- ken, (No. 61, 62.), but this resemblance appears to be owing to the friction of the feet, and the action of the weather, on a variety of grauwacke, containing an unusual proportion of mica. By casting an eye over the map of Cornwall, it will be ob- served, that the above specimens are selected from the most remote corners of the peninsula. On examination, I think they will be found sufficiently similar to the Grauwacke of Werner, to be entitled to be classed along with that rock. Dr Bercen, in his paper on the physical structure of Cornwall, gives them no other name, and if authority is to be qualified by experience, the opinion of one who has traced the footsteps of SaussurE, and who has studied the geognosy of WrRNER with the utmost enthusiasm, cannot fail to be received with re- spect. F I have thus endeavoured to shew by the selection of spe- cimens, and by the opinion of a very scientific observer, that the stratified rock of Cornwall is grauwacke. It would be un- candid, however, not to acknowledge, that the general texture of this rock was different from the grauwacke of the south of Scotland ; it was more of the slaty variety, and frequently seem- ed, from its smooth and soft feel, to contain a large proportion of magnesian earth *. I understand, in a course of lectures now delivering, a very material alteration has been proposed upon the Wernerian Sys- tem, * Since I read this paper, I have had occasion to pass through the transition country of Peeblesshire, &c. On former occasions, I was in the habit of search- ing for characteristic specimens of the grauwacke ; I now looked for such as re- sembled the killas of Cornwall, which I found in abundance, (Nos. 62, 63.). TRANSITION ROCKS. 121 tem, in order to introduce thisrock in a position distinct, and very distant from grauwacke. It appears to me much more simple to suppose, that rocks of the same class, in different districts, may present peculiar characters, than that the operations of nature should have been so multiplied and complicated, as to afford the endless distinctions which are thus required. | In- deed, I cannot help thinking, that if the Killas of Cornwall had been sufficiently known, it toad have excluded entirely the introduction of that harsh-sounding German term Grauwacke. Killas appears to me to be as proper a translation of that word as Specular Iron-ore is of Eisen-Glanz, and I think may be used with great propriety ; distinguishing Grauwacke and Grau- wacke-slate, by Amorphous and Schistose Killas. The only other rock of any importance in Cornwall is Gra- nite, termed Grauen by the common people,—a name also given to clay-porphyry, a substance found pretty frequently in large veins, (Nos. 16, to 19, 28,48.) The shades of distinction chro- nicled by the mineralogist, cannot be expected to attract the at- tention of the miner, who knows but two rocks, grauen and kil- las, throughout the Stannaries. It has been thought that a dis- tinct rock was understood by the term Elvan ; but this is a mis- take, elvan may sometimes be greenstone, but in general is either killas or granite, and is so termed by the miner when he finds the rock harder to work in one place than in another. Before I entered Cornwall, I was led to believe that it abounded in two kinds of granite, Primary and Secondary. Never having had an opportunity of comparing them in situ, I was anxious to do so here, and different localities were pointed out to me; these I examined with care, but could discover no grounds to justify any distinction. Dr Brrcrr makes no mention of secondary granite; and another gentle- man, whose opinion on this, as on most subjects, will be received with the utmost deference, and who had the same ob- Vor. VII. Q ject 122 REMARKS ON THE ject in view, during a visit made since I was there, informs me that he could discover no distinction at all. It is therefore of importance to ascertain whether the granite of Cornwall be new or old; which will easily be done, by com- paring the appearances it presents, with the descriptions of these rocks as given in the Wernerian school; it is there taught, that three formations of granite have been ascer- tained. The oldest is the basis or nucleus, round which all other. rocks have been deposited. The second occurs only in veins, traversing only the granite of the older formation. The third rests on some of the older primitive rocks, in unconformable and overlying position. From this description of its external relations, it is evident that the granite of Cornwall can neither be the second nor third. With respect to its internal structure, we have the following definition: Granite is a granular aggre- gated rock, composed of felspar, quartz, and mica. These al- ternate from large to small, and even to very fine granular. The large and coarse granular usually belong to the oldest ; the small and fine granular to the newest granite formations. Besides felspar, quartz and mica, other fossils sometimes occur in it; of these, schorl is the most frequent, then garnet and tinstone *. At Penzance I observed some buildings constructed of a re- markably fine-grained granite ; but this I nowhere saw in situ: otherwise, from Teign Bridge, where I first set my foot on granite, to the Land’s End, it is generally of that character which entitles it to be ranked with the oldest variety, (Nos. 8, 21, 27, 34, 35, 54, 55.) In many places it has suffered to a most wonderful extent by decomposition, but where it retains its freshness, no granite can possibly be better characterised. The + Jameson’s Mineralogy, vol. ur. p. 102, &e. TRANSITION ROCKS. 123 The specimens which I was able to bring away, and which are now before the Society, are by no means adequate to con- vey an idea of the coarse texture it sometimes presents. In the granite of Dartmoor, the crystals of felspar are uncommon- ly large, often four inches in length. I believe it was from this neighbourhood that the flags of the footpath on Westmin- ster Bridge were brought ; in these, crystals of felspar nearly as large may be observed. Granite countries usually present a bold and varied outline ; but to this rule Cornwall is a most decided exception : its as- pect is tame in the extreme, being comparatively flat,—a cir- -eumstance visibly occasioned by the corroding operations of time. Nowhere are the vestiges of degradation so remark- able as here. The enormous deposites of tin in the different stream-works, of which that of Carnon is perhaps the most ex- tensive, clearly prove the destruction of surrounding moun- tains. This tin, in the shape of rounded pebbles, formed a stratum, of about a foot thick, under a deposite of granite-gra-_ vel and mud, together forming an overburthen of forty feet thick, and occupying a valley of very great extent. The lodes which furnished this tin must have existed above the level of the deposite ; and from the quantity of metal deposited, they must have occupied a large tract of country. Other monuments of this general destruction may be found in the peaks which are seen im every direction in the granite districts of Cornwall. These are evidently the result of surrounding decomposition, and are formed of huge masses of rock, apparently piled on each other, with a regularity resembling masonry, and in all respects simi- lar to the arrangement observable on the summit of every mountain in Arran, where the traces of time are also deeply furrowed. Roach Rock, a binary compound of quartz and hornblend, is another very remarkable instance of the same fact: this rock is flat at the top, and being quite perpendicular on three sides, Q2 when 124 REMARKS ON THE when viewed from the west, presents the appearance of 2 square castellated building, which is rendered more conspicu- ous, by being nearly of the same height as the tower of an ad- joining church. There can be no doubt that this singular rock, owes its present appearance to the operations of time on the surrounding materials, which its peculiar composition has enabled it to withstand. The killas likewise presents marks of degradation, where the country is composed of that rock. I noticed in some districts the roads mended entirely with quartz, (No. 24.) ; the brilliant white appearance of which, after a shower, had a very curious effect. I could not comprehend by what industry the accu- mulated heaps of this substance were obtained: at last I per- ceived that they were gathered from the adjoining fields, and in some places picked from the surface of a common, by means of a hoe or mattock. That fragments of quartz should occur so unmixed with any others, is only to be accounted for, by sup- posing that they formed the quartz veins in the killas, which, from superior tenacity, resisted decomposition, while the softer parts of the rock, yielding to the action of the weather, were reduced and carried away. We thus find, that the granite of Cornwall possesses the characters ascribed by Werner to that of the highest antiquity. Some inferences may likewise be drawn, in corroboration of its title to be classed with rocks of this description, from the na- ture of the metallic veins by which it is traversed. In the German account of the relative ages of metals, tin is the third, and wolfram the fourth in order of antiquity *. If veins containing these metals, be considered in other coun- tries as indicative of rocks of the oldest primitive formation, the same application must be made to those of Britain. I may now ask, if this be not the Oldest Granite, where are we to find it? as it appears to me impossible that any sub- stance * Jameson’s Mineralogy, vol. u1. p. 275. TRANSITION. ROCKS. 125 stance can more decidedly concur with definition. In the Alps, Dr Bercer must have learnt what primitive granite meant; yet not a doubt escapes him, of the Cornish being any thing else. Distinctions either do, or do not exist ; if they do, character must be attended to; if they do not, it is quite unnecessary to add the terms Secondary and Tertiary to a substance posses- sing every attribute of a primary variety, merely because the structure of an adjoining rock does not accord with a specific theory. Grauwacke, or, as I shall in future call it, Killas, I have be- fore noticed, is a rock composed of fragments more or less comminuted, which. must have existed in another state before they assumed their present. arrangement. Along with the strata formed of these, beds of limestone are found, contaming indications of organic remains. These are not confined solely to the limestone, they occur also in the killas; a fact which may be witnessed at any time, .either.in the neighbourhood of Coniston *, or on the right bank of the Blackwater, a little. be- low Fermoy, in the county of Cork, (Nos. 66, 67.).. The for- mation of this class of rocks was therefore subsequent to.the formation of living animals, whose existence is supposed to be proved by the occurrence of organic remains in the composi- tion of the rock.. In Cornwall, in Westmoreland, in Galloway,.and in the counties of Down and Derry, this rock lies directly on. granite, —a circumstance which we should at first sight be inclined to consider as indicating its subsequent formation. This thought, however, vanishes the moment we contemplate the veins of © granite by which it is traversed. Of. these there are many ex- amples; | * Since I read this paper, I wrote to a friend at Coniston, requesting a. few of these specimens, well characterised, might be sent me: some of which are de-- posited, along with the rest, in the cabinet of the Society, (Nos. 64, 65.) 126 REMARKS ON THE amples; but the most striking are at the Louran in Galloway, and at St Michael’s Mount in Cornwall. : It is many years since Sir James Hatt laid before this So- ciety an account of his observations on the granite district of Galloway, of which the Louran forms a part; and to the perse- vering activity of that gentleman, we are indebted for the dis- play of one of the most interesting exhibitions of granite veins that exists. The peculiarities observable in Galloway, were first pointed out to me by him; and as he has so lately favoured the Society with a particular account of them, it leaves me no- thing to say regarding that quarter. At St Michael’s Mount, the shooting of the veins from the great mass of granite, is also most strikingly exemplified. They were here first noticed by Professor Prayram, who com- pares them, most aptly, to the ramifications of the vegetable root * ; for, indeed, nothing can be more illustrative of the phe- nomenon as it is here exhibited. It is to be observed that granite veins, particularly when ex- tremely minute, usually differ in texture from the mass to which they belong. While the little peak of St Michael’s Mount maintains a similarity of character with all the rest of the Cornish granite, not only in point of internal structure, but with respect to the tin and copper veins which traverse it, as well as by the massive blocks, hewn by the corroding hand of time, which ornament its summit; the veins that set off from it, gradually become finer as they recede, but still preserve the perfect character of the rock. The importance deservedly attached by Dr Hurron to the phenomena of granite veins, gave rise to a variety of hypothe- ses among those who were inclined to consider this rock as the original deposite, who have accounted for their formation’ in different ways. It * Tllustrations of the Huttonian Theory, p. 318. TRANSITION ROCKS. 127 Jt was first stated, that they were formed of newer granite, and, if properly examined, would be found to cut the ald gra- nite as well as the rock which rested on it. This opinion was-once very strenuously supported. in this country ; but as facts would not bear it out, it was abandoned. I find, however, in a recent publication, something similar to it maintained by Dr Luc, who asserts that. the veins at St Mi- - chael’s Mount are not granite, but merely quartz, which tra- verses the granite as well as the stratified rock. I cannot com- prehend how Der Luc could have been so much deceived at this place; as simple inspection of the smallest. specimen, will prove that he was mistaken. It was next said, that the veins in question were not true veins, but such as are termed Cotemporaneous. To support which, it was boldly asserted, that they never extended beyond. the limits of such rocks as were composed of the same mate- rials, gneiss and mica-slate. I trust it is now distinctly shewn, that they do extend bes. yond these limits, and likewise that they traverse rocks from | which, by no method of reasoning, it can be supposed that they could possibly be formed by secretion. The last opinion is that which has recently been brought forward by Dr Bercer*. After describing the granite veins of St Michael’s Mount, he proceeds to say, that they are simply elevations on the plane of the granite existing previous to its being covered by the stratified rock; that the spaces between them were filled up as the grauwacke was deposited ; and hence the abrasion of the surface, brought to light a section, which has merely an appearance of veins. _ Were the devotion of Dr Brrczr to his master less conspi- cuous in his geological disquisitions, I should be inclined, on the * Transactions of the Geological Society, vol. 1. p. 147. 128 REMARKS ON THLE the above statement, to call his character as an observer in question, having passed over in silence the detached masses of killas, which he could not fail to observe included in the gra- nite, and which the above hypothesis is as far from accounting for as either of those mentioned before. I have only a few specimens (Nos. 39, 40, 41.) to lay before the Society from the veins of St Michael’s Mount; but they are equally interesting and satisfactory. One, exhibits a por- tion of the killas bounded on each side by granite; another, a portion of two granite veins traversing killas; and the third a mass of killas included in the granite. Simple inspection is sufficient, in the first place, to shew that the opinion of Dr Luc is groundles with respect to the substance of these veins. One of the specimens also, contains two small veins of quartz, which are of the kind called Cotem- poraneous ; these keep the direction of the seams of the strati- fied rock, and are cut off by the granite in the same line with- out any interruption. | To the opinion of Dr Bercer they also offer some reply. If the grauwacke had been deposited on the granite in the way he supposes, it is natural to conclude, that it would have been arranged in lines parallel to the sides of the elevations, somewhat similar to the coating of bark on the trunk of a tree : but in place of this, the seams of the killas are set at an angle of about 30°, to the planes of intersection with the granite ; consequently, if deposited from a supernatant fluid, they have assumed a very different position from that which either mechanical or crystalline influence would have induced. The hypothesis suggested to Dr Hurron by the appearance of these veins, meets every difficulty : they conveyed to him evidence of being derived from a source of the greatest vio- lence ; and also that nothing but liquid matter injected from below, TRANSITION ROCKS. 129 below, could have created the disturbance among the stratified rocks, so conspicuous when in contact with granite. As itis a self-evident position, that a rock which is cut by a true vein, must have existed in a solid state previous to the formation of that vein; so is it equally obvious, that if the vein can be tra- ced into an adjoining mass, of which it is found to be a part, that mass must stand in the same relation, i in point of period, to the rock which. contains the vein, as the vein itself does : another, the i — must nan been of, prota formation to the included... No theory, however, but that of Dr Hurton can account for these appearances: to. no- thing but force can the position be attributed, which the stratified rocks haye assumed in the vicinity of the unstratified; and: nothing | but matter | ‘injected:i in a liquid state, . could possi- bly have formed the shoots which traverse from the great mass of granite perforating the stratified rock, and at the same time envelope detached fragments of that rock. As the idea of vio- lence i in these operations has. been so frequently combated, I cannot. refrain. from noticing here, a very striking mark. of it I met with at Coul i in Ross-shire, when visiting Sir Gzorcr Mackenzix. There the strata of gneiss are much disturbed by the 1 invasion of granite veins: near which, on the outside. curvatures of some of them I perceived rents similar to what we might expect, on bending a flattened, mass of clay, nearly de- prived of moisture. I am fortunately enabled to present to the Society specimens illustrative of this interesting fact (Nos. 68, 69.) dn, the, hears Pr: Dr Hurron, we find also some locmaals ‘to account. for; the diminution of grain. in the substance of, the veins. The same cause to which, in: a former paper,, I at- tributed the gradation in the texture of .greenstone, may be supposed to have acted here.; It does,not, howeyer, ob- _ Vou. VII. R serve 130 REMARKS ON THE serve an equal constancy, some veins of granite being as coarse- grained as the mass to which they belong. In a former part of this paper, I had occasion to notice an alteration which appears to take place in the texture of killas, when in the vicinity of granite. This circumstance was so re- markable in Galloway, at the Louran and other places, that I took the strata so situated, for mica-slate, although I had obser- ved no line of separation between it and the killas ; I was for- cibly struck with this, at the moment, but having then no time to follow it up, I was obliged to leave the country without any particular examination. It will be observed, by the specimens from St Michael’s Mount, that the killas there assumes the ap- pearance of fine-grained gneiss. At Wasseldale Crag, between Kendal and Shap, | noticed a rock, in the immediate vicinity of granite, quite similar; and I am told, that the texture of the strata, near the granite of the mountains of Morne, is altoge- ther the same. This alteration is always of a gradual nature; and is so im- perceptible, that it affords a good example of what might be understood by the German term Passage, or transition from one species to another ; this Passage, even admitting the sub- _stance altered, is of too limited a nature to constitute a distinct and totally different rock. _ This alteration, if traced with attention, may lead to some very important results ; but, without entering upon it at pre- sent, I shall content myself with recommending it to the no- tice of geologists, some of whom may consider it of too minute a nature to deserve attention. They may, however, rest assu- red, that it is only by an accurate examination, and a faithful detail of such objects, that we can hope to arrive ultimately at truth, the only solid basis of philosophic inquiry. I may be accused of generalising too much in the foregoing statement, on grounds so limited; it must be remembered, however, TRANSITION ROCKS. 131 however, that I have purposely confined myself to the exam- ples of the relations which exist within my own knowledge, between the Transition rocks and Granite. The same pheno- mena are familiar, where gneiss and mica-slate come in contact with that rock ; but as these strata are considered to be of a very different age, the facts which I might have cited, had my object been to prove the age of granite with respect to all other rocks, were unnecessary, when my purpose was to point out the relative ages of killas and granite. From what I have said, I consider myself warranted in fi-- nishing this paper with the following conclusions : The Killas of Cornwall belongs to the Transition series of. WERNER. The Granite of Cornwall is possessed of every character by: which the Oldest varieties are distinguished. That Granite, the nucleus round which WERNER conceives all other rocks were deposited, is in some cases actually of a _ later date than the Transition series, which comprehends strata containing shells; and that its subsequent formation is clearly evinced by the appearances at St Michael’s Mount. Hence, that the distinction of Transition rocks, is grounded. on false conclusions. And finally, That Werner must make very material altera- tions on his present system, if he wishes to accommodate it to the phenomena so commonly presented in nature. R2 | APPENDIX. wine 9 iol Mas Snr aie ot sno spt, ot <8 ti ts «ps ie vehi wiley ayer: arnt ; Ae eof on f slate pehare busted acdidine ote! spinel j ER ead gmt Shey Te Hor ‘a ~ wae fet (ber “ff eee: y ars oa :, ¥: ener. 133 APPENDIX. On a former occasion, I stated as my opinion, that all geolo- gical papers ought to be accompanied with specimens of the reeks of which they treated. This is a condition not always to be complied with, unless the intention to write precedes the examination, when a collection may purposely be made; but when the idea suggests itself, after one is far removed. from the district, it amounts nearly to an impossibility. In the pre- sent instance, although I be possessed of all the specimens necessary, they belong to a series which I formed for other purposes. Rather, however, than mutilate this, I have thought it better to present the whole to the Society, in. whose possession I shall have an opportunity of referring to them at any time; and as they have signified their acceptance, it is necessary to add to my paper, the following brief list of the minerals I collected, which are marked and numbered, as picked up on my route, commencing in Somersetshire, where the transition rocks first make their appearance, and ending at Ilfracombe, after traversing Devon and Cornwall in different directions. After leaving Bristol, on the road to Exeter, we traverse the limestone ridge of Mendip ; to the south of which, there is an extensive plain, stretching to beyond Taunton, whose unifor- mity is occasionally interrupted by small isolated hills, like islands in a lake. These are probably formed of Transition rocks, Nos. I, & 2. 5, 6, 7. 134 REMARKS ON THE rocks, although on the plain itself, where the soil is laid open, which is principally composed of limestone debris hori- zontal strata of the same substance were exposed to view. Ap- proaching Taunton, the road leads over some of these hills, and here it was that I met with strata highly inclined, very similar in colour and aspect to some varieties of sandstone, but considerably more refractory under the hammer, indicating, I suspect, the commencement of the Transition series. Vesicutar Trap. I found this on the road near the house of Sir Tuomas Actanp, a few miles north of Exeter. I saw none of this in situ, though very commonly in the buildings in and about Exeter. On quitting Exeter for Moreton, the road is extremely hilly, rising and descending over abrupt knolls almost all the way ; these are principally formed of a soft decomposing rock, in thin strata, breaking in rhomboidal fragments, and very similar to the slaty clay of Werner. After passing Teign Bridge, this substance assumes a greater degree of consistence, and occurs in strata nearly vertical, some of which are coarser in the grain than others. These were extremely difficult to break, and presented a close smooth fracture, approaching to conchoidal. The Teign is the eastern boundary of Dartmoor, and, within a few hundred yards. of it, and immediately beyond the strati- fied rock last mentioned, Granite occurs, containing very large crystals of felspar, which continues to within a short distance of Tavistock, situated on the Tavy, which bounds ~ Dartmoor on the west side. Here, as on the banks of the Teign, the. Killas rests upon the Granite. At Wheal Friendship, a mine at that time under the management of Mr Joun Tayzor, (to whose intelligence I am deeply indebted for a great share of the information I obtained, 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. TRANSITION ROCKS. 135 ) obtained in the country), I selected the following speci- mens, as illustrative of the Cornish terms, which certainly afford the best explanation that can be given, of a language entirely peculiar, _ Killas, by comparison with the Grauwacke Slate of Frey- berg, I find this to be quite as similar as any two speci- mens from the same quarry could be expected to be. Elvan, as pointed out at Wheal Friendship. This I took for coarse-grained Grauwacke ; it was very difficult to break, and a very small proportion of it exposed to view. I could not, therefore, observe its connection with the surrounding rocks ; but, from more minute examination, I suspect it may belong to a bed of Greenstone. . Capel, a veinstone or Salband, composed of Quartz penetra- ted by Chlorite. A Bunch of ore, is here exhibited by a portion of Copper- pyrites, in a vein of Quartz, which represents the lode. When found in this way in a mine, it is termed a Bunch of Metal. A heave to the right, the Killas is here ferent) in diferent directions by Quartz veins; that marked A represents a lode, intercepted and heaved to the right by B, a cross course. _When the lode is cut in a very oblique direction, it is said to be caunted. A Horse, when a lode is divided, and joins again, it is said to take horse, and the included mass in this specimen, is called the Horse of Killas, &c. A Squat, when the lode suddenly enlarges, it is called a Squat; and the metal it contains a Squat of Ore.—By means of this vocabulary, I very soon became familiar with. many of the commonest mining terms in the country. In Nos. 16. to 19. 20. 21. 136 REMARKS ON THE In order to form a junction between the Tavistock Canal and the Tamer, it became necessary to drive a tunnel, for a mile and a half, through a hill called Morwel Down, which promises to be a source of interest to the geologist. In forming this tunnel, several powerful veins of clay porphyry have been penetrated, the substance of which is in some places much disintegrated, in others firm and compact ; veins suppo- sed to correspond have since been observed on the surface. In the tunnel, the Clay Porphyry alternates several times with the Killas, which is here of a light-grey colour, and a soft friable texture. In the course of this undertaking, two workable metallic veins have been intersected, no traces of either had been found on the summit of the hill, although diligently examined. Passing the Tamer, we enter Cornwall, and at Gunnislake, is a mine of Copper in Granite ; and a little beyond, at Drake- walls, there is another of Tin, in Killas. Tin-vein in Granite, from Carelaze, near St Austle. Killas found on the road from St Austle to Carclaze; this I consider a very perfect specimen of Grauwacke. Mass of white Quartz, of which the roads are formed. Mixture of crystallised Quartz and Wolfram, covered with a coating of Bitumen, found in Poldice mine near Redruth, at the depth of 106 fathoms, in Granite. Arsenical Pyrites, mixed with acicular, dark, greenish-grey crystals, supposed to be actinolite, from Blaney’s — a branch of Wheal Unity. Granite, Cairn Brae. From a vein which traverses the north-east side of Cairn Brae: on the spot it appeared to me to be Clay-Porphyry, in ‘hand specimens it resembles fine-grained Granite. \— Vein-stone, Nos. 29: . 80. - 31, 32. 33. » 34, 35. 36, 37. Ss. 39to41. 42, 43. TRANSITION ROCKS. 137 Vein-stone of Quartz, impregnated with red Oxide ef Iron, and containing white Steatite, from Tincroft. From the high-read near Tincroft. This is a very tough rock, and very fine-grained: it appears to be a variety of Green- stone similar to NO. 10. Killas, marked with dark-coloured spots, from ‘the side of the road to Cambourn, a little westward of the last. Killas of a light-grey colour, from St Anns. From Beacon Hill, a conglomerate formed of the debris of Granite, very similar.to some varieties of Sandstone. Granite from the Land’s End. Hornblend-Rock from Botallock, a curious, little, but valuable mine, on the north side of sai Peninsula, near the ex- tremity. Cockie, massive Tourmaline, from the same place. Specimens from the junction of the Granite and Killas, at St Michael’s Mount. From the shore near Penzance: these I consider to be Killas of a very tough and compact variety, they are found very near Granite, or some similar rock, which presented some- thing so peculiar in the aspect, that I cannot Lig A recom- mending it to the attention of geologists. Serpentines from the Lizard. Hornblend-Rock, which forms the basis on which the light- houses of the Lizard stand. Clay-porphyry, near Trewithin. Granite, with a vein of Tin, St Stephen’s. Conglomerate of Say and Granular Talc, from the same place. Phosphate of Lime and crystallised Talc, in Granular Talc, from Stoney Gwins. Killas from a quarry between Bodmin, and the race-course of that town. This substance is very soft, but well adapted Von. VII. S for 54, 55. 56. 57. 58. 59. 60, 61. 62, 63. 64, 65. 66, 67. 68, 69. 70. 138 REMARKS, &c, for building, from the peculiar facility with which it is quar- ried ; the stratification being horizontal, and the cross rents perpendicular, and so regular, the quarry presents a very symmetrical appearance. Granite, coarse-grained, near Bodmin. Fine-grained Killas, near Launcestown. About seven miles from Launcestown, on the road to Oak- hampton, I found a quarry containing schistose and amor- phous Killas interstratified, the last of which I believe to be as perfect Grauwacke as any in the district of Lammer- muir. Greenstone, Hatherleigh. Variety of Trap from Cleave. Killas from Ilfracombe, alluded to in page 119. Specimens quoted, but not from the same country. Fine-grained Grauwacke, from Peeblesshire, in all respects. similar to the Killas of Cornwall. Note, p. 120. Shells in Killas, from Coniston. Note, p. 125. Same from Fermoy, county of Cork, p. 125. Gneiss from Coul, p. 129. Transition Limestone from Rae Quarry, containing shells, p- 113. IV. IV. On the Revolutions of the Earth’s Surface. By Sir James Hatt, Bart. Pr. B.S. Ep. & F.R.S. Lonp. PART L [Read March 16. 1812. ] E are never more disposed to give credit to a philoso-: phical system, than when we meet with a case of its: successful application, unknown to the author, or containing circumstances which he had not taken into account when ‘ib formed that system. The facts brought forward in the following paper, which, according to my view of the subject, clearly indicate the operation of immense torrents, can be accounted for, I think, in a very satisfactory manner, by the Huttonian Theory, and consequently afford some very powerful arguments in support of it. _ But such was by no means the view taken of this subject by Dr ld himself, or by Mr Puayrarr, who, since his death, $2 has 140 ‘ ON THE REVOLUTIONS has so ably illustrated and maintained his geological opinions. These gentlemen have expressed themselves, on all occasions, in a manner peculiarly hostile to the employment of such torrents as geological agents, believing that all the phenomena: may be traced to the influence of diurnal causes only. I have no hesitation in declaring my hearty concurrence in what I consider as the essence of the Huttonian Theory ; mean as to all that relates to the influence of internal heat in the formation of our rocks and mountains: But I could never help differing from Dr Hurrov, as to the particular mode in which he conceived our continents to have risen from the bot- tom of the sea, by a motion so gentle, as to leave no trace of the event, and so as to have had no share in producing the present state of the Earth’s surface. _ At an early period of life, while I imbibed from the delight- ful conversation of my worthy friend Dr Hurron, the spirit of his geological views, I retained my attachment to opinions suggested by M. ve Saussure’s observations, which, at a still earlier period, I had acquired in the Alps, and which had been: rivetted in my mind by the sight of the pheno- mena from which they have. been inferred. The facts also observed in the Russian empire, and bropght forward. by Professor Patxas, relative. to the productions of the tropics, which are found upon the banks of the Frozen Sea, appeared to me of sufficient force to justify his belief, that, at some re- mote period, a torrent of water had swept across the conti- nent of Asia. I have, therefore, been always disposed to com- - bine the doctrines of Hurron with those professed by the gen- tlemen just named, relative to marine inundations ; and a num- ber of facts which I have observed in this country, will con- tribute, I hope, to throw some additional light upon this. diffi- cult subject. Before OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 14] Before mentioning my own observations, [ beg leave to lay before the Society the state in which I found the question. The central ridge of the Alps, of which Mont Blanc is the principal mountain, consists, as is well known, of Granite. Nearly parallel to it, and at a distance of fifty-four miles to the north-west (by Sir Grorce Suucksurcn’s measurement) lies the mountainous ridge of Jura, fifty or sixty miles in length, composed entirely af calcareous matter. Between these two ridges are interposed the valley and lake of Geneva, and other valleys and inferior hills. The native place of the granite is confined to the centtal ridge; but over the surface just de- scribed, innumerable detached granitic blocks are very irregu- larly scattered, which have originated, as we must presume, in that central ridge, and have been transported. to their pre- sent position by some mechanical power. Upon the southern side of the Baltic, a multitude of similar blocks are found, also scattered irregularly over a sandy di- strict, of which a particular and detailed account is given in M. ve Luc’s Geological Travels, vol. i. The origin and history of such blocks, which occur in va- rious other places, have given rise to considerable discussion ; and. the question is inseparably connected with other points of magnitude in geology,—such as the formation of valleys and lakes, and the distribution and arrangement of various beds of clay and gravel, and of all the loose and alluvial as- semblages which occur under various forms in all parts of the globe, anal constitute its most valuable districts i in point of fer- Bao M. pe Saussure ascribes the transportation of the granitic blocks on the Alps to the action of an immense torrent of wa- ter, or Debacle, as he terms it, which at some remote period, flowing over the summit of the Alps, had carried these blocks along with it. Dr 1492 ON THE REVOLUTIONS Dr Hurron and Mr Prayrar, as I have already said, deny the necessity of introducing such an agent, since the circum- stances, as they conceive, might have been produced by the usual action of rivers. But this simple view seems to be ex- cluded, when we consider both the magnitude and the posi- tions of these blocks. Their size, in some cases, amounts, as in the valley of Monetier upon Saleve, to 1200 cubic feet, and in the case of those on the Coteau de Boisy, to 2250, and even to 10,296 cubic feet, which is the measure of the block called Pierre 4 Martin. To move a mass of granite of even fifty or sixty cubic feet, and to carry it a few yards, would require the utmost efforts of the Rhone or the Arve, as they flow near Geneva, in their highest floods, but that such blocks could be conveyed by one of them along its whole course, is contrary, I conceive, to all experience, and still more when we consider that these rivers are divided at their source from beneath the Glaciers into for- ty ot fifty small streams. Yet from the Glaciers, these blocks must have come ; and when we take into account the magni- tude of some of the granitic masses, it is clear that the task is beyond the power of any river that flows on the surface of the earth ; nay, it seems more than water, under any predicament, could accomplish, and more than could be expected from the Debacle itself, however extravagant its magnitude may appear: but we shall again return to the subject, and shew in what manner this difficulty may be explained. These stones do not lie merely in the beds of rivers, but oc- cur all over the country, and on the summits of mountains, where rivers could least be conceived to have flowed ; nor are they confined to that side of the country, or to the side of the lake of Geneva which lies next the Alps; for we find them in particular on the face of Jura, which fronts the central ridge and OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 143 and the lake, at an elevation of 2000 feet above the latter. A set of low hills also intervene, which occasionally hide that cen- tral ridge from the view ; and it is principally where the snowy summits are visible from the face of Jura, by means of some depression in these intervening hills, that we find those travel- led masses; as I remember well to have witnessed, at some of the places which Saussure has pointed out, where, in high situations, on the face of Jura, I rode through great assem- blages of granitic blocks, three or four feet in diameter. The force of this fact is admitted, but an attempt is made * even under that admission, to refer the whole to diurnal ac- tions, by supposing, that from the spot where these blocks lie, up to the summit of Mont Blanc, one continued solid plane has ascended, along which, on a declivity computed at one in thirty, these blocks may have been hurried by a stream of wa- ter; and that subsequently, in the course of ages, all the inter- vening mass had been washed away, so as to reduce the coun- try to its present situation. But this hypothesis removes the difficulty of the intervening valleys only; for the transporta- tion in this case would be eeecely less difficult than it would be to Geneva, as matters stand at this day ;—and a circum- stance occurs, founded upon the observations of Sir Grorcr SHucKBURGH, which seems entirely to preclude this hypothe- sis. According to his measurement and scale, as given in the Philosophical Transactions, vol. lxvii. the height of Mont Blanc is 14,432 feet above the lake, and the distance in a straight line from Jura to Mont Blanc, I find, by his scale, to be nearly fif- ty-four miles, and 2000 feet is the height at which these gra- nite blocks occur on Jura. The slope, therefore, along which these blocks must have descended, would be nearly that of one in * Tlustrations, art. 345, page 385. 144 ON THE REVOLUTIONS in twenty-three. But without inquiring whether or not this declivity would be sufficient for the purpose, it is of conse- quence to attend to another circumstance pointed out in these measurements. The line above which snow lies perpetually, during all summer, is there noted, and lies by the scale at 7500 feet perpendicular below the summit of Mont Blane. It is easy, then, to calculate to what horizontal distance from the centre of the ridge, this limit of perpetual snow would extend, and we thus find it to be 32 miles *. But Saussure has found the junction of the granite with the surrounding strata at the Buet, and by the same scale, I find the distance of this moun- tain from Mont Blanc is about 10 miles. It is obvious, then, that in the supposed situation of the Alps, in which the gra- nitic * Let AD be Jura, and BC Mont-Blanc. Let D be the place on Jura where the blocks lie; the line DC will be the outline of the supposed surface. Let AB be drawn horizontally at the level of the surface of the lake, and DE at a level 2000 feet higher, meeting BC in E. We have then AB = DE =54 miles. = 285120 feet ; and CE = CB— EB = 14432 — 2000 = 12432 feet. The mea- sure of this declivity along CD may therefore be easily obtained. Thus, CE: ED: : 12432 feet : 285120::1:22.9, nearly one in twenty-three. Mr Prayrarr states it at one in thirty ; but he has reckoned to the summit of Jura ; whereas the blocks under consideration lie at some distance below that summit. Let CF be equal to 7500 feet, and let FG be drawn horizontally; then G will be the lowest point of perpetual snow upon the supposed surface. The horizontal distance of G from the centre will thus be obtained, CE: CF:: ED: FG, or 12432: 7500: : 54 miles : 321 miles. Let H be the ex- treme point of the granitic mass at the Buet, and let HK be drawn vertically ; the point K will.denote the limit of the granite upon the supposed surface. OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 145 nitic mass could not be conceived to extend farther than it now does from the middle, that the whole granitic surface must not only have been buried in everlasting snow, but that the ex- tent of this snow must have been three times that of the gra- nite. Now there is every reason to suppose, since the tempe- rature diminishes as the height increases, that within this up- per third, the temperature has never, in the hottest day in sum- mer, reached so high as 32°; that is to say, that water has ne- ver there existed in a liquid form. We cannot, then, conceive any block, however small, to have been conveyed from thence by means of water, acting by the usual diurnal laws, M. ve Luc admits the reality of M. pr Saussure’s debacle, and accounts for it in the same manner; but he does not ascribe to it, either in Germany or in the Alps, the transportation of the granitic blocks, the presence of which he accounts for very differently. He supposes that these blocks have nowhere migra- ted along the surface, but have been ejected from below, at the places where they now lie. This ejection he produces by a very extraordinary hypothesis *, founded entirely on gratui- tous suppositions, and which affords no plausible solution of the difficulty, by which we might be tempted to adopt it. M. vz Lc mentions a theory formed by Mr Wrens, a Pro- fessor of Berlin, to account for the same blocks.. He embraces a belief which seems to have been in considerable favour, that the level of the Baltic Sea has been sinking for ages past, and he extends his belief of the same change taking place in the - Vou. VII. T whole * He supposes, that below the firm crust of the earth, then lying horizontal- ly at the bottom of the sea, a set of caverns once existed, filled with peculiar elas- tic fluids. That at a certain period, this crust breaking to pieces, fell with great violence into these caverns, and drove out the elastic fluids contained in them with such impetuosity, that the blocks of granite under consideration, which then constituted portions of the lower part of the crust, were forced upwards into the air, and fell back into their present position. 146 ON THE REVOLUTIONS whole of the North Sea. His idea is, that a change has been gradually going forward in the position of the centre of gravity of the earth, which has been moving to the southward, and that an equivalent rise is experienced in the southern hemisphere. That when the North Sea stood at its highest level, these gra- nitic blocks had been transported across the Baltic, by means. of the winds, on floats of ice, and settling in their present pla- ces, had been left by the retiring waters. M. ve Luc, in a very satisfactory manner, in my opinion, re= futes one essential part of this system, by shewing, from the form of the new lands, and from other circumstances, that no change in level whatever has taken place on the surface of that sea for many ages back, and, indeed, ever since the surround- ing country has possessed its present form. As to the other part of his system, which relates to the transportation of these blocks by means of ice, we shall soon have occasion to resume its consideration. * Besides the consequences resulting from these particular phenomena, there are other material branches of Dr Hurron’s: theory connected with the same views, which in my opinion require to be carefully revised. The theory which he has ad- vanced respecting the formation of valleys, by mere diurnal actions, appears to me liable to great objections, and I cannot help agreeing with M. ve Luc, in much that he has urged against Mr Prayram on this point. I also concur with my friend Sir Grorcr’ Macxenzig£, in some general views, sug- gested to him by the aspect of certain rocks in Iceland, and in rejecting the slow operations of the atmosphere (Travels in Iceland, p. 39.) The difficulty is peculiarly great where a lake occupies the' bottom of the valley, and is very conspicuous in the case of the lake of Geneva lately mentioned. For, granting all that has heen OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 147 been advanced in support of the diurnal formation of the val- ley in which this lake lies, granting that it has been excavated by the diurnal actions, since these granitic blocks were deposi- ted upon Mount Jura; it still remains to be explained, how the lake of Geneva itself was formed, the depth of which amounts in some places (Saussure, art. 44.) to 950 feet. Now, as has very fairly been stated, this lake is constantly receiving all the spoils of the district which lies above it, called the Val- lais, yet delivers nothing at Geneva, situated below it, but pure water. It is evident, then, that every known diur- nal action tends to fill up this lake, and none to excavate it. This is therefore admitted by Mr Prayraar, to be a case “ in “ which hypothetical reasonings are warranted by the strictest “ rules of philosophical investigation, and where we must “ therefore have recourse to an agent that is invisible.” [//u- strations of the Huttonian Theory, p. 366. This acknowledged difficulty seems calculated to entitle the following speculations to a patient hearing from this gentle- - man; and he has already, in another part of the same work, expressed himself with regard to them, and other kindred opi- nions, in a manner highly encouraging to discussion, and which affords one of the most striking examples of candour that has ever occurred. _ © These arguments,’ Mr Prayrar says, (referring to those he had just been stating) art. 367. page 412. “ appear to me “ conclusive against the necessity of supposing the action of sudden and irregular causes on the surface of the earth. In “ this, however, perhaps I am deceived, neither PaLias nor “« Saussure, nor Dotomiev, nor any author who has espoused “the hypothesis of such causes, has explained his notions * with any precision; on the contrary, they have all spoken “ with such reserve and mystery, as seems to betray the weak- UD nal ag oe 4 on oR 148 ON THE REVOLUTIONS. “ ness, but may have concealed the strength of their cause. I “ have, therefore, been combating an enemy that was in some respects unknown, and I may a supposed him dislodged, only because I could not find his strong holds.” The charge of obscurity here brought ose ward, is very appli- cable to the diluvian system of Saussure and Dr Luc, in what regards the origin of the torrent, or the disposal of the water aften it had overwhelmed the land. The same charge seems not, however, to: apply to the suggestion of Professor Pazxas, who, in an early work, entitled, Observations sur la Formation des Montagnes, first published in 1777, has very, explicitly a- scribed the inundation by which he conceives the continent of Asia to have been overwhelmed, to the action of volcanoes ri- sing in the Indian Sea, and forming the Moluccas, the Philip- pines, and other islands, known or supposed to be volcanic. It must be admitted, that such an event may occasion- ally have happened. But the occurrence of similar catastrophes may be.inferred in a manner still more general and unequivocal, from those Plutonic * revolutions the reality of which has been established by Dr Hurron’s observations. According to his system, all our strata once lay at the bottom of the sea, and have been raised into their present situation by the subterra- nean and submarine exertions of heat, similar to that which ap- pears externally in the volcanoes. And the angular fractures. exhibited by these beds on many occasions, prove that this elevation. was performed in such cases when the mass was m a hard state. It is obvious, then, that the same principle: which I lately attempted to apply (page 87. of this volume) to the volcanic phenomena, as exhibited in the Atrio del Cavallo, will apply to those Plutonic revolutions ; and we are authori- sed tig a * I need scarcely say, that by the term Plutonic, I mean to characterize that. geological system in which the principal agent is heat acting under Compression. OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 149 sed on these principles to expect, that the liquid substances of basalt and of granite, in their progress through the rents of our strata, have been exposed to sonidelattor, like the lava in the rents of Mount Vesuvius; that their progress has been arrested, and the protruding energy accumulated in a similar manner, till it acquired sufficient power to break through that obstacle, or through some other opposed to it ; and it is manifest, however gradual and uniform the propelling farce may have been previous to its accumulation, that the ul- timate laceration must have been performed, by a sudden and violent motion, producing an earthquake at the surface, and ‘thus affording a more extensive and more satisfactory solution of that tremendous Phenomenon that is furnished by the steam of Mr Mrrcuett; though I am ready to admit, that in the vol- canic actions, the production and condensation of steam, on many occasions, has produced very powerful effects. In the Plutonic regions, as the restraining mass was beyond all com- parison stronger, and thicker and heayier, than in the most violent volcanic action, it must have exerted a power of resist- ance greater in the same proportion ; consequently, the time of that constraint must have been of imcomparably longer dura~ tion, and the violence of the shock, when the fracture did take place, though no less sudden, must have been cba inrlgr more powerful. Thus, as Vesuvius, in the course of the middle ages, was once at rest during several centuries, we have reason to presume that the Plutonic action, after being suspended for several thou- same years - should rush forward with a degree of violence pro- portioned * This observation meets an objection urged against Dr Hurron by M. pz Breisuac, a gentleman. to whom I feel indebted for the handsome manner in which he has mentioned the result.of my experiments, and who, on most occa- sions, has treated. our views with peculiar fairness, but who seems in this im- portant 150 ON THE REVOLUTIONS portioned to the time of its previous constraint, and capable of fulfilling all the conditions of Saussurr’s debacle, or the wave of Paruas; and the existence of these tremendous events is thus indicated @ priort by the Huttonian principles. T shall now consider, whether such traces have not been ac- tually left by these waves, as to place the reality of their exist- ence beyond all doubt. We have already alluded to some of these, and shall have occasion to mention some others ; but in a case of this sort, no historical, nor even traditional authority need be expected ; for though no limit could well be assigned to the magnitude which such a wave might actually reach, there is a decided limit to the magnitude of one that could be recorded; since, by exterminating all witnesses, every wave beyond a certain size would infallibly be the cause of its own oblivion. Those of a moderate extent are most likely to have been recorded by man, having sufficient power to pro- duce the most awful impressions, and yet sparing a sufficient number of witnesses to transmit the event to future genera- tions. In our attempts to elucidate this subject, we shall refer, in the first place, to specimens of this tremendous phenomenon in still lower stages of its power, since they alone have been recorded in an authentic and intelligible form, I mean, by res ferring to those agitations of the sea which have accompanied most of the great Earthquakes in our own times, as we learn from the following regular statements. In portant article to have altogether misapprehended the system proposed. In his late work, (Introduction a la Geologie, tr. Fr. p. 115.) he urges as subversive of Dr Hourron’s views, some thermometrical observations in which the bottom of the sea was found to be as cold as its surface. To urge this as an objection, implies that the heat employed in this system is supposed to be for ever, and everywhere, acting upon the sand of the sea; whereas it is well known that Dr Hurron conceived that the subterranean. heat, as well as that of the volcanoes, was subject to short fits of activity, with ages of intermission. a aoe einai OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 151 In the Philosophical Transactions, vol. xurx. p. 424. we have an account of the earthquake at Cadiz, by Mr B. Br- WICKE, merchant there, 1st November 1755, in which it is said, “ an hour after” (the first shock) “ looking out to sea, we saw a “ wave coming, at eight miles distance, which was at least six- “ ty feet higher than common. Every body began to tremble ; *« the centinels left their posts, as well they did; it came “ against the west part of the town, which is very rocky ; the * rocks'abated a great deal of its force; at last it came upon “ the walls, and beat in the breast-work, and carried pieces of “ eight or ten tons weight, forty or fifty yards from the walls,” We have another account of the same by Don Anronto DE Uttoa, Phil. Trans. vol. xu1x. p. 427. who describes the wave as having returned five times after the first*. And similar facts are stated. of other scenes of this sort. One circumstance in addition to those mentioned, which has accompanied. all these great events, and which seems at first sight to contradict our explanation of them is, that in all the agitations of the water, the first event has been a retreat of the sea. Mr __ ® He says, “ the inhabitants had scarcely begun to recover from their first “ terror, when they saw themselves plunged into new alarms; at ten minutes wel past eleven, they saw, rolling towards the city, a tide of the sea, which passed “ over the parapet of sixty feet, above the ordinary level of the water ; at thirty « minutes past eleven came a second tide, and these two were followed by four “ others of the same kind, at fifty minutes past eleven ; at twelve o'clock, thirty 6c minutes ; one o'clock, ten minutes; one o'clock; fifty minutes. The tides * continued, with some intervals, till the evening, but lessening. They have “ Tuined one hundred toises of the rampart, part of which, of three toises length, “and of their whole thickness, were carried by the torrent fifty paces.” It is remarkable, that in these six waves, the two first intervals of time are exactly of twenty minutes each, and the three others of forty. It is probable, that they have all resulted from one great impulse, Wgod 152 ON THE REVOLUTIONS Mr Mircuttxi says, Philosophical Transactions, vol. .1. p- 566. 611. speaking of the earthquake at Lisbon in 1755, “ the bar (at the mouth of the Tagus) was seen dry “ from shore to shore, then suddenly the sea, like a “ mountain, came rolling in. This phenomenon accom- “ panied the same earthquake at the island of Madeira, “ where we are told, that at the city of Funchal, the “ sea, which was quite calm, was observed to retire sud- “ denly some paces, then rising with a great swell, without the « least noise, and as suddenly advancing, entered. the city *.” He further states, in the same page, that “in the northern “ part of the island the inundation was more violent, the sea “ yetiring there above one hundred paces at first, and sudden- * ly returning, overflowed the shore, forcing open doors,” &c. Again, in page 466. he says, “ The great earthquake that de- “ stroyed Lima and Callao in 1746, seems also to have come “ from the sea; for several of the ports on the coast were ““ overwhelmed by a great wave, which did not arrive till four “ or five minutes after the earthquake began, and which was “ preceded by a retreat of the waters, as well as that at Lis- < bens Looking into the original account of these calamities in Don Antonio pE Uxtoa’s Travels into South America, French edition, vol. i. p. 467. I find that he mentions two events of this sort, which took place at Callao; one in 1687, in which the sea first retreated, and then returned with such force as to overwhelm Callao and other places. And again in 1746, when, in the course of twenty-four hours, two hundred shocks were felt : on this occasion, the sea retiring as it had done formerly, on similar occasions, returned furiously, and overwhelmed Cal- lao * Philosophical Transactions, vol. xu1x. p. 433. The retreat is here said to have begun an hour and a half after the shock. ees OF THE EARTH'S SURFACF. 153 Jao so completely, that nothing remained of the whole town but a remnant of Fort Santa Cruz. Out of twenty-three ves- sels at anchor in the harbour, nineteen were sunk, and the four others, one of which was a frigate, were carried to a great di- stance on shore, and left on dry land. At Callao, out of four thousand inhabitants, only two hundred were saved. Mr Mircuett endeavours to account for this, by his favou- rite doctrine of steam, according to which he conceives, that the strata at the bottom of the sea have been raised as a roof; he then continues, (p. 613.) “ now while the roof is raising, the “ waters of the ocean, over it, retreat, and flow from thence every way; this, however, being brought about slowly, they will have time to retreat so gently, as to occasen no great “ disturbance ; but as soon‘as some part of the roof falls im, the “ cold water contained in its fissures mixing with the steam, * will immediately produce a vacuum, in the same manner as “ the water injected into the cylinder of a steam-engine, and “ the earth subsiding, and leaving a hollow place above, the “ waters will flow every way towards it, and cause a retreat of “ the sea on all the shores round about.” But the gradual elevation of the roof, keeping tight all the while, which is here assumed as the steam was collecting, can by no means be ad- mitted; since, as we have shewn, a mass such as this, when forced upwards, would have yielded suddenly. ~ This phenomenon, however, along with all the rest mention- ved, may, I conceive, be traced as consequences of the simple, but rapid, elevation of the bottom, which we have ascribed to the forcible introduction from below of stone in liquid fusion. Water being almost incompressible, or elastic in an ex- ‘treme degree, it is obvious, that an elevation of that portion ‘of the fluid which lay immediately upon the part of the bot- tom raised, would take place almost simultaneously. This MV or. VIT. U elevation 154 ON THE REVOLUTIONS elevation would of course be the greatest in the middle, the quantity of matter in the vertical line being the least ; but there is no doubt that an action of the same kind, diminishing in a high ratio, as the distance from the centre increased, would be extended all round; the surface of the fluid being thrown into the form of some species of conchoid, produced by the re- volution round the vertical axis cb of the line dce, (Plate VI. fig. 1.) the highest point of which is at c, with a contrary flex- ure at f and h, and going off beyond these points, in such a manner as to have the original level surface of the water dbe for an asymptote. This conchoidal elevation, produced in the first moment, being just equal in bulk to the quantity of water displaced by the solid mass (aa) elevated at the bottom. If this mass stopped suddenly, as would naturally happen, when, in consequence of the rupture, the protruding liquid stone has found a vent; it is evident, that every part of the wa- ter put in motion during the first moment, would tend, accord- ing to the first law of motion, still to continue moving during the next and following moments; but this tendency could not be everywhere effectual ; because, if all the water that rose in the first moment were to rise also in the second, a vacuum would’ be the consequence. In the second moment, then, a struggle must take place between the different portions of the fluid; the middle portion, which had acquired the greatest velocity, would continue to flow upwards, and its place not being sup- plied from below, as, during the first moment, a suction would be exerted downwards, upon all the surrounding fluid. The consequence must be, that the rise which each particle would have performed by its separate momentum, during this second moment, would be counteracted by the pressure of the atmo- sphere, and entirely done away at a certain distance from the centre, as at f and h, fig. 2. ; beyond. that limit the water would sink ~ ae =< OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 155 sink below the medium level, as at k andi. An annular de- pression would thus be produced, surrounding the central ele- vation, vertical sections of which are exhibited by dif and hie; that depression below the. medium level being exactly equal in bulk to the additional elevation at the centre, occa- sioned by the momentum, the vertical section of which is fghe. The middle elevation, and the annular depression, would continue to increase during a period, and to an amount regulated by that class of laws, which determines the magnitude and duration of waves, as relative to the wind which produces them; and the water at the end of that period would be thrown into the position denoted by the dotted line in fig. 2., and by the single continued line in fig. 3., indicated in both figures by the letters dk f ghie. During a third period, the water flowing from without the annular depression, to fill it up, a wave of depression would be propagated outwards in all directions, and would visibly reach to places where the elevation produced by the direct impulse in the first moment, had not been at all perceptible, in con- sequence of their distance from the centre. It is owing to this cause, Iam convinced, that the catastrophes at Lisbon, at Cadiz, at Madeira, and at Lima, in so far as the position of the surface of the sea was concerned, were all first announ- ced by a retreat of the sea, as shewn at m, in fig. 4. During another successive period, the undulatory motion continuing, the wave of elevation would advance towards the shore at m, and being met by the retiring water, would produce the curling form called the breaking of a wave, as shewn at m in figure 5. At that instant the calamitous effects described in all the great earthquakes, as resulting from the sea, have been produced, Beye oct” . U2 PS mtg ny OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 209 of which is evinced, as has been shewn, by the concurrence of a three-fold set of facts, surrounding us in this neighbourhood. 1. The distribution. of loose matters in tails and ridges, on this side of the Island, and in knolls on the West. 2, The grooves and scoopings, and: obtuse-angled ridges, occurring on the surface of rocks of every description; and, lastly, the scratches and other minute features of abrasion, which are found to.accompany the large features, where the rock has been protected from injury. All. these events have been shewn to arise, as natural pi inialwalees on; of the ssmsaisisian Theory: civiitecos o As another consequence of lt hae T have also brought forward the formation of valleys of all sorts.. I have imputed the detachment of mountains, and the formation of islands, as well as of promontories and arms of the sea, to-cireumstances which could not fail to take place in the forcible elevation of stiff-and frangible masses, performed by a succession of local efforts from beneath, urged by irresistible power *. I have furnished a theory of the formation of lakes, which does not seem hitherto to have been accomplished in a satis- factory manner, by any other hypothesis. One class, belong- Vou. VIL. Dd ing. * Since the first part of this paper was printed, a very familiar circumstance has presented itself, which affords a clear illustration of this great natural ope- ration. When a mason is preparing common lime for building, he lays the burnt limestone in a heap, and throws water upon it; after this, some time elapses be- fore any action is visible, before the lime, as.it is said, begins to fall; in this in- terval the sand, which is to be mixed with the lime, is thrown upon the heap, so as to cover it completely, and the surface is made smooth and uniform by re- peated blows of the flat of a spade. Soon after this, a heave takes place from within ; the lime swelling, raises up the sand, and divides it by numberless rents, which becoming wider and wider mpwards, as the heave advances, a representa- tion in miniature is produced, of an alpine district. = ae * . ¢ “eae i; 4 210 ON THE REVOLUTIONS — > ®& ing to solid rocks, I have derived from rents formed b inequa- , lities of elevation, and the opening of rénts upwards. Another class, formed in alluvial districts, has been traced to modi cations performed by various obstacles upon the depositions * » made by the great inundations alluded to. rc “Y In thus controverting some of the collateral opinions of Dr Hurron and Mr Pe reatiy I venture to hope that my argu- ments, which have been founded on their principles, and which have led me to acquiesce in their most general and important conclusions, may tend less to weaken, than to confirm, the re- sult of their immortal labours. ¢ SPECIMENS. ee orn a ls i f° . gs “ Pug * . . " * ne ae OF THE EARTH'S SURFACE. 211 + ~~ . e te jf P * , * : 4 e. as @ SPECIMENS. . ties x” . aR No. 1. Craigietti Quarry, from” - « JW. 5S. to E. 5° N. - 2 Maiden Craig, - - WwW. 35° S. v 4 “Aes Ravelstone old Prantl W. due. 4. Well Craig, near NE W. 20° S. m 5. Craighouse Quarry, | W. 5° 8... 6. North of ruin at Dean of Noth -, Clermiston, - W.10° So « 7. North-east of cottages ierey, W. 10° S. 8. Middle of the North Hill Park, W.10°S. 9. South side of ditto, - W. 10° S. 10. Bare space west of summit, W. 10°S. 11. Summit of the hill, -« ‘W.10°S. 12. South-east corner of South Mid- Hill Park, W. 15°, , 13.. Summer-house on second sum-. a a ae. belonging to Ravelstone,_ W. 15° S.. 14. Sheep. Park of. ene __-Hill House,- » W. 8s. 15. Below Murrayfield Chany east” =a of Belmont, - ‘W.15°S. 16. Dickson’s Craig, aia us 3 Sie 17. Redhall, - - ~ .W.8°S, 18. Ravelrig, - ently «8 wW. rey ae 19. Kingston, near North Berwick, W..15° §.: - 3 od : . Dd2 VI ® , ? . ef a4 “ oF ' OR ee Oe RN ak. Sas ie. : oui gyiicr at gs : f ee a pt a ote ai ‘ me Nerd : 4 rs ra bce toe ee Pep SMC, I ince fats “pe ogee o> seaman, Oy ere ; SoM Siaeecehe. (Ae. erated er greene: Seat eran po ay Rahs a 4 — ni " ; -s ; » om * a - < v te a is 7; - - ; , F ‘i pax S fe 8 i : a a y : vi ees...) til wit 120 «oi 2b sik on aa gia Ae pac : ,. “af a - \ iS ee ‘= ? an, Ot ee ‘aed gba ’ See ee | PLATS “VI. Fig. = ms" Vol. VIL page 222. 7 / Sigs a, ? a Sa Nee a p42 Fig 3. g Bsr di Bx Make Dee wipe oh A eee h ‘4 oN as = =} SS SSS SSS eee : ie eos —— —— = ~ — ; as ; 2a = ea a SS Fig 4. a =e SO ns ee SS = %, = peu, aa a Be = = Wie 5. be 5 SS n =—— == 7 a . BN — — Engd bv We). Lesare Edint ‘ ‘ A = he i 2 ‘ ca } ' . - ae | ies ' 3 . ‘ a ey ‘ * a ‘ “AUTO BOY IIOW TRE yee . a es <° . + pot \ we, ¢ i 7 & x Ge hs 5, , re iF . as os t t . - wv - ‘ ; ‘ : f 9 J = - it eh a a OWS eAO D Uy SpA A ML PL UT Sys Wey, supgemny ya My pbug TNA eto == UH Pe Ae TOE T wrypa somup Cq posoarig pLINTor a. : . SNOW S a &j ; spredureq wn < We aH 4 Pooaead, op a8 il iN , “troaspoauyy ae = a2) apsey yoo ye et OTT TET eae bee Sa peoy $4 MoDSBTE) 4“ eo rune pl rae LS al > ~ ee 2 VI. | An Account of some Geological Facts observed in the Faroe Islands. By Sir Grorce STevart Mackenzie, Bart. Pr. Pu. Cu. R. S. En. [Read Nov. 2. 1812.] [ singular appearances which were presented to my view by the Trap Rocks of Iceland, and the interest which they excited, made me resolve, as soon as I had given an account of that country to the public, to visit the Islands of Faroe. This expedition was undertaken, for the purpose of ascertaining, whether, in a Trap Country, where no traces of external volcanoes existed, any thing similar to the peculiar features of the rocks of Iceland was to be found. In the latter country were discovered a series of rocks, lying above the beds of Trap, which bore the most striking marks of igneous origin ; in some instances having a perfect resemblance to ordinary Trap, and in others to the common Lavas of the country. The beds of Trap, and those above them, being separated by mechanical depositions of Tuffa (Trap-Tuff), led me to the conclusion, that the whole of the beds had been formed at the bottom of the sea, by successive eruptions of a submarine vol- cano. 4 214 GEOLOGICAL FACTS OBSERVED ’ eano. The results which I suppose may have attended a sub-.- marine eruption at a great depth, will be quoted in the se- quel. ‘ . ” ee The following observations of - ye respecting the forma-. tion of these islands, contributed essentially to confirm the de- sire I felt to explore the country. It must be believed, that this clergyman had possessed some previous knowledge of the — igneous theories. ‘“ It would form,” says he, “ a curious ob- ject of research to inquire, in what manner the Faroe hills have- been formed, and how they attained their present elevation ; whether above or under water? Whether they owe their height to volcanic explosions, which threw one stratum above ae or whether these strata were deposited upon each — other under the water, and were afterwards raised to their pre- sent situation by a volcanic eruption, or some elastic force pro- duced by subterranean inflammation; or whether these hills have been formerly covered by the sea, which has since retired back, in consequence of some convulsion of nature * ?” Again; “ But in examining the bottoms of the hills along the sea-coast, one will often discover indubitable marks of voleanic eruptions, or of some other convulsion: of nature, which. has acted a distinguished part in the formation of the singular phe- nomena which here present themselves to the eye of the curi- ous observer. It, is seen in many places close to the water’s edge, that the matter of which the rock is formed has been. in a state of fusion, and has become hard in its course. _Some-. times this hardened matter is smooth) on. the surface, but has the appearance of the ice on a stream or rivulet, where the wa- ter rises above the first crust, and forms several strata, one above the other ; but sometimes this hardened matter is rough, and * Lanpt, Translation, Lond. 1810, p. 5. 2 FPS ’ P ” tals” F & P gst? + a ne es ~ ‘IN THE mice ISLANDS. 215 wi pe and knobs, such as we may suppose would be rye _ seen tal first fused, and then cooled in water *.’ + Besides the desire natural to all travellers, to have a friend to a partake their “labours and enjoyments, the particular object I had in view, - iTSpeeped: it a matter of importance, that I, should » “ have. a companion, of whose competency to judge upon the i ° spot, of any new fact that might occur, there could be no doubt. On proposing to him to take a share in the, expedition, my lo @ friend. Mr ‘Tuomas ALLAN, whose great experience in geological . examination, and his intimate acquaintance with individual minerals, eminently qualify him. for research, rpadily agreed. to seapeipatyy me. The islands of F aroe,. or North Faroe as they are’ egratiicsls called, are nearly midway between Shetland and Iceland; and “Sie between the parallels of latitude 61° 20’ and 62° 25, Pinks ‘ing north and south about seventy-five miles. The meridian of the seventh degree of west longitude divides the group into two nearly equal parts ; the extreme points of land on the east and west sides including 1° 25’, or about forty miles. Besides a great many detached rocks, the islands are eighteen in num- ber ; the largest, viz. Stromoe and Osteroe, being in-the centre. The extent of the former is twenty-eight miles long, and, on an average, six miles broad; that of the latter, Shirts the same breadth, and twenty-two miles long. . The general aspect of the country is mountainous and preci- lester and, while the lofty rocks which frown over the ocean, inspire distrust in those who approach them for the first time, many excellent harbours are to be found, where sath of any size may ride securely. » The principal place i is Thorshavn, situate on the east side of Stromoe. It is a small town consisting of wooden build- ings, * ‘Lanvt, p..11. “te si * 216 #« GEOLOGICAL FACTS OBSERVED © ge Jai. Fy wi t . ’ _into a bay, and forming two very commodious har country in the vicinity, though by no means "the greatest tract of comparatively low land to be att ‘ in any of the islands ; but it is exces ingly bleak anc “y There are, in a few places, valleys of ies small extent ; the separation of the mountains being for the » most part narrow K * glens, and, in many instances, merely the breadth of a small te stream. ne —— The soil, in almost. eveapirt of the islands, is chiefly peat.” io No trees are to be seen, excepting one or two stunted moun- - tain-ashes in the governor’s garden. This deficiency of trees may be attributed, perhaps, more to the wetness of the soil than to the climate. The whole country abounds in springs ; no part of the soil being naturally dry, while, at the same time, it is very shallow. There are two lakes of considerable size in the island of Vaagoe. One, called Sorvaags Vatn, is about three miles long, and about half a mile broad. The waters of this lake approach very near the coast, which is lofty and precipitous ; and, after a. - short course, fall into the sea, forming a magnificent cascade — about eighty feet high. The other lake is on the north-west ~ side of the island, and is about a mile long, and a quarter of a mile broad. It is not named on the chart, nor by Lanpr. In Stromoe there are several small lakes, the most consider- _ sable being that near the village of Leinum. There are but few in Osteroe; the only one of note is . that called Tofte Vatn, at the south-east end. ‘ The streams are in general merely brooks ; that which is- sues from the lake of Leinum being the only one which can be considered as a small river. The variety of cascades which» © these streams form, is endless: and some of them, whe: swollen ee ea a : e P ea we “zs . ee a a al . en we bat * -* ¥ . i‘ ha _ IN THE FAROE ISLANDS. . 217 a 3 swollen by rain, are eaccedinly picturesque. Many of them ja vast i that they are completely disper- ry fall fr ast I _ © &sed into fi pray long eforegthey reach half-way down the precipice. _ itl td 4 di ptonniny ped: a variety of forms, but tend chiefly s . 4otesaume that of a cone at their summits, which are often m , sharp and tugged.) The Northern Islands, Kalsoe, Kunoe, Bor- “4 doe, and Videroe, consist of long sharp ridges, the summits being ~ broken into many fantastic shapes. The highest land is in Stro- ® moe and. Osteroe, which are separated by a narrow channel, _ which in one place is scarcely a quarter of a mile broad. The state of the weather prevented our ascending the highest mountain, called ‘Skel ingtell, in Stromoe: but we succeed- ed in reaching the summit of one of the highest mountains in Osteroe, called Slatturtind, near the village of Eyde. By barometrical observation, this appeared to be 2825 feet above the sea. Skellingfell * cannotbe less.than 3000 feet high, and is probably somewhat more. j The western coast of Stromoe presents an extent of twelve . miles of the most sublime rock-scenery that can be conceived. ~ Every part of the Faroe group has its romantic beauties ; and *y there is scarcely a promontory which does not exhibit a scene calculated to excite the most lively admiration. The general ‘elevation of the precipices on the west side of Stromoe, varies : from 1000 to 2000 feet. There is a cliff called Kodlen, form- _. ing the north-west promontory of Osteroe, which did not strik _ ~ us so much by its elevation, (for it sunk far beneath the neigh- bouring rocks of Stromoé), as by the circumstance of its being "exactly perpendicular. Mr Axran. measured its height by te Vou. VIL ; Ee Means - be vf ¢ t ae ‘ _ * The name of this mountain, and some other names, are variously spell. ed; but the mode adopted in this memoir conveys the pronunciation. + , ed ale 2 B-.) ive al ow of oe 4 we 2 @ IN THE PAROE SSEANDS. m ‘ 919 am «’ st example we had _an opportinity of. examining, ‘of f tuffa,. lense beds of which form so remark- al ure of Icela ‘observed forming part of a very” . «€ dah on the me coast he island of Vaagoe, calls os NE m ow. e saw ia sort. of -. in giteneat aces 5 a teularly at the bottom of the promontory called, q tromoe. It oT also be : seen on the beach, wi the allageyi in Naalsoey “ ® 4 : % we % ie 2 -* The a + € nie > sa * LR es ‘ -* . » from the ak or. the i dlelitrmias es. Me it is not in any case: easy, I _ may say ey to Mine to w s taapcéitic substance we ought to refer ‘the basis, which varies i perl respects, it may perhaps be best, when there ‘is ‘afly uncertainty. a a both »it © and the ‘included masses; for pro- ‘lixity is, in every de ption, preferable to srantpa erspicuity. T'rap-tuff im- ‘plies, either that the basis is derived from Trap, 0 or that the included masses are ‘Trap, or that both hate the same origin. © Now, as the rock in question often contains sandstone, and sometimes wood ; and as in Tceland “and other volcanic "countries, it contains | lava and other voleani ghee the term Trap-tuff conveys none of these important particulars. _ Crsetnn seems, therefore, to demand a ee wo uld propose that the basis should be understood ge- wnerelly, aE ofessor Jameson has described it, to be << ‘rather a loose, spongy, “_ « clayey basis,” and that we should relinquish the - ‘rap, and use, as a ge- neral term, the word twff, or the original and more har nious Italian T'uffa, and describe the included masses. Thus, in Iceland, i met with tuffa, the compo. * nent parts of which were so minute, ‘fe it resembled red sandstone ; tuffa inclu- ding rounded masses of trap, from a size very minute, to many feet in thickness ; ‘, tuffa including masses of trap, lava, slags, and Mineralized wood. Here the de- scription appears to be absolutely necessary, to prevent: misapprehen sion ; and in- stead of being at,all offensive, it affords ‘perfect satisfaction : ites 0 use for them all merely Bho i many Roper? particulars | ‘would - ted. 4 _ Objections also arise to the tein, Cale-tuf, which may bé'understood to ffean a calcareous basis, cementing together substances, the nature of which we are left ‘to imagine. The included masses, being sometimes, entirely eicareous, and sometimes heterogeneous, the term, by itself, conveys nothing satis ory. For _ fragments connected by a solid basis, the old term breccia seems to ‘be unob-— jectionable, when qualified, as circumstances may require, by ba description of © the basis and the included masses, & , * ae , a” a wo " “ *@¢ a - : « wy e yore e o- f od ~~ on . 7 ees @,> oe : ace 7 ® . ‘= . ae, 3 « — . 229 » GEOLOGIE FACTS OBSERVED, © » a - . ~ > » re oy. 4 The Society ‘ill ae doubt recollect thesfadt which I dee 4 scribed, of the under-surfaces of f many of the beds of Prap i im, *. . Iceland, bearing unequivocal marks of their having been i ina state of fusion, of which there are various specimens in ourca- binet. On - finding the re separating the beds in Fa me. ™ _I expected (Blinect with some indications of heat in that ‘coun-— eery also; and 1 was not disappointed, though. theif occur- “an “rence was not so frequent in Faroe as in ieetand: Near . } Kirkeboe, we observed a considerable degr e of roughness” > on they | bottom of a bed f rock, cof 5 resembled some that dccurred in Akkrefel Iceland o much, that the - ‘ specimens differ only im. waits of colour. At Kirkeboe, ~ such marks of fusion were in many places uit apparent ; ; but I did not succeed 1 in. my” attempts: to procure a mass : of a size sufficient 1 to. hibit, in a satisfactory manner, ‘the ge- neral feature which is so Baiarlcalel The most ‘perfect’ I could procure on a small scale, of that slagginess which was so conspicuous in “Tceland, was found on the hill of Leinum in Stromoe. «I had to regtet that heavy rain, and. the risk incur- red in wandering among high precipices, while surrounded by thick fog, prevented my eeblaing this mountain so com- © ~ | « pletely as T wished.” ‘ ; But whatever degree of doubt might have been left on my . mind by | the appearances just describe!’ it was entirely dissipated “by a new and most important fact, in rela- tion to heat having operated»in the formation of trap, ~ which first presented itself to our notice in the island of Naalsoe, where almost every circumstance of importance in the geology of Faroe is to be seen, and where the great- | est variety of the individual minerals which oecur in trap - are to ‘be found. This islanth Mes opposite to Thorshavn, | q being separated from Stromoe | by a channel about five miles | br itd . Se ate of one mountain, rising to an elevation of * at? ¥ ‘ 1500 ».) > ; CGhOL0GY or Far0e £4,ATH 1. LMhitchell fo. UROLOGY 08 FAROE. py Nitehiell, fod t —— % ¢ m : ¥ ‘ oe a. eS Wy “ mN THE FAROE ISLANDS. 291 J swe o.. e * ey feet ; and receives its name, which signifies Needle Island, me erforation in a rock 2 at the sith end, thought to re- Fs ofaneedle ie surfaces of many lavas which I passed over in Iceland, were not unlike coils of rope, or crumpled cloth; an appear- ance which we should expect to be assumed if any viscid > matter in motion. On our first visit to the Island of Naalsoe, .» we observed the surface of a bed of amygdaloid, which had . Bie, exposed to a ‘considerable extent by the removal of the equal Pr one reconcileable to the supposition of their having flowed ite ‘ .e state of fusion at the bottom of the sea. 5 Another point of resemblance between icclann and ‘ts e remains to be noticed. Lanopz, in his description of Faroe, — (which, as far as I had the opportunity of judging ori’ the 2 : is a very faithful one, though his tr anslator does not always do him justice), mentions great fissures which can often be traced from one island to another. e found that these fissure had been originally entirely filled with veins of basalt ; and in those only did that rock occur to our observation. Pooe columnar, and the columns being perpendicular to the alls} the ba- salt is easily broken down; and water-courses being form- | | ed, the veins are soon worn away. On examining the on sides of the veins, we found, though not in every instance, , a vitreous coating, similar to what was observed on those of Iceland. - * 7 Thus, the perfect resemblance between the trap rocks of Fa- : roe, and those of Iceland, seems to be completely established. The beds are separated by the same substance, viz. layers and 4 beds of tuffa. They present indications of fusion ; and Fa roe has afforded some of a new and very decided charac- ter. I have heard that similar appearances exist in Norway; and it is not improbable, if geologists take the trouble of look- ing for them, that such will be fonnd in evéry country whol- ly composed of trap; and that the igneous origin of that 7 %e a” genus” the fact of water being found in the vesicles of basalt and other rocks, may be accounted for. It must be observed that the steam, in such circumstan-_ "s 3 ces, must have been very much condensed, so much, indeed, as to be almost — A in the state of water greatly heated; much more so than in the familiar ex- _ periment made with Papin’s digester.” od i e - . o ° . > ‘ , Pa " ‘ * r ~ | ° rs & > IN THE FAROE ISLANDS. 925 : Se — ee. UL o w* » ; 7 a will beestablished beyond a doubt. The discove- De, gol ohana the idea of which first struck the cele- ». brated Do: OMIEU, serves as fn additional illustration of the » m gnitude and various exertion of that power, which, when “a _ subjected to ‘the control first conceived by the ingenious > Horrov, explains almost every phenomenon of the mineral re- _* gions. ” : ; While the great point, the action of heat in the formation of trap rocks, seems to be demonstrated, forming a theory of the ‘manner in which heat has operated in particular cases, is, in « q eneral view, perhaps not absolutely necessary in the present : 8 inte of geology. Yet it is satisfactory to the mind when any ‘explanation, consistent with the laws of nature, is suggested. * The theory of submarine volcanoes is not meant to be extended to the appearance of beds of trap interspersed between strata of sandstone and other rocks. These have been thrust among , the strata from below, and have probably been the cause of the strata being elevated above the sea, in which they were form- ed. The succession of beds of trap, one above another, is the fact which the theory of submarine volcanoes is intended to explain ; and though it may not be thought to afford grounds for conviction, yet, in a case where the agent employed is of unlimited power, the imagination is led, by this theory, into a scene on which it can dwell with some degree of satisfaction. Some affect to view geological theory in the light of idle spe- culation ; while others, of whom I am one, consider it the — spring of research, and the direct road to discovery. : ere are three descriptions of geological facts of importance _ to theory; those which support it, those which are difficult to _ account for, and those which can be explained by the opera- tion of agents opposite in their nature, as fire and water. In ‘proportion as the first accumulate, the second present fewer Vo. VI. Ff obstacles ; eo ” » ie 296 GEOLOGICAL FACTS OBSERVED obstacles ; and the last, which may be called neutral, are asso- © ciated with the first. Difficulties remain to be overcome both in the Huttonian, and in the Wernerian system; and unless the partizans of each were zealous in applying their doctrines to the facts which they discover, the face of nature would cease to be referred to for those steps by which alone we can hope to arrive at a perfect system: and our progress would be so slow and heavy, that prejudice might take possession of our minds, so as to shackle, if not to exclude, the free exercise of reason. Rocks such as those of which the Faroe islands are formed, are very liable to destruction by the operations of the atmosphere. The great abundance of springs, which is characteristic of a trap country, aid the action of frost. Accordingly, the whole of Faroe exhibits extensive marks of the constant and destructive opera- tion of these agents. The sea, too, rapidly undermines the preci- pices, large masses of which are daily buried in it. As all the narrow channels which separate the islands, lie in the same di- rection, and as veins of basalt are sometimes seen as if branch- ing from them through the adjacent islands, I am induced to suppose, that the separation of the islands has originated in the destruction of large veins, subsequent to the land being eleva- ted above the sea, and caused in the same manner as that of ‘other veins or dikes, now going on. The support of the walls being removed, decomposition, and the effects of moisture and frost, would operate in gradually destroying the beds, and at last the sea, breaking through (as it is constantly doing in va-_ rious parts of the islands), these channels might in this manner have been formed. In the same way, the position, in some instances, of those huge masses which now stand separated from the coast may be accounted for. Indeed, in several pla- ces, we saw the separation actually proceeding, by the remo- ‘ val . * ». _ IN THE FAROE ISLANDS. 227 ” & ‘ + val of veins, particularly near the village of Tiornevig in Stro- uit SG? ae e. ; a ~e a ~ ue ee y ¥ > % . ‘An account of some other geological facts, of the varieties of the trap, and of the various minerals contained in them, I leave to my friend Mr Axtan, whose great accuracy in such descriptions is well known to the Society. ries Pad * ‘. - am + * “ wl ‘te . s er Sy 7 * . ; we viel ‘ ‘ | Fre ‘ No. VIL. j ie a a ‘ % 4 * aes " ¥ ve Treg i ral wi we we ” At > Sad rey k # spon) abe he ek: ‘ , & ep, a hel etd PEND NETS é she " MOREL OEY” Me ‘ et) Rite tay’ | ich ° ’ 4 : . PROM hed) het & Relea ag ie PRAY ea a : ¢ Sa - a eee ; i ae Dati 0 Rh alia ee they 4 {ofiets GPP, Fy ’ > 4° 4 ue ‘ * RL ce) bg Pair Rae ; $023 hing , ’ F alt tie YL gh f ita + q id AWigy 405 we { | sist tal bab nts acct at eebaceeliall “a ats ry 0 Pen capt Ma: whe’ pee anges AS Rye a ie ee @ te pated ated yom eaeeanin = ° . r 3 ” 3 a“ , » z Wr pew ms . a > * Bese | ENRUTOwWME | LV Vo . oy) may pesmper | SGN¥FTSI TOWNA | EE ra ee ements: ee oN : > ae En FE EE ee iat aes = ore : os a i SLE Te TOMA CIM: pone’ =o Fak. RN ana ceroerog MOVED upoucbropp abunprrsys SE i word anoypose ivy SRG. aA > =) aS ath Sraosmy Sy MLE PPL PUY IML wa NYOL ENIEIILED AV LITIVIC TO op LL TNON ODPL TRUM TOW SL idl SANY TST FHL JO TIC TIX ULV Id ig 3 AD arternage ee | » - ' 4 VII. An Seat of the Miner alogy of the Faroe Islands. mn biel Aaa Esq. F. BR. S. Evin. a aed nie we . Read 1st February 1818.) gine pues ieee) as ney given a paper, en- titled, “ An Account of some Geological Facts observed ,'* in the Faroe Islands,” it may be necessary to explain why our communications were not combined i in one. This was simply owing to our. objects being in some measure dissimilar. He was anxious to compare the facts presented in a country decidedly volcanic, with those in a trap district, where no traces of a vol- cano were to be discovered ; consequently, his observations were confined to particular facts: whereas my object is to describe, without relation to theory, whatever appeared to me interest- ing in a geological point of view. » I do not propose to embarrass myself with an attempt to re- duce the various phenomena I remarked, to any existing theo- ry, farther than what appears warranted by the new and addi- tional light we derived from some of the appearances in Fa- roe I shall content a with aiding the labours of future travellers, a satel 230 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY travellers, by enabling them to profit by our experience, and by removing the difficulty we encountered in procuring infor- mation, regarding the objects calculated to gratify curiosity, or assist us in our investigations, which neither of the ac- counts of Faroe published are capable of doing *. In the following pages, I shall take notice of the objects most deserving of attention, and particularly note the locali- ties where minerals are to be found ; and conclude with a few observations on the geology of the islands. To this I shall not attempt to add a description of the inha- bitants, their mode of life, or their means of subsistence, al- though all are peculiar, and all interesting. It would be teme- rity to attempt it cn an acquaintance of five weeks, although that time was sufficient to satisfy us, that they are a people in all respects honest, industrious, and hardworking, who earn their scanty livelihood with more labour than perhaps any other set of human beings, while nothing but patience and contentment appears to prevail among them. In our voyage to Faroe, we were extremely fortunate; al- though the weather was boisterous, the wind was fair and stea- dy, so that we cast anchor at Thorshayn exactly in sixty hours after passing the Isle: of May,—a run of about five hundred: miles. When we first made the land, the atmosphere was so- thick, that it was some time before we discovered the island we were approaching to be the Lesser Dimon, situated between. Suderoe and Sandoe. . The form of this rock is similar to that of Ailsa; it gave us a glimpse of the trap country we were go- ing to ransack, and as we approached our anchorage, other magnificent cliffs successively displayed themselves, affording: some idea of the grand scenery we were about to. visit. Having * The anly publications on the Faroe Islands are those of Dezxs and Lannr. ‘The former appeared in 1670, the latter in 1800. SR ae = d 4 f : Slate —™ int ets Se ae Maal. 6 SRSA RE I OE OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 931 Having established our head quarters in the house of the ‘Governor, Major Lorsner, who entertained us with the greatest hospitality, we engaged a servant and a guide, who both of them occasionally acted as interpreters ; and the weather be- ing unfavourable for commencing our journey, we delayed a few days, in hopes of its improvement. We had selected June, as a season most likely to afford us comfortable wea- ther; but during the whole month, we had not two days together that it did not either rain or snow. August and September, we found, were considered the most favourable periods. During this delay, we had time to inform ourselves of the best mode of travelling through the country. In Faroe, the term road means little more than direction, as not even a path is to be discovered in some of the principal routes, which are merely the most passable cuts across the _ hills: occasionally a priest may save himself bodily labour, by traversing these wastes on horseback; but a stout man will ge- nerally accomplish the same distance in less time on foot. Where a country is so entirely intersected by the sea, inland ‘communication is but seldom resorted to, nor would it at all answer the purpose, where such constant intercourse is requi- red ; the inhabitants of the most distant parts being obliged to repair almost weekly to Thorshavn, to draw their little por- tions of grain from the Government store; where the stock is always so stinted, never more than a fortnight’s allow- -ance is delivered at one time. Besides, all the ‘habitations are _ situated on the coast. Boats, therefore, afford the best mode of travelling, and the only means of conveying goods. Even to a stranger, there is no inducement to traverse the interior, which presents nothing but dreary desolation. All the stri- king scenery is on the coasts, and there only are minerals to ‘be procured ; for although Lanpr mentions, that the best zeo- lites, 232 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY lites he got, were found among the debris upon the sides of the hills, those we picked up in such situations, were uniform- ly deprived of lustre, and otherwise much damaged. The boats are principally used for fishing ; they are all con- structed in the country, of plank brought from Norway. They are built in the canoe shape, and though not very commodious, are so admirably fitted to the seas of Faroe, that I do not. recollect, during the whole of our excursions, to have been in the least incommoded by the rising of the spray. The conti- nual practice of the natives, and their constant habits of attend- ing to the tide, not only for the purposes of their avocations, but also to mark time, when the sun is obscured in clouds, renders them extremely expert in the management of their craft ; yet they never venture their boats to sea without ha- ving them well manned,—a precaution extremely necessary, where, by the: rapidity of the currents, and,the sudden gusts of wind, the waves are thrown into the most violent agitation: almost instantaneously. The Faroe Islands being so celebrated .as the source of the finest zeolites and caleedonies, which decorate the cabinets of Europe, Ithere expected to find a perfect magazine of every thing magnificent of that nature ; and never doubted that we should meet with people in plenty, who, if they had not objects of this description to dispose of, would at least be able to conduct us to the places where they were to be procured. I was therefore sur-. prised, that not one person in Thorshavn could give us any sa- tisfactory information, on the subject. Such is the indifference- those beautiful productions of nature, so justly prized abroad, meet with in their own country. Our guide, Hans, who had also attended Sir Joun Sranuey in the same capacity, told us, that that gentleman had supplied himself with zeolites from a cave in Nalsoe, about twenty-three years before ; but that he had. not ash ips OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. _ 233 not been in it since. Knowing what a hopeless measure it is to explore a country in quest of its mineral produc- tions, without being previously directed to the particular spots that afford them, this information occasioned considerable cha- grin; and as it appeared we had only our own exertions to depend upon, we commenced operations ,with all possible speed. That part. of Stromoe which succchapele Thorshavn is tamer than the generality of the country, and, so far as we could dis- cover, presents nothing of interest to the mineralogist. We therefore immediately proceeded to, explore Nalsoe, a long narrow island which, lies within five miles; and here we found a constant source of amusement *. Almost the very first object. that attracted our attention on landing, was the very remarkable appearances of fusion, on the surface of a bed. of amygdaloid, mentioned by Sir Gzorce Mackenzie. ese occurred on a point as nearly due east as possible from Thorshavn. ‘Two miles south of this is the cave in which Sir Joun Sranuey had found so many brilliant specimens of zeolite. _ It is described by Lanopr as a very re- markal le cavern, not, however, for its productions, of which he takes no notice, ‘but as leading to a perforation said to pass s0 ‘nearly through | the island, that the noise of the waves on the 2 opposite ide may be heard at the extremity of it. This aperture I c could d _ not, find; it may, however, be covered with debris, the p ace being so, much altered since Hans our guide was ‘there before, that he scarcely knew it to be the same. It is pile’ considerably 2 above the level of the sea, in a soft amygdaloid, d presents an opening of about two hun- dred | feet i in met while its inmost recess does not exceed Vou VIL pan yae es re Shialogt 1849). peighty, nhs ay the ret map of the Varve ‘elands, reduced from that of Captain Bons, I have traced our different routes. 234 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY eighty ; in front it is nearly closed up with debris, which slope gradually into it, so that it is in many places quite low. Here, both in the solid rock, and among the fallen fragments, we found specimens of zeolite in abundance, of the species Stil- bite, Apophyllite, and Chabasie. The first of these was the most abundant, and occurred very beautifully crystallized, in irregular crevices, disposed in groupes, on globular mesotype, mixed with minute crystals of chabasie, and of the following forms: 1, Flat rectangular prism ; the broad surfaces of which have a lamellated and pearly aspect, while the narrow ones are longitudinally streaked, with smooth shining termi- nations, set at right angles to the rest, forming a paral- lelopiped. 2. The same ; having each of the solid angles replaced by two planes, set obliquely on the narrow sides of the prism, presenting the form dodecaddre, fig. 1718. of Havy. 3. When the replacement of the solid angles is not complete, part of the terminal plane of the first variety remains. Form epointé, fig. 179. of Havuy. Besides these, we found it in radiated and lamellar masses, and in aggregations assuming the sheaf shape. The Apophyllite is a rarer mineral ; we found it only among some of the fallen masses of rock, disposed on a ground si- milar to. the last, and, mixed with. crystals of stilbite. ‘The forms it assumes are very simple, and as follows: 1. Equilateral rectangular prisms ; terminated at each end by a plane set at right angles. Here the sides of the | boaube i prism ee) ar is 23 q bs Mt . % ; ee 3 £ j : a ' OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 235 prism are all streaked, and the terminations pearly ; these crystals appear to have but one cleavage, which is at right angles to the axis, and extremely distinct. 2. The same ; slightly truncated on all the solid angles. 3. The same; with the truncation on the angles somewhat deeper ; a small four-sided facet remaining on the sum- mit, forming a truncated pyramid. In other specimens I have found the apex complete, producing a very distinct sharp-pointed pyramid *. We here likewise found radiated“and amorphous mesotype ; also in most delicate minute acicular fibres. Chabasie occurred here only in very small crystals; but towards the southern extremity of Nalsoe,,we found it in very large crystals, some of them at least an inch in diame- ter ; they were imbedded in a very tough rock, and, being naturally brittle, we were unable to detach them. From the southern point of Nalsoe, a portion of the rock was removed some years ago to Kongsberg in Norway, for the purpose of extracting the native copper dispersed through it ; this, however was not found to answer, from the small quanti- ty it produced. , Another spot was also pointed out to us as affording copper, on the east side of the island, a little north of ‘a small detached rock called Kabelen, and not very distant from where we first saw it. A Gg2 I Fe Aen iv roo e Toe ’ * This variety has been referred by Havy to the species Mesotype. From “the great respect I entertain for the opinions of that distinguished mineralogist, it _ is with reluctance I venture to place it under a different name. It is not, how- ever, without due consideration that I have done,so: my reasons I shall detail more fully, when speaking of the Crystallised Mesotype. 236 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY I here had the good fortune to procure some very good spe~ cimens of the metal, in rather larger bulk than usual, very beautifully crystallized, with some of the sprays forming the nuclei of radiated mesotype; which, when considered in a geo- logical point of view, is a circumstance highly deserving atten- tion. Here the native copper is found in amygdaloid, at no great distance from the spot where we saw a bed of the same material covered with the most decided marks of fusion. It does not traverse it in veins, but is disseminated in minute par- ticles, and sometimes presents crystallizations, equal in beauty to any from the veins of Cornwall, although imbedded in the solid substance of the rock, through which it branches with the utmost elegance and freedom. The whteds I have mentioned as the localities of these minerals, with one or two others, rather of less note, were the only spots we landed at. There were many others, which appeared sufficiently inviting; but from the roughness of the waves, and the quantity of sunken rocks, we could not with safety approach them. Having delayed some time, vainly waiting for good weather, we. at. last proceeded to the western coast of Stromoe, and took up our lodgings at Quivig, in the house of the priest, Mr Horm. During our voyage to this place, the mist lay. so thick upon the islands, that we seldom could see the summit of the cliffs, near which we were obliged to steer, in order to ‘keep our course. Our host at Quivig, was the only person whom we met with in Faroe, in the habit of collecting its mineral productions ; and although he did not appear to haye made, avery good selection for himself, yet he, conducted us. toodifferent. ca- vities .on,the shore, from: which we' ‘obtained some of the finest zeolites that ever were brought from these islands. Some of the " ' cavities aw on OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 237 cavities were three feet in diameter, and entirely lined with large crystals of stilbite; but .the most interesting, were between Quivig and Westmanhavn. In one, we observed the mesotype, in long acicular crystals, but so extremely slender, that it was quite impossible to detach them entire from the rock. In another, we found the same substance, but in a more tangible form. This cavity was about two feet wide, eighteen inches deep, and nine high, in a perpendicular rock, about ten feet from the base, which was washed by the tide. By means of a ladder, we succeeded in reaching this repository, and found the whole interior coated with aggregated groups of stilbite, having only the crystallised acuminations visible, of an opake yellowish-white colour, and varying from an inch to an inch and. a half in thickness.. Upon this ground were disposed nu- merous groups of mesotype, radiating from a centre, and shoot- ing from the surface, an inch to an inch and a half in length, in clear, transparent, well-defined prisms, of a rectangular form, terminated with a flat four-sided pyramid, the variety pyramidée of Hauy, and varying in size from a hair to a line in thickness. . It: was a mortifying circumstance to be obliged. to destroy any part.of this very magnificent specimen, in de- taching it from the rock ; a circumstance, however, totally un- avoidable. I succeeded in obtaining several very good speci- ~ mens, and by gluing them carefully to the bottom of a box, was. very fortunate in preserving them in all their natural beauty. This is the Mesotype of Havy, and the Nadelstein of Wer- NER ; it varies entirely from the Apophyllite formerly noticed ; in place of a distinct foliated cleavage, cutting the axis at right angles, with a pearly lustre on its terminations; it pre- sents a vitreous fracture, without the appearance of any regu- lar cleavage, and an uniform lustre in all directions. Fragments of Mesotype dissolve in nitric acid, and form a clear transpa- rent 238 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY rent jelly; while the Apophyllite separates into minute parti- cles, of a semitransparent white *. It .besides varies in refrac- tion, and is in all respects similar to the Mesotype from Puy de Dome, a magnificent specimen of which I had lately the honour to receive from the hands of Monsieur Havy. On the east side of the Bay of Westmanhavn, we found other cavities containing Mesotype. We there also discover- ed a vein of calcareous spar, about two feet in width, from which we detached several specimens ; it was entirely compo- sed of a congeries of crystals, among which were imbedded, rounded masses of amygdaloid. The forms here presented by the carbonate of lime are quite new to the mineralogist, and are particularly described in the late work of the Count de Bour- Non, who has added to his already numerous collection of the crystallizations of that substance, no less than eleven varieties. To his interesting work I beg leave to refer for their detailed description f. Having been compelled to abandon our intention of ascen- ding Skeelingfeld, from the state of the weather, we were like- wise advised not to attempt the open sea, by which we propo- sed to proceed on our journey to Osteroe. We therefore passed over to Wagoe, and paid a visit to the island of Tint- holm. The peculiarities of Tintholm are not mentioned “in the translation of Lanpt, although fully described in the origi- . nal. * The Apophyllite of Uté in Sweden, as well as of Disco in Greenland, after separating in the acid, swell out in a very remarkable manner, occupying a space very much larger than the original ; but do not combine into a gelatinous mass. + Catalogue de la Collection Mineralogique du Comte de Bournon, London, 1613. faz. Or. "4a" Ping | ¥ % bi ‘ & g OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 239 nal. This little island forms a continuation with the west side of the Bay of Sorvaag, but is not seen from the village of that name. We there obtained a boat, to proceed towards it, and in going down the bay, which is very narrow, we came suddenly in view of it, with all the singular and grotesque rocks by which it is surrounded. One of these is perforated by the sea, forming’ a very fine natural arch; while another, like an enormous column, placed crooked on its base, stands as if prepared to fall into the abyss beneath. The summit of Tintholm may be from five to six hundred feet above the level of the sea; it is divided into a number of pinnacles, so extremely slender to appearance, that it becomes a matter of surprise how they resist the fury of the storm. This peak presents on the south side a bare perpendicular cliff, and appears to be principally composed of amygdaloid. The only observation we made here, was with regard to the extreme si- milarity of the trap-tuff to that which Sir Grorce Mackenzie -met with at Akkerfeld, and in other parts of Iceland. It con- tained no minerals of any note. ‘Here, for once, the weather favoured us; and although the cliffs of Wagoe were not more elevated than others we had previously seen, they were disincumbered of clouds, and when viewed from the farther extremity of Tintholm, form- .ed a most sublime prospeet. At the time, we could not sufficiently estimate their altitude; but the diversity of form into which their summits were broken, and the fine contrast afforded by the intervening rocks, with the beautiful effects of light, altogether rendered our visit to this place ex- ‘tremely gratifying, particularly, as we were not at all prepared ‘tomeet with any thing of the kind; and we left it with a feel- ‘ing, that overlooking Tintholm, would have been the omis- sion of an important object of curiosity, in a.tour to Faroe.» Next 240 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY Next morning Wagoe was obscured in heavy clouds of thick mist. When the tide served, we left Midvaag, on our return to Thorshavn ; but had no sooner fairly quitted the shores of this island, when, emerging as it were from darkness, we had a view of Skeeling, and ‘the other mountains of Stromoe, with the islands of Hestoe, Kolter, Sandoe and Suderoe, none of which had been visible as we passed them before. It very frequently happens, that one island is enveloped it in fog, while the next is quite clear of it. The clouds take their partial stations with inconceivable tenacity ; and, according to the direction of the wind, it was usually known what sort of atmosphere was enjoyed in the remote quarters of the group. ° From Thorshayn we proceeded on a second tour, to Eide, a small village situated at the farther extremity of Osteroe. The channel which divides the two principal islands is very narrow in some places, and cannot be passed at all times of tide, even in the small craft of the country, being traversed by a reef of rocks near the middle. The hills are generally tame on both sides of this passage, excepting at Zellatrae, where there is a magnificent bed of columnar greenstone. At Eide we remained some time ; but our proceedings were still sadly impeded by the weather; we, however, had an op- portunity of ascending Slattertint, a neighbouring mountain, apparently not much lower than Skeeling. According to Captain Bory, the last-mentioned is only 2400 feet high. From the very excellent chart constructed by that gentleman, after an accurate survey of the islands, in which even the shading of the mountains is executed with great cor- rectness, we ought to state with diffidence, that our measure- ment of Slattertint, by means of a barometer, indicated an elevation of 2825 feet; from its summit we could discern, that oF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 211 that Skeelingfeld was considerably higher, and, according to our estimation, not less than 3000 feet above the level of the sea. We had no opportunity of repeating our observation ; but as we took all possible pains to guard against error, we have room to suspect that Captain Born must have fallen into some mistake ; although, from the opportunities of observing, which his long residence in the country must have afforded him, we cannot, ia much hesitation, come to such a con- clusion. « In this excursion we had reason to congratulate ourselves on our good fortune. The atmosphere was clear of clouds, conse- quently almost every island in the group was within sight, which, from the wonderful variety in the form of the hills and islands, affords a very grand and striking prospect. The peculiar delight one feels in the enjoyment of a boundless view from an elevated situation, was, on this occa- sion, considerably enhanced by the unobscured horizon, and peculiar brightness of the day; since our arrival in the coun- try, we had not till now enjoyed a single hour, that would have permitted us to see half the extent. Though bleak and barren, and in many places covered with eternal snow, the novelty of shape, which varied in every hill,—the deep ‘indentations of the sea,—the contrast of the irregular out- Ime with the even and unvarying direction of the rocky beds, and the placid stillness of the surrounding ocean, all contribu- ted to repay us most amply for the trouble of our ascent. Like many of the Faroe hills, the summit of Slattertint is flat, and presents an irregularly oval plane, of sixty yards by thirty-six in its greatest dimensions. This surface is covered with thick moss, under which the soil was completely frozen. We observed nothing remarkable in the composition of the beds, and no minerals of any consequence. Vox. VII. Hh The 242 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY The village of Eide is situated on the-acclivity of one of the headlands which presents a perpendicular front to the oceans Some-of these we had previously been much strugk with ; that of Nypennes puzzled us extremely. Lanpr re- presents it to be 1200 feet high, which, from the magnitude of every thing around, the little distance we thought we were from it, and without any object by which we could form an estima- tion, we could not bring ourselves to believe. I was therefore determined to ascertain, by the simple mechanical means of a line and plummet, the height of the Kodlen, as the headlané near Eide is called, and succeeded, by letting down a fishing- line, with a stone at the end of it, from the top of this formi- dable precipice, from which I ascertained its height to be 1134 feet *. This, I believe, is a very near approximation to the truth : the elasticity of the cord was the only material source of error; but I-endeavoured to counteract this defect, by. stretching the cord sufficiently when it was measured off. We were thus furnished with the means of forming a | proper estimation of these tremendous cliffs, and without it. we should in all probability have left the islands under a very different. impression regarding them than we did. The Kod- oh ue eh wa sehr) td len * It was not till after the third attempt. that I was satisfied with this experi~ ment. In the two first I met with unlooked for difficulty, by the hitching and entanglement.of my cord, upon the projecting points. of the rock, and-also by, the severity of the blast, which. striking on so large a:surface, blew upwards with tremendous fury, even when- there was otherwise apparently but little wind. I consequently bethought myself of coiling a given quantity of cord, upon a round stone, and forming 2 compact mass, of sufficient weight to overcome the violence of the wind opposed to it at the summit, which decreased proportionably to the opposition it met with in descending; while the shape, and unfolding of the rope, rendered it less liable to attach itself to-the points of the rock. By means: ef this device, I succeeded to my satisfaction. OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 243 len is by no means remarkable for its elevation; the Myling, in Stromoe, is at least a third higher. presenting an unbroken mural front, with scarcely a point for a bird to perch upon from the summit to the base. On the west sidé of the promontory, opposite Thiornivig, and also on the east side, upon the shore, we observed nume- rous indications of fusion upon different surfaces of the rocks ; and it was from this vicinity that we procured the principal part of the specimens, bearing ‘testimony of this fact, that we brought home with us. It was among some large fragments, also on the east side, that we discovered specimens of apo- phyllite altogether rare for the magnitude and beauty of cry- stallization. boseot ow ) They here occur in rectangular prisms, often in perfect cubes, sometimes longer, sometimes shorter ; occasionally, the cubes are truncated upon the solid angles, either slightly, or so deeply as to meet, forming the regular cubo-octohedron. The crystals, like those formerly mentioned, which we found in Nalsoe, are streaked on the sides longitudinally, and have a pearly aspect on the terminations; they are disposed on a ground of mamillated mesotype, and in some instances grouped like fluor-spar ; the cubes being irregularly implanted -on each other. They are perfectly transparent and colourless, except when affected by the weather, which renders them dull and opake. The largest I met with measures seven-tenths of an inch, by five-tenths. I was assured by M. Varina, a Spa- nish mineralogist, and a distinguished pupil of Werner, that it is to this variety he gives the name of Cubizite, although it is under that appellation the Analcime and Chabasie of Havy are described by Brocuanr and others. It may be, therefore, that the Cubizite of Werrner, is in fact the Apophyllite of Hh 2. Havy, 944 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY Havy, and that Werner’s Nadelstein should be confined to Havy’s Mesotype. The only other circumstance of interest which I met with near Eide, was a remarkable instance of the abrasion of the surface, where the rock appears to have been worn down by the friction of heavy bodies. Of this I shall take notice in the sequel. Again, we were obliged to abandon our station, without completing our intentions, in consequence of the badness. of the weather; and being deterred from venturing to the north- ern islands in this direction, we returned to Thorshavn, resolving to attempt it by the south side; and after some delay for a favourable day, we reached Waaij in Bordoe, with tolerable prospects of success. Here we had just landed, and prepared ourselves for our afternoon’s excursion among the neighbouring hills, when it began to rain heavily, and conti- nued pouring for fifty hours, accompanied with sleet ; on the third evening a shower of snow commenced, and next morning the mountains were clothed in white almost to the water’s edge. It was now the 23d day of June, and yet this inclemency created no surprise among the natives, who assured us, that at Christmas the weather was generally better. The re- cent snow did not lie long, and, anxious to do something be- fore we left the place, we ascended a hill which. lies on the west side of the village, while it yet snowed, and were repaid for our trouble, by observing marks of fusion, similar to those of Eide, but at a height of at least 1200 feet, We had hither- to found them only close upon the shore. Despairing of being able to proceed farther, and as our pro- visions were not calculated for so long a delay, we were compel led to return to’"Thorshavn, and busied ourselves in directing preparations for our final departure. At this time the weather suddenly. OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. — 245 suddenly assumed a more settled appearance than it had hitherto done; and having still a few days at our disposal, we resolved to make a last effort, to visit the objects we had hitherto been prevented from seeing. We had now to retrace a great part of our former track ; but the difference of weather rendered it entirely new to us. Formerly, as one cloud followed another, we caught an occasional glimpse of the coasts along which we were steering; now we had a delightful view of all the islands and groups of mountains, perfectly unimpeded; and _ their rough surfaces afforded as magnificent effects of light as can well be imagined. One of the most extraordinary of these, is in the island of Wagoe. On the north side of the entrance to the Bay of Midvaag, there is a fragment of a rock standmg out from the rest, to which, from its acute pyramidal form, they have given the name of the Trolkende Fingeren, or Witch’s Finger. As we approached it from the extremity of Stro- moe, the light’struck upon it, and the rocks in its vicinity, exactly so as to produce the appearance of a Gothic cathedral ; an appearance not requiring fancy to help it out, but actually demanding attention to overcome the illusion. We had pas~ ‘sed close under this rock twice before, but had not till now seen it. » We again passed our former residence at Quivig, and reach- ed Westmanhavn soon after noon. Next morning we were ready to start on our long meditated expedition at an early hour.. The weather was fine, and the water in the bay as smooth as any lake; still the people wished to dissuade us from venturing upon the open sea, asserting that we should find it very rough without. We now begar to be less moved by their representations than: formerly, having observed their extreme caution, or rather timidity, on all occasions. We determined to proceed, and although the sea was certainly more agitated than 246 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY than we expected, all inconvenience it occasioned soon ab- sorbed in the stupendous grandeur of the scenery that open- ed upon us. From the northern coast of Wagoe, all the way to Eide, we had a continued series of magnificent cliffs, tower- ing in many places, like minerets, to the height of 2000 feet. Here also we saw aseries of rocks, which, from the accounts con- tained in Lanpr, had excited a great degree of curiosity: al- though they do not by any means accord with his description, yet they present some of the wildest and most magnificent ap- pearances possible. Here a part of the coast is separated from the rest, and appears to have formed a barrier or wall in front, the ruins of which now only remain. In one place, where the largest portion stands highly elevated from the water, an im- mense perforation, like a grand portal, presents itself, through which boats of any size may row in safety. The rest of this reef, as it may very properly be considered, presents a string of fantastically shaped rocks, many of them acute pyramids, denominated Drengs in the language of the country, in a line at unequal distances. In a little narrow bay near this, of about three or four hundred yards in depth, there is another wall, somewhat similar, dividing the bay in two; the extremity of which ranges with the entrance of it. The end towards the sea is highest; and from this it declines to the other, being ornamented all along with the same kind of pinnacles we formerly admired at Tintholm. In it we also found a na- ‘tural arch, through which we passed in the boat. These walls, I first suspected, might have been the remains of enormous dykes, similar to some which exist on the coast of Antrim ; but on examination, I found no traces to support that conjecture, nor could I discover any probable cause for their separation from the adjoining country. -We OF THE FAROE ISLANDS: Jay ’ We arrived at Eide in the afternoon ; and from thence pro- ceeded, early next morning, towards the northern: islands, directing our course to Wideroe. From the general appear- ance of the country, and the perfect sameness we every where met with, in its geological characters, we found there was little inducement to prolong our stay in this quarter, and therefore - resolved, if cireumstances permitted, to return the same day to Thorshaven. The morning was beautiful ; and as we skirted sib, we had’ a delightful view of the coast, which presented many of the singularly shaped rocks, of which we had seen so many the day before. Being obliged to keep out to sea, to get into the current, we had an opportunity of comparing the relative heights of the Myling and Kodlen, and to form avery accurate’ judgment of the former, by knowing the altitude of the latter. . We now passed along the islands of Kalsoe and Kunoe, which are little more than lengthened ridges of barren rocks, pre- senting the most frightful aspect of sterility. We arrived at. Wideroe a little Berens mid-day ; it is situated on a peninsula, the isthmus of which is of considerable extent: on the left, the rocks rise, in wild and rugged peaks, to avery great height ; and having viewed the bold and rocky shores of Fugloe chia Swinoe, from py Saas side of the sine we again em-- barked: ' " It was our intention, at this. place, to have changed ‘our: boats ; but the people being all engaged abroad, ; plucking their sheep *, our crew from Eide offered to take us forward, appa- rently delighted with the opportunity it gave them of obliging us. We had- already come twenty-three miles, and were’ dis- 9 tant: * The savage custom of: tearing the wool from the backs of their sheep, still prevails in these islands. 248 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY tant thirty-three from Thorshayn, where our people were still twenty-three miles from Eide; and as they never remain from home over night, they had to complete a journey of se. venty-nine miles without rest, and almost in the constant ex- ercise of the oar. From their knowledge of the tides, they are enabled to take every advantage of the current; but ina voyage of this extent, it was impossible to have it always favourable; we were therefore more than once stationary for upwards of half an hour; the utmost exertion of the crew be- ing barely sufficient to prevent the boat being carried back with the stream, in turning some of the headlands we had to pass. About eight in the evening we reached Thorshavn, where, after resting an hour, our crew left us to return home, and arrived there at two in the morning, having performed their voyage in nineteen hours, including stoppages, an exertion which may appear incredible but to those who saw it. By this rapid and successful voyage, we retraced in three days nearly all our former excursions, and, besides, accomplished our visit to the northern islands. We were now fully satisfied, we had nothing new to expect by extending the period of our stay, and nothing now remained worth examination, except the island of Suderoe, which, lying in the course of our return, we expec- ted to stop at after our final departure from Thorshavn ; but in this we were unfortunately disappointed. We were likewise satisfied with the supply of minerals we bad obtained. We had made a splendid collection of zeolites, of every variety, except analcime, of which I was rather sur- prised not to have seen a single specimen in the country, ex- cept one solitary crystal, which was found among the debris at Waaij. Since our return, however, I have procured a very magnificent specimen of this substance from Kollefiord in Stromoe, OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 249 Stromoe, not above ten or twelve miles distant from Thors- havn; a discovery somewhat mortifying, considering we could ‘have visited it with great facility. Of Calcedony we had likewise procured several very capital specimens, all brought by the people to barter against tobacco ; nor could we learn where they were to be found in situ, being constantly told, that they were got loose upon the sum- mits of the mountains, and by the priest at Quivig,. that the place he found them in, was at that time covered with snow. ‘Two days before our departure, an accidental circum- stance led to the accomplishment of what I so much desired : a country man offered us some masses, having the appearance of being recently detached, from some small barnacles which adhered to them being still alive. This led us to inquire where they were got ; and being informed at Lambevig, within twelve or fifteen miles distant, we determined to explore it. The nearest approach to this place is by Skaalefiord, on the west side of Osteroe. Here we landed at Glibre, and walked over to Lambe, not three quarters of a mile distant, and having there procured a boat, were set on shore among the rocks, a little to the right of the harbour, where we soon found some immense masses of calcedony. Our apparatus was now considerably impaired ; besides, the rock was so situated, that nothing but mining tools could ef- fectually act upon it. These we had now neither time nor op- portunity to apply, although we would certainly have done so, had we come here earlier; as it was, we procured some excel- lent and interesting pieces of calcedony, as well as some capi- tal specimens of chabasie. But the circumstance which afford- ed me most satisfaction on this expedition, was to find the ca~ vernous calcedony in situ. I here saw plates of it of extraordi- nary dimensions, one being four feet long by two in breadth, Vou. VII. I which 950 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY which appeared to be parallel, with several others. which I saw in the same place, and all of them horizontal. On the shore of Skaalefiord, we also found several mas- ses of calcedony, of the same description, likewise cavernous ;. and I have no doubt, that by a little attention, abundance may be found in the same vicinity. This excursion was particularly gratifying to me, as it afford-. ed an opportunity of observing some peculiarities in the rela- tions of a fossil, very much referred to by the supporters of | the two great geological questions, each as affording decisive proofs in their own favour. Viewing it as belonging to that subject, I shall connect my observations on calcedony, with those I have to make on the geology of the country. The difficulty we met with, in discovering the localities of minerals, fully confirmed the fears I anticipated on our first arrival. Excepting Mr Horm the clergyman of Qui-. vig, we did not find a person in the country, in the prac-- tice of collecting minerals. But notwithstanding the appa- rent indifference, with which. these beautiful productions are. treated by the natives, yet’ they scon found: out the ob- jects we were in pursuit of, and frequently afforded consi- derable assistance in finding them; as all, however, depends on - the care with which minerals are taken from the soil, and as these. poor people are-destitute of implements for this purpose, it is impossible they can obtain them in their most interesting state, even if they were inclined to bestow their time and la- bour in collecting them, which the difficulty they experience in- obtaining the more necessary articles of food _ sai most. peteniptorily forbids. ‘ This excursion to Lambe was the-last. The day followinige we embarked, expecting the vessel would come to anchor off Suderoe, as was originally intended. But as we approached that. OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 951 that island, the wind blew so fair, and at the same time so strong, that we thought it niore advisable to bear away, and had the singular good luck to reach Leith Roads in less time than we took going out, having performed our expedition exactly in six weeks. GEOLOGY. In the preceding part of this paper, I have purposely tefrain- ed from touching on geology, in order that I might bring to- gether the few remarks that occurred on that subject. No country perhaps presents such perfect sameness in its geologi- cal relations; from end to end the islands are composed of trap rocks; consequently, it is only to the peculiarities this interesting series here affords, that my observations can ex- tend. ; . _ Sir Gzorcr Mackenzie has already described part of the cu- rious phenomena I now allude to, which he thinks corroborate the doctrines suggested by some of the facts he met with in Iceland, and has, in a great measure, exhausted a subject so singularly meagre. A few observations, however, still remain to be made, without entering into any theoretical discussions, which, though amusing, in the present state of knowledge, are not capable of leading us to any satisfactory conclusions, with - respect to the general formation of the globe. All I hope to “accomplish is, to give a faithful description of what I have “seen; and to mark the impression made upon my mind, by Tia certain 952 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY certain features which distinguish the Faroe Islands from all other countries I am aiiliainted with. The Faroe islands occupy a geographical extent of about sixty miles by forty; their greatest stretch being north and south. Throughout the whole, there is not one atom of stra- tified rock to be met with, if I may be allowed to judge from: the islands we visited, together with what we learned of those. we did not touch at. I do not consider, that even the coal of Suderoe presents an exception to this general conclusion. We have much reason to. regret, that circumstances prevented us from exploring this island; as, from some remarks, both of Deses and Lanprt, as well as from some observations of Captain Born, which occur in a periodical publication of Co- penhagen, devoted to natural history, Suderoe contains pecu- liarities in the arrangement of some of the trap rocks, with which we found nothing analogous in any of the diet islands. According to Lannr, the coal-was. particularly exami- ned by a Mr i, eng in 1777, in obedience to. the orders of the directory of mines; and by his report, the veins extend.in length: 12,000 feet, and, at an average, 4000 in.breadth. He then goes on to calculate the quantity of fuel that an area of such dimensions would produce. From this it must be suppo- sed, that he has estimated in the above sum, the whole of the coal to be met with in. Suderoe ; consequently, as there are se- veral places at which it, is found, none-of the seams: can be of large extent. With respect to the quality of the coal, he as- serts, that it was found to. be superior to that of Airshire ; but this cannot be the case, if it be all like the specimens we pro- cured, which are entirely similar to that occurring imbedded in the basalt, in the vicinity of Ballintoy, on the coast of Antrim. It presents the same ligneous texture ; it burns with difficulty ; it. OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 258 it emits the same intolerable smell; and produces a very large proportion of ash.’ At Ballintoy it occurs only in small beds, sometimes in very minute patches, and i is used only in burning lime. I think it is fair, therefore, to conclude, that this coal pre- sents none of the characters of regular stratification ; and it be- sides, appears to be totally unaccompanied with sandstone, as I find it immediately connected with trap in some of the spe- cimens I have got. So far as we saw, sandstone does not oc- cur in the country. Lanpr mentions generally, that it is to be found in the:dales of Nordstromoe. We nowhere, however, saw any vestiges of it; and from the very low ebb of his geo- logical acquirements, nothing on that subject, unless corrobo- rated by other testimony, can be attended to, as we may judge by the following passages, quoted from Captain Born, as au- thority. “ If (says he) a bluish-grey fine-grained sort of stone, “ which contains grains of quartz and calcedony, be not gra- ‘* nite or limestone, neither the one or other is to be found in “« the islands.” Page 140, The varieties of trap we met with, were Greenstone, Por+ phyritic Greenstone, Amygdaloid, Trap-tuff, and Porphyry- slate. Basalt we found only in a few dykes; we nowhere saw it in beds, or presenting the: beautiful articulated columns of Staffa and the Giant’s Causeway. ‘The beds composed of these different kinds of trap, have one uniform dip and direc- tion ; stretching from S. S. E. to N. N. W., and so very slight- ly inclined, that it required a considerable portion of the rock to; be seen at once, to render the inclination. perceptible. When surveyed from the north or south, the beds conse- ' quently appear horizontal; while on the east and west sides an inclination is sheet } dipping almost imperceptibly to, wards the south. This 254 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY This arrangement of the mass of beds, prevails with great uniformity throughout; we observed them to deviate only in one instance from it, at the western extremity of Myggenaes, where they rise abruptly to an angle exceeding 45°. There was no particular uniformity that we perceived, in the succession of the different kinds of trap, although such might perhaps be dis- ‘eovered on more minute investigation. The trap-tuff was more abundant than any of the other varieties, and was often the only material we could distinguish, in cliffs of tremendous elevation, in which we sometimes found it difficult to trace the separation of the different beds. When greenstone or amygdaloid are interposed, the separations are better defined, and are often divided, by a layer of brick-coloured fine- grained tuff, which passes into the substance of the adjoining bed, and is analogous to the red material which forms so stri- king a feature in the basaltic promontories of the Giant’s Causeway. The grandest display of greenstone which we met with was at Zellatrae in Osteroe, where the bed, like that of Fairhead, is three hundred feet thick, and split in a similar manner, into prismatic concretions, which, at a distance, give it a regular columnar appearance. On the top of the hill, at Leynum, I found the greenstone in the rude columnar form, which it assumes on the south-west side of Arthur’s Seat; and in Nalsoe, as well as in some other of the islands, we no- ticed eds of a description quite new to me. Being considera- bly elevated in the cliff, we could not ascertain the dimensions with accuracy. I think, however, that, in Nalsoe, may be from forty to “fifty feet thick ; it is composed of vertical co- lumns, enormously thick. In some the diameters were little short of their length ; and although they stand straight upon the base, they are all bent at the sides, so as to present an ir- regularly waved line between each. The most singular cir- cumstance OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 255° ecumstance respecting them is, that they are all coated with am arrangement of small prisms, set at right angles to their axis ;. so that when some of these rude masses are broken in their longitudinal direction, a circumstance which occurred not -un- frequently, a double set of small prisms appeared, to separate - the columns, not unlike little dykes; and when an horizontal direction chanced to be displayed, a radiating arrangement of prisms was observed around the edge. The substance which generally occurs, of a brick-red colour, and forms partial sepa- rations between some of the varieties of trap, seldom extends’ to any great length ; in thickuess it is very irregular ; the great-. est depth we met of it, was in the vicinity of Kirkeboe in Stro= moe, where it may be from eight to ten feet. It is not invariably of a red colour: under the greenstone at Leynum, it. occurs of a dark-green. This material, which in some cases may very readily be mistaken for sandstone, particularly as it frequently presents a slaty texture, after being acted on by the weather, appears to me to form a portion of the overlying trap, although it no doubt presents a very different character. In other beds of greenstone, nearer home, alterations equally re- markable may: be pointed out; and as we frequently observed in ‘it cavities lined with zeolite, similar to those which were dispersed througli the other parts of the same bed, it ei possibly be considered of a separate formation. » Notwithstanding the uniformity that prevails in the general disposition of the trap in Faroe, there are some beds which de-' part entirely from it. The most remarkable of these, we met. with in the vicinity of Norderdahl in Stromoe? “A little north ° of. this’ place, there is a conical hill, presenting 4 projecting . rounded ‘front towards the shore; and being denuded from top to bottom, the structure is distinctly seen, and the horizontal beds traccd with the utmost precision. Resting on these, and covering 256 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY covering the summits and sides of this cone, excepting on the south, a bed of greenstone stretches, which is rendered parti- eularly conspicuous by the vertical rents of its prismatic con- cretions. On the west side, after descending more than half- way from the top of the cone mentioned, it continues towards, and again rises to the tep of Dalsnypen ; from whence passing under other beds, it may be traced in an undulated line, al- most without interruption, to Skellingfeld, where it terminates in a wedge, about half-way from the base of that hill. A little north of this, and nearly in a line, the same kind of greenstone recommences, and extends to beyond Leynum. Skeeling pre- sents on the west side a bare section, like the conical hill of Norderdahl, whence the beds may be counted in one continu- ous slope, from the base to the summit, rising to a height of about three thousand feet; and here, although the powerful mass of greenstone I have just noticed, loses itself in a wedge, there is not the slightest derangement created among the other beds of trap of which Skeelingfeld is composed. The position of this enormous mass of greenstone is worthy of attention, and is difficult to reconcile with any of the doc- trines I know of. Its occurrence in Skeeling, &c. as an adven- titious ‘bed, like that of Salisbury Craig, is nothing uncom- mon; but when it extends from under the incumbent trap, stretching itself over a most irregular surface, and finally co- vering, as like a cap, a very acutely conical hill, it assumes a new and totally different character. It is in the beds of amygdaloid that the beautiful zeelites and calcedonies are found. I have already noted the different places where they occur, and have also given sufficient details respecting the varieties of zeolite. But as the peculiarities of Calcedony have often been urged in support of doctrines very opposite - ee ee OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 257% opposite in geology, a description of them belongs more pro- perly to this part of my subject. From the proofs we met with in Faroe, of the igneous ori- gin of trap rocks, I think it almost unnecessary to enter into any discussion respecting the formation of Calcedony, as no doubt can very reasonably be entertained of its co-existing with the matrix in which it is inclosed. The laws by which it has been regulated, in assuming the various appearances it now presents, are, however, beyond our reach; nothing I met with~- tended in any degree to elucidate the subject. Calcedony occurs in the rock in the most irregular masses, generally rounded, and sometimes shooting into forms like. bunches of grapes. It is either solid, or in hollow cavi- ties, and varies in size from the head of a pin to a foot or up-’ wards in diameter.. When solid, the masses are marked with: parallel lines, straight or concentric, sometimes with botlv; the latter forming a border or coating round the: straight: lines. The, solid pieces are frequently penetrated by minute stalac- tites of the same substance, branching through the mass, in a form perfectly vegetable ; and as these always contain a por- tion of green earth, it occasions an appearance extremely similar to moss; which no doubt has given rise to the assertion of Lanpt, that moss and_ straw actually occur: in them.' I have sometimes found, on breaking the solid’ masses, which contained these slender: fibres, the latter would: séparate from their bed, and leave an impression of their form,— a tolerable proof that they must have been in a solid state: pre-: vious to their being enveloped in the larger mass. J have ob- tained very few stalactites, whose centres are not occupied by this green substance; it. seldom exceeds in thickness the: twentieth part of an inch, and varies in colour, from a very Vor. VIL Kk dest: 258 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY dark green, with a tinge of blue, to a pale green, and even 8 light straw-yellow. It is always opake. It is not easy to conceive, that this substance could have existed without some- thing to support its very delicate fibres; but yet this appears to be quite evident, from the examination of specimens, and consequently adds one more difficulty to the solution of the formation of Calcedony. When calcedony occurs in hollow cavities, they are simply mamillated, ornamented with stalactites, or lined with crys- tals. Externally, they are of a very fantastic shape ; but with- in, the arrangement is more symmetrical. The upper part forms a kind of dome, with a smooth mamillated surface, or appended all over with stalactites, which generally hang per- pendicularly, but sometimes ramify in-every direction ; while the lower part of the cavity is filled up, so as to present an horizontal surface or platform, affording a pleasing contrast with the irregularity opposed to it. This platform is evidently the result of circumstances sub- sequent to the formation of the stalactites, as they not only occasionally penetrate it, but sometimes the horizontal partseems to have risen to the top, so as to have filled the cavity, and en- velope the stalactites entirely: This part of the mass also varies from the rest, by presenting different shades of colour, forming the onyx, or Band Calcedony of the lapidaries ; it is often accompanied with semi-opal, white, yellow, and green in colour, and also with the opake white substance, known by the name of Cacholong. It likewise often happens, that the upper and stalactitic part of the cavity is covered over with a second deposition, forming a distinct coat, which sometimes differs in colour. Besides the circular arrangement which this pro- duces in the section of the stalactites, when they are cut across and t OF THE FAROE ISLANDS: 259 and polished, a radiation \of fibres may be observed diverging from the slender green thread which occupies the centre. It does not appear as if the form of the stalactites were ow- ing to the pendulous. position in which they are found, as they sometimes occur attached by the side; and terminated both above and below. With respect to»size, they vary, from the thickness of a hair to two inches in diameter; but I have not. found any above four inches in length. The cavities are often entirely lined with crystallized ‘quartz, . which always forms a distinct coat, and is sometimes interpo- sed between the two coats of calcedony. To illustrate these combinations, I selected a series of specimens, all of them por- tions of hollow masses. In the first, the quartz is transparent and crystallized, in the usual form. In the second, the crystals are~ coated with calcedony, but so slightly, that the shape of the quartz is preserved entire. In the third, the edges of the crystals are rounded off. In the fourth, the apices are partly converted. into mamillons. And, in the fifth, the crystallization is entirely replaced by a.mamillated surface; the quartz being. visible only in the section of the mass. Nearly the whole-of these changes may be traced in- one specimen belonging to Sir Gerorcze Mackenzie. At.one part, the crystallization is nearly complete, while, at the other extremity, it is perfectly mamil- lated. I never observed quartz crystals among stalactites, or stalactites among crystals. The quartz and calcedony al- ways occur in distinct coats, one-or other occupying the whole surface; and, except very rarely, with perfect uniformity. Quartz and calcedony is a combination well known to mi- neralogists ; but before visiting Faroe, I was not aware, that the latter substance occurred, also intimately connected with zeolite. Some Danish mineralogists have considered this sub- stamce as the connecting link between calcedony and opal; a Kk 2 conclusion: 260 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY conclusion I did not find to be justified by the observations which occurred to us; opal and the mixture of zeolite and calcedony having uniformly very different aspects. The first specimen of this description which I procu- ved, is a very interesting one. The outer surface, or that which lay next the matrix, is formed of radiated zeolite, which has also been projected into the cavity, in the form of stalactites. The whole of this is covered over with calcedony, which is so intimately blended with the acicular fibres of the zeolite, that it is nearly impossible to trace the demarcation between the substances. And, again, upon this calcedony, is imposed acoating of most slender stalactitic fibres of the same material. In the centre of the zeolitic stalactites, there is a point, like that occupied by green earth, in those of calce- dony, from which the zeolite diverges. Here the zeolite is infinitely harder than is usual with the varieties of that substance,—an effect no doubt produced by its intimate con- nection with the calcedony. In cavities of this description, we sometimes found quartz and sometimes zeolite; but the latter does not, like the for- mer, uniformly occupy the entire surface, being occasionally dispersed in solitary crystals, among the stalactites of calcedo- ny, and sometimes, though rarely, accompanied with carbonate of lime. The only variety of crystallized zeolite which occurred in these cavities, was Apophyllite, presenting two or three very beautiful varieties of crystallization : 1. In rectangular prisms, terminated at each end by faces set at right angles to the axis, and deeply truncated on all the solid angles, so as to form a truncated pyramid, the I LS ~ has ‘OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 961 the sides of which would measure about 67°. This is the Mesotype epointée, fig. 175. of Havy. 2. The same crystal, with the apices of the pyramids perfect ; may be termed the Pyramidal Apophyllite. 3. When the same crystal is so short in the prism, that the truncating faces touch, and so broad on the terminal faces, as to reach the sides of the prism, a cube trun- cated on all the solid angles is produced. 4, In rectangular prisms, hollow, and diverging at the termi- nation. This-variety, I suspect, owes its present ap- pearance to decomposition. In one specimen, I found some of the crystals of zeo- lite covered with a sheath of calcedony, open at the top, and partly hollow, owing to the decomposition of the apophyl- lite. It would be almost endless to proceed, with a detail of all the peculiarities which occur, in the combinations of these different substances. I have said enough to mark several cu- rious circumstances relating to them ; many of which will per- haps have an effect quite the reverse of affording any clew to- wards those hidden arts by which the hand of nature has ac- complished their formation. We have proofs, most unequivo- - cal, of the igneous origin of the rock in which they are imbed- ded, and consequently of their own. But granting this, as also the construction of the cavities, and the production of the sta- lactites of caleedony, whence came the second coating, which so frequently occurs, ling them entirely and uniformly throughout ? whence the different alternations of quartz and calcedony ? and whence the substance of those beautiful crys- tallizations of zeolite I have just mentioned ? Like 262 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY Like all other trap countries, the Faroe islands are intersec= ted by innumerable dykes. Those we examined were princi- pally of fine-grained greenstone, and more or less formed of prismatic distinct concretions. They frequently occur in the hollows, between hills, and in gulleys which intersect the precipices, being, from their proneness to decompose, them- selves the cause of these indentations. They do not appear to have any peculiar direction, although they be generally very nearly perpendicular. Many we perceived cutting the hills- from top to bottom. Some we could trace from one island to another; and even where covered with soil, we: often ob- served their track, by the superiority of the verdure on the surface; the dyke, from its looseness of texture, having acted as a drain, and rendered the bottom more nourishing to the vegetable root. This circumstance proves how permeable - these dykes are to.moisture, and helps.to account for the sin- gular fissures that. often present themselves on the shore.. They are considered by Lanpr as marks of some violent con- vulsion in nature ; and.to a common. observer, they have very much that. appearance: The effects of the weather, however,_ without any such assistance; are quite sufficient to accomplish. this end; nor will its operations be tardy ; the constant ac-. tion of the surface-water on the summit, and the continued. lashing of the wayes at the base, are ageuts of sufficient power 3. and we have thus: dykes washed from their sockets, for an. ex=. tent of several hundred feet, leaving a: frightful chasm in, rocks of enormous height.. Two of the most singular dykes. we met ala, are » between: Thiorniyig and Westmanhayn,, on the north-west coast of Stro- moe. The first intersects a mural. precipice, a little be-. yond Stakken. This is a double dyke; immediately under the edge of the cliff, it divides, and shortly after joins again ;. it. ES eee eee a OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 263 it then separates a second time; and thé left branch con- tinues its course downwards to the sea; while that on the right diverges, and breaks off in a poit ; a little beyond, but somewhat above the level of this, it recommences, and con- tinues downwards to the edge of the water, in a line parallel, but at a distance from the other. Both terminate in caves, awhich often occur at the base of dykes. The other which attracted our attention, is a little south of the entrance to: the bay in which Saxen is situated. At the top, it cuts the edge of the cliff, in the usual manner. After descending for some length perpendicularly, it makes a curve to the left, in the form of a hook, and becomes evanescent. Within this curve another takes its rise,-and after describing a figure similar to the letter'S, it again vanishes. To this ano- ther succeeds, somewhat similar in form, but not quite so regular, commencing and vanishing in the same way; and from within the lower curve of the last, another sets off; and from this the dyke continues perpendicularly till it reaches the water. The cliffs in which these two dykes are, being princi- pally composed of trap-tuff; the colour of which is dark-brown, while the dykes themselves are almost black, and of the pris- matic structure; the contrast renders them conspicuous and well defined. ' [have seen’ many veins of basalt, but never found one pre- ‘senting features at all analogous to those of the last mentioned. From the appearance of the tuff in its immediate vicinity, one would almost imagine, that the whole mass, from top to bot- tom, not less, I think, than about 1000 feet, had been in a soft state when invaded by the dyke. In many of these rocks there is a parallel disposition of the materials observable ; and in some, myriads of minute particles of zeolite were arranged in such regular lines, as to give them a decided stratified appear- ance. 264 ACCOUNT OF THE MINERALOGY ance. Some such lines existed in this cliff; which, near the dyke, were drawn as it were into the curves it has described, which could not easily have been the case, had the rock been in a so- lid state when it was traversed by this dyke. The soil produced by the degradation of trap-rocks is usu- ally found to be fertile, and favourable to vegetation. These islands, however, where no other rocks exist, have no such happiness to boast of. In Faroe, there is no flat land, on which the reduced materials can rest; and where not occu- pied by impracticable cliffs, they present a solid smooth sur- face, always highly inclined, on which vegetation, by degrees, arrests the crumbling particles, and in time forms a sward upon the arid rock. Here, however, from the impenetrable nature of the mass, no support can be obtained by the vege- table fibres ; accumulation, therefore, becomes fatal, and, sink- ing under its own weight, the soil slips from the surface, and leaves the rock in its original naked state. The hills being placed so near to each other, there are no valleys to enrich ; consequently, whatever falls from above; is swept away by the mountain torrents, and affords no: far- ther benefit. So slight is this vegetable covering, that it ofter gave way under our feet, leaving the smooth rock exposed. This was likewise the case among the more recent debris, on which, when expecting safe footing at least, we often found an inclined and slippery surface, covered with wet clay, which rendered. a considerable degree of caution necessary.. It is be- tween the sward thus formed and: the rock, that the rain+ water must find its way. Hence the cold damp bottom on which the verdure rests, renders it totally unfit for ro or improvement. f Where the torrents poured down the side of a hill, we had gn. opportunity of observing the smooth and. solid nature of the wen OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 265 the rock, on which the action of the water had produced no other effect, than displacing the soil, the course being simply marked by it on each side ; and Lanpr informs us, that there is no soil in any part of the country above three feet thick. It would be curious to investigate, whether this smoothness on the sides of the mountains could be traced to any external cause, such as that which has been observed by Sir James Hatz, on Corstorphine Hill, and other parts of this country, indicating the passage of heavy bodies along the surface. Near Eide, I observed a very remarkable example of this description. There the rock was scooped and scratched in a very wonderful degree, not only on the horizontal surface, but also on a vertical one, of thirty to forty feet high, which had been opposed to the current, and presented the same scoop- ed and polished appearance with the rest of the rock, both above and below. Had any doubt respecting the igneous formation of trap rocks remained upon my mind, previous to my visit to Faroe, “it would have been completely removed, by the facts we there met with, which have been so ably described by my fel- low traveller. These we first observed in the Island of Nal- soe, and afterwards at Eide, and at Waaij. The specimens bearing marks of this phenomenon, which we brought home, in order to present to the Society, will sufficiently convey the same impression to all who examine them. No production of a furnace can tell its tale in plainer language, nor any slag bear more distinct marks of the effects of heat. In Nalsoe, it was only on the surface of one bed of amygda- loid that we observed these marks of fusion. They were the first I had seen,.and of course created no small degree of sur- prise. This was distinctly the upper surface of the bed, be- Vou. VI. Ll ing 266 ACCOUNT OF THE MINARALOGY ing immediately overlaid by the brick-coloured trap-tuff, pass- ing into the superincumbent bed. At Eide and Waaij, the- appearances differed from those of Nalsoe. They did not oc- cupy the surface, but were dispersed through the bed, at dif- ferent elevations, yet all parallel, as if it had been formed of a multitude of partial flowings, each. moulding on the consolida- ted surface of its predecessor, and extending, as the supply of fluid matter permitted ; and, so far as we observed, this was always in the direction of the declivity of the hill or cliff on. which we perceived them. By the regularity of the folds and. wrinkles. which characte- rize their surfaces, and their usual horizontal position, they seem to have flowed undisturbed ; and although we never met with any very extensive surface exposed at one place, in con- sequence of finding them always on the declivity of a hill, yet we had the most perfect evidence of their passing under the incumbent rocks, but to an extent of which we could of course form no estimation. There was enough, however, seen, to mark it as a fact of a general nature, and one which, more than. any other I have ever met with, denotes the origin of trap: rocks. There is a wide difference between ascertaining the agency by which a rock has been formed, and the manner in which that agent has been applied. It is an inquiry perhaps of no: great utility, but, in prosecuting the one, the other naturally presents itself, and the inquisitive mind cannot be expected to stop short, particularly at a point, where, for the first time, it has met with data quite uneqitivocal. Here, however, the multi- plicity of proof in favour of the former, throws a difficulty of great: magnitude in the way of the latter. Had each bed been the operation of a voleanic eruption, the appearances of fusion would. : | | OF THE FAROE ISLANDS. 967 would have been confined to the surface, as was the case in Nalsoe ; but when these occur throughout the whole mass, all in parallel lines, it is difficult to comprehend how the minute portions constituting a series of distinct and separate flowings, . could have been produced. From the smallness of their bulk, it appears evident, that they never were exposed to the action of a superincumbent ocean, as they could not possibly contain heat enough to counteract its effects; and if the whole bed had been in fusion at once, the internal marks, if not oblitera- ted, would, at all events, have been deranged. In order to. conceive a bed of lava flowing under an ocean, I should ima- gine one necessary postulate is, that the bulk of heated matter must, in all cases, be equal to sustain the whole in a state of fusion, until it has flowed into the situation it was destined to fill; and from thence, again, other operations are requisite to raise it to the station it now occupies, above the level of the sea. The extent of the country, the uniform inclination of the beds, their regularity and symmetry, all present difficulties to this mode of formation ; and while the igneous appearances in the rocks of trap, bespeak a source in some near neighbour- hood, throughout the islands, there is not one spot that can be fixed upon, more readily than another, as the site of a volca- no; the highest hills in the country, Slattertint and Skeeling- feld, being surmounted by beds of trap, nearly horizontal. To my mind, the subject remains loaded with difficulty. It is something to have obtained’ such unquestionable corrobora- tion of the igneous origin of trap. But the circumstances under which that powerful agent has performed its office, are to me, I confess, as inexplicable as ever. tee eben ateiKo th een eaten legos: ecb Or; M0 Sei, i 28 flop wareusces sitosle eats derarkgvois! I cata - Sjeagtibedenvonkt weed biwalanqanos 1 vivodla i pre Faas a ee pagtiwolt odasaepeis: bre dogg “40 1388 on : pam. parvertiaraeel trvor'd drlbihong depeypiriet ‘ 7 nis etl headers ortaty serge sebelbhar is phere — ohor-alodtw sty: pease ath ytopegpuL Ot dquonetesd . | eles sedis bees ole. ‘Pmtin de ata GN pian rane waed: gecdk siapeo: lis so, blinds. ane a | as se 1 ney om uth 2 ba Ae eliig 2 He ras ths poe seme a 40 aS eee ee on ae ey > eat? peta VIII. Account of the Structure of the Taste Mountatn, and other Parts of the Pentnsuta of the Care. Drawn up by Pro- FEssoR Prayrair, from Observations made by Captain Basit Hatt *, R. N. F. R. S. Ep. (Read 31st May 1813.) be Agen Paper which I have the honour of presenting to the Society, is drawn up from letters written by Captain Hat to some of his friends in this country, after a visit made to the Cape of Good Hope, and an excursion to the Table Mountain, in July last. I have given the description, as much as possible, in his own words, and have only connected parts, which, from the nature ef the communications, were necessa- rily disjoined from one another. One of the letters being written to myself, and containing a general view of the whole, has been my guide for arranging the rest. Captain Hatt intended to have reduced his observations into order, for the purpose of laying them before the Royal Society, which, however, his professional avocations have not left him leisure to accomplish. In the mean time, as they make known a new fact in Geology, and one which, though from analogy, we might suppose that it was somewhere to be Vou. VIL. P. IL Mm met * Then Lieutenant. 270 ACCOUNT OF THE STRUCTURE met with, has not hitherto occurred, it was thought right to lay them before the Society; and I have undertaken the ar- rangment of the materials the more willingly, that the de- scriptions, though coming forward without the accurate finish- ing which the author alone could be expected to give them,,. do great credit to his skill and judgment, and will, I am sure, be received by the Society as a most promising indication of the. talents of a young and ardent Geologist, from whom much important information. may hereafter be expected. The Peninsula of the Cape is. a narrow mountainous ridge; stretching nearly north and south, for thirty or forty miles, and: connected on the east side, and near its northern extremity, with the main body of Southern Africa by a. flat sandy isth- mus, about ten miles broad, having Table Bay on the north of it, and the spacious indenture, or rather gulf of False Bay on: the south. ‘The southern extremity of this peninsula projec-. ting into thie sea, with False Bay on the east, and the ocean on ides south and west, is properly the Cape of Good Hope, and is the most southern point of the African Continent. At this. point, the-chain which constitutes the peninsula, though rug- ged, is lower than at the north end, where it is terminated by: the Table Mountain, and two others, which form an: amphi- theatre, overlooking Table Bay, and opening to the north. The sketeh. Plate XIII.. represents the positions here referred: to.. Table-Bay is open to the north and west, and is therefore an unsafe station for ships while the sun is in the-northern hemi- sphere, and while:the wind blows strong, as it always does, at that. season, from. the north-west. The ships then rendezvous in False Bay, where they have complete shelter from the pre- yailing wind.. The ship in which Mr Hatt was, arrived on the: coast Oe pur[sy jeego pron ap OF CARBONATE OF BARYTES. 291 separated, and are extremely imperfect. When. the angle of incidence at the first surface of the prism is increased, the images become more and more distinct, and better separated ; but, by diminishing the angle of incidence, all the images ap- proach one another, and are confounded into one mass of ne- bulous, light. With a plate of Carbonate of Barytes, which. was about prom tenths of an inch thick, and which had its surfaces at right angles to the direction of the longitudinal joints, the image of a candle was a large circular mass of light, when the incidence was perpendicular. | By inclining the plate, this. mass was chan- * ged into an annular image: By increasing the inclination, it as- sumed the form of a crescent, and at a. considerable angle of incidence, it was.separated into three imperfect images, or cir- cular arches; of nebulous. light, similar to those which were seen with the fifth prism. The middle image, which was the brightest, consisted of the ordinary and extraordinary image, which were not. separated, in. consequence of the parallelism of the refracting surfaces. In. one position of the plate, these- arches, were crossed by, other three. similar, arches, inclined to the first at an angle of 10° or 12°. _| The phenomena which. have now been described, differ in several respects from those which are presented by the agate. In the Carbonate of Barytes, the two images are distinctly se- parated, and. are; therefore, formed by two separate refractive powers; whereas in the Agate, the bright image is placed. in the centre of the nebulous mass... In the Carbonate of Barytes, the imperfect image occupies:a small space; but.in the Agate, it is an elongated mass of light, extending about 71° in length, ‘and, about 1° 7’ in breadth, on each side of the bright 4 image. These differences, however, are probably owing to the different ways in which the two minerals have been cut; but it is not easy 992 ON THE OPTICAL PROPERTIES easy to submit this point to direct experiment, on account of the difficulty of procuring a mass of agate, from which a varie- ty of transparent prisms could be obtained. It follows, how- ever, from the theory of the depolarisation of light, which I have explained in another place, and which is supported by all the evidence which any theory can possess, that the specimens of agate which depolarise light must necessarily form two di- stinct images,—a phenomenon to which we have found a rapid ‘approximation in the carbonate of barytes. The property which has now been explained, forms a simple . and infallible mineralogical character of the striated carbonate of barytes ; and is particularly valuable to those who have been perplexed by the numerous marks with which some writers have laboured to distinguish it from its kindred minerals. The assistance, indeed, which optics affords in discriminating mi- nerals, is of the most extensive kind; and it is much to be wished, that mineralogists would exchange many of their vague distinctions for those unambiguous characters which bodies ex- ‘hibit in the modifications they impress upon light. The Abbé Havy has, in some measure, begun this reforma- tion, and has set a brilliant example of what may be effected by the aid of mathematical and physical acquirements. In his admirable work on Crystallography, which has never been duly appreciated in this country, he has created a new science, in which he has shewn how to determine the integrant molecules of crystallised bodies ; and how, from a few primitive forms, may be derived that endless variety of secondary crystals which adorn the mineral kingdom. The recent discoveries which have been made in optics, enable us to give a new direction to these interesting inquiries ; to determine the forms, and even the angles of crystals, from their optical properties ; and out of a mass of shapeless fragments, to reconstruct an artificial crys- tal, iY PPS ir ————— ee ~~” oie nde - * “OF NITRATE OF POTASH. 293 tal, of which all the parts shall have the same relation as they _had in nature to the axes and sides of the primitive crystalline _ form, JIL Nrrrate or Porassn. ‘This salt possesses the most remarkable optical properties of any crystal that is at present known, and its various actions upon light are of. the most sperseloup and instructive charac- » ter. : } P The crystals ‘which I ho were all equiangular hexae- dral prisms ; and the light was transmitted through two natu- _ral faces, separated by another face, so that they were inclined »to each other at an angle of about 60°. . This inclination is by no means conyenient for measuring refractive and dispersive powers ; but I attempted in vain to form artificial faces incli- ned at a less angle, and, those means: which Thad found suc- cessful with other, soft sharma completely 1 failed when applied to this salt... When.a candle was aloaet through. the nitrate of potash, I observed a double refraction very much greater than that of calcareous spar,—a phenomenon which gave me the more :sur- prise, as ‘the Abbé Havy, who examined many splendid cry- stals of this salt, ascribes to it the property of imple refrac- tion. Case The lash refracted i image \ was a aioe lari mass of white ne- bulous light, condensed at its centre, into a very faint image of .the’candle, but without any strong prismatic tinge ; while the light which had suffered the greatest refraction, formed a di- stinct and highly coloured image. The great interval between Vou. VIL P, Ib > bo nyp the Ay 294 ON THE OPTICAL PROPERTIES the two images; the achromatic nebulosity of the first, and the distinctness and deep colours of the second image, formed al- together a singular phenomenon, and, at the same time, afford- ed an ocular demonstration of the existence of two dispersive powers in doubly refracting crystals. The following measures of the refractive powers.of the two images were taken with the greatest care: Angle of the prism, - 60° 21, Angle of refraction for the Ist image, 24° 8° Angle of refraction for the 2d image, 38° 54 Index of refraction for the-Ist image, 1.3374 Index of refraction for the 2d image, 1.5156. In order to-confirm these results, I formed a new prism, and obtained the following measures : Angle of the prism, =e 62° 12 Angle of refraction for the Ist image, 24° 48 ~ Angle of refraction for the 2d image, 40° 39 Index of refraction for the lst image, 1.3326 = Index of refraction for the 2d oo TO1sS By taking a mean of: chase results, nie hy are Peete near to each other, we obtain for the — , Least refractive: power, ~ -h.3350° Greatest refractive power, - 15145 Hence it follows, that the least refraction of nitrate-of pc ash, is almost exactly the: same as ‘that of Water, which i is. 1,3358,—a result of such an extraordinary: natnre,, that I felt it necessary to confirm it by repeated observations. kN In - ee i ee ee ee ee ———— a OF NITRATE OF POTASH. 295 In measuring the dispersive power of this salt, we cannot expect the same accuracy of result on account of the great angle of the prism. Owing to the nebulosity of the first image! it is impossible to measure its dispersive power; but it evi- dently corresponds with its low power of refraction. In order to correct the dispersion of the second refraction, it requires a prism of flint glass, with an angle of nearly 60°. With an angle of 66°, the dispersion is more than corrected; but with an angle of 56° the correction is not nearly completed. The dispersive powers due to these different angles, are es Bisrepa in the following Table: : 66°, 0.0613 Angles - the ae glass } 0 Dispersive powers, } eos _ Prism, ry 56 0.0546 By taking a mean between the two extreme observations, we obtain 0.058 for the approximate dispersive power,—a result which could scarcely have been anticipated from the substan- ces which enter into the composition of nitre. The follow- ing Table will shew the relation which this measure bears to | the dispersive powers of other bodies : Sulphate of ead, ~ 0.060 Nitrate of potash, 2d oo - 0.058 . Flint glass, - - 0.048 Wats, ; - - 0.035 In order to examine the character of the rays which form the two images, I polarised the light of a candle by reflection from glass, and viewed it through two of the parallel faces of a hexaedral prism of nitre. When the edges or common sec- Pp2 tions 296 NITRATE OF POTASH. tions of its faces were parallel to the plane of reflection, a bright image of the candle was seen in the middle of a mass) of nebulous light, exactly similar to what happens in the agate when its veins are parallel to the plane of reflection. But: upon turning round the crystal of nitre, the bright image gra- dually vanished, while the nebulous light increased ; and when: the edges of the crystal were perpendicular to the plane of re- flection, the bright image was extinguished, and: the nebulous. light a maximum. When the reflected image of the candle is viewed. through two inclined faces of the nitre, the two images vanish alternately, like those formed by all doubly refracting: crystals, A prism of nitrate of potash, having its refracting surfaces equally inclined to the axis of the enact crystal, possesses the faculty of depolarising light ; and hence it follows, from the theory of depolarisation, that lis prism must, in this case, form two distinct images.. The two neutral axes of this salt, are parallel aM rieipendte cular to the sides of the hexaedral prism ; and the depolarising axes are parallel to'the diagonals of the square base common’ to the two pyramids which compose its primitive reetangular octaedron. The least refracted image is that which is produ- ced by the extraordinary law of Capen: The beautiful coloured rings which I exhibited to the Socie- ty, as produced by the action. of topaz upon, polarised light, and. which I have:also discovered in the agate, and in a:great varie- ty of other bodies *, exist also, but-in a very singular manner, in the nitrate of potash. a By, + See Phil, Trans. Lond. 1814 Parts. p. 2180? STRUCTURE OF DOUBLY REFRACTING CRYSTALS. 397 By comparing, in a rude manner, the coloured rings formed by different bodies, with the thickness of the plates by which they were produced, I concluded that the conjugate diameters 1 of the rings were ail as Gian) m being the index of re-. fraction. In the nitrate of potash, however, their magnitude is quite anomalous, as it produces along the axis of the hexaedral prism a series of miniature rings, nearly eight times less than they should have been according to the preceding law. The beautiful generalisation of the phenomena of coloured rings, which we owe to the genius of the celebrated Bior, may per- haps afford an explanation of this apparent anomaly. The Carbonate of Potash forms also two images, one of which is bright, and the other nebulous. They are polarised in an ‘opposite manner, like those formed by the nitrate of potash, but the nebulous image is more distinct in the carbonate. With a prism ‘bounded by natural faces, and having a refrac- ting angle of 49° 53’, I obtained. ie following measures of its mean refractive power : de, pout of refraction for the ciel image, il 379. _ Index of refraction for the brehii image, 1.482. ft! wy. ON THE RR OF Dovary Rernacnive CrysTAts..: "Notwithstanding the numerous discoveries which have Te- cently appeared. respecting. ‘the polarisation | of light, no at- blem of double refraction. Theyfurnish us, Hdead: with a va- riety of beautiful - phenomena, analogous to the polarisation of light, which always accompanies the production of two images ; but they afford no ground of conjecture Tespecting a separa- tion of the penci into two parts. When. 298 ON THE STRUCTURE OF When I discovered the property possessed by the agate, of forming a bright and a nebulous image, and of polarising them in an opposite manner, like all doubly refracting crystals, I was sufficiently aware of the conclusions which it authorised * ; but as no other crystallised body exhibited analogous pheacs mena, I contented myself with stating these = as mere conjectures, which required the sanction of numerous ex- periments. In the carbonate of barytes, however, and in the nitrate and carbonate of potash, we are presented with properties analo- gous to those of the agate, and are therefore enabled to resume this subject, with that confidence which can only be derived from multiplied observations. When we examine the two images formed by calcareous spar and other perfectly transparent crystals, we find that they have the same magnitude, and are equally luminous and di- stinct. There is, therefore, no circumstance which can lead us to suppose, that the light which forms the one image passes through a part of the crystal, having a different structure from that which transmits the light of the other image. In the car- bonate of barytes, however, where the transparency of the cry- stal is imperfect, one of the images is nebulous and imperfect ; and as the same phenomenon is exhibited in the agate and in the imperfectly transparent crystals of the nitrate and carbonate of potash, we are entitled to conclude, that the light which forms the imperfect image is transmitted through the imper- fect structure ; while the light which forms the bright image, is transmitted through a structure of a more perfect kind. The imperfect transparency, therefore, of the crystal, and the nebulous * See Phil. Trans. Lond. 1813, Part 1. p. 101. a DOUBLY REFRACTING CRYSTALS. 999 nebulous character of one of the images, can be considered in no other relation than that of cause and effect: From the optical properties of the agate, this conclusion de- rives a still higher degree of probability. The two images formed by this mineral are not similar to each other, like those of calcareous spar, though they possess exactly the same pro- perties. One of them is bright and distinct; and the other is a mass of nebulous light. Now it happens, that the agate pos- sesses two different kinds of structure, corresponding to the characters of its two images, and distinctly perceptible even to the naked eye. One of these structures is composed of small serpentine lines, like the figures 3333, resembling the sur- face of water ruffled by a gentle breeze ; and I have a speci- men ‘in my possession, one-half of which ‘His much larger ser- pentine lines than the other. The light’ which passes through the serpentine lines, is that which forms the nebulous i Image ; while that which passes between them forms the distinct image, This may be demonstrated. es a. shaltiets ei experi- ments. ~ When the light is transmitted’ atts a part of the agate that has the largest serpentine lines, the nebulous image has an appearance different from: that which it has when the light is transmitted’ through the other part where the serpentine lines are ‘smaller. if the agate is inclined in the direction of the serpentine lines, s so as not to prevent the rays from passing between them, the bright i image will be distinctly visible as be- fore ; but when the agate is. Rage a in a direction at right angles to this, so as to prevent the rays from passing between: the serpentine lines, the whole of the transmitted light is ne- bulous. Hence it follows, that the nebulous image is produ- ced by the peer structure of the agate, indicated by the serpentine: 300 -ON THE STRUCTURE, OF ‘serpentine lines; while the bright image is produced by a structure the same as that of all other transparent bodies. The curvature of the nebulous light, in some specimens of agate, with incurvated veins, and its constant parallelism to the laminz, and to the direction of the serpentine lines, give additional probability to this conclusion. Here, then, we have a case of the most unequivocal kind, in which one image of a doubly refracting crystal is produced by one structure, or by one part of the crystal, while the other image is produced by another structure, or another part of the crystal ; and hence we are led to conclude, in general, that the two images exhibited by all doubly refracting bodies, are formed by two different structures, related to some axis or fix- ed line in the primitive crystal. Whether this difference of structure is produced by a difference in the arrangement of the elementary molecules, or is owing to a combination of dif- ferent ingredients, is a point which still remains to be deter- mined. The phenomena presented by the agate ve the ieee of barytes, convey still farther fo ees respecting the structure of these imperfect crystals. In one direction, the light transmitted by the agate is wholly nebulous; the perfect image being converted into a shapeless cloudy mass, and con- founded with the nebulous image. In another direction, one of the images is distinct and perfectly formed ; and, in one specimen, which has the faculty of depolarisation, there must necessarily be two perfect images. In a prism of the carbo- nate of barytes, both the images were imperfect. In a second prism, the one image was nebulous, and the other distinctly formed; while, in other prisms, there was a ra- pid approximation to two perfect images. Hence it follows, that DOUBLY REPRACTING CRYSTALS. 301 that the imperfect structure, which, in general, transmits only a mass of nebulous light, allows a distinct image to be formed, when the rays are incident in one particular direction ; while the perfect structure, which in general gives a distinct image, allows an imperfect image to be formed, when the light pene- trates it by a particular path. These inferences, which I conceive to be irresistible, have a higher degree of importance ‘than we may at first be disposed. to attach to them. They form a real step in the explanation of double images, and indicate a part of that structure which is necessary to their formation. The other phenomena of double refraction are still involved in obscurity. '! he opposite polarisation of the two pencils, may be explained by suppo- sing the crystal to consist of laminze inclined in various direc- tions ; and, as I have shewn in another place*, the same phe- nomena may be actually produced by an artificial crystal, com- posed of bundles of glass plates. The most perplexing point, however, is the extraordinary refraction which takes place at a perpendicular incidence. Whether this phenomenon is the re- sult of an extraordinary law of refraction, as Huycrens and Newton supposed, or is produced by forces dependent on the elementary structure of the crystal, is a question which still remains to be determined. The extraordinary reflection and refraction arising from the last of these causes, which I have discovered in Mother of Pearl +, present an analogy, by no means remote, to the phenomena of double refraction. * Phil. Trans. Lond. 1814, Part I. p. 280. + This substance, whose remarkable optical properties I have explained in another place, resembles the Agate, the Carbonate of Barytes, and the Nitrate and Carbonate of Potash, in giving a bright and a nebulous image, when the Vou. VII. P. II. Qq light 302 ON THE sTRUCTURE, &c. light is transmitted in one direction, and two bright images, when tlie light is transmitted in another direction ; but it possesses this property under circum- stances of such an extraordinary nature, that I could not with propriety have introduced any account of it into this paper. A number of soft substances, of animal and vegetable origin, have likewise- the faculty of forming a bright and a nebulous image, under various singular modifications. A full account of the results which I have obtained with this. elass of substances, will be found in another paper. XI. An Account of Observations, made by Lord Wexp Sry- moor and Professor Puayrair, upon some Geological Ap- pearances in Glen Tilt, and the adjacent Country. Drawn up by Lord Wes Seymour. (Read May 16. 1814.) Ay Gee river Tilt is a principal branch of the Tay, which rises on the borders of Aberdeenshire, and runs to- ' wards the south-west, through the north-eastern part of the county of Perth. A portion of the valley along its course, for ‘about ten miles above Blair of Atholl, is called Glen Tilt. 2. The adjacent country presents the common character of the Highlands. It is mountainous and rugged, and the surface, except in the lower parts of the valleys, is chiefly covered with heath. Peat-moss frequently occurs. The rock beneath con- sists entirely of those substances, which belong either to the Primitive Formation, or the Overlying Primitive Formation, of Werner, and of which the stratified part is by Dr Hurron denominated Primary. This account is warranted by all the observations which have been made upon these mountains; 5 and their general aspect furnishes a confident inference for the whole. To the north and north-east, the mountains about the head of the river Dee, two or three of which are little inferior Qq2 in 304 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES in height to Ben Nevis *, are said to be mostly of granite ; and, it is probable, that either granite, or substances akin to it, oc- cur in many places between these mountains and Glen Tilt. From the south-east, round by the south, to west, there is little room to doubt that the rock is almost wholly stratified, and that its chief components are gneiss, mica-slate, granular lime- stone, and granular quartz, with their intermediate gradations. This opinion was supported by our own observations, at the Pass of Killicranky, a few miles to the south-east of Blair, where there is a fine transverse section of the strata, and by others upon the rocks in the channels of the Garry and the Bruar, todhe west and north-west of Blair. Without dwelling upon these , I shall enter upon a detailed description of what appears nearer Blair, and proceed with it up Glen Tilt }. 3. In- * Their height is about 4000 feet ; that of Cairngorm, one. of the highest, is- 4060. + See Note A, at the end of the paper. _ : se + The minute details, which. continually oecur in the following pages, must, to most readers, appear tedious and useless. It is necessary, therefore, to men- tion, that Glen Tilt was the first scene, in which Dr Hurron met with what he considered as a confirmation of his views, respecting the relations that subsist between granite and the strata adjacent to it; and, in the controversy that has. . since prevailed, between his followers and those of Werner, the former have in- sisted much upon the phenomena in this Glen, while the latter have repelled their arguments by a very different account of the structure of the rocks, and of the substances that compose them. It became of importance, therefore, to ascer- tain the facts more precisely. With this intention, Mr Prayrair and myself. passed some days in examining Glen Tilt, in the autumn of 1807 ; and I return- ed again, for a short time, in 1808. In my description, I have endeavoured to avoid the language of theory as much as possible. When any thing has been no- ticed which is trivial, and does not immediately bear upon the main question, it willl IN GLEN TILT. 305, 3. In the immediate neighbourhood of ) Blair, the river Tilt, and the small stream of the Banavie, which runs through: the Duke of Atholl’s pleasure-grounds, afford, each of them, a deep section of the rock, and shew that it is almost wholly formed of strata...The slight examination which we gave to these, led us to conclude, that they consist, for the most. part, of granular quartz, mica-slate, hornblende-slate, and granular limestone. An observation made with an instrument for the purpose *, upon the strata by the side of the Tilt, not far above its junction with the Garry, determined the stretch:to be about N. 60° E.; and another upon the strata in the bed of the Ba- navie gave N. 58° EK. This near coincidence must, however, be regarded as accidental; for the position of these strata is. yaried by many inflexions of their planes, especially on the banks of the Tilt. The dip is every where southerly, at an angle which varies considerably, but is commonly small for. primary will be remembered, I hope, that*the occasion called for a statement of the whole ease ; and, besides, while the mere outlines of theory are still under discussion, it. seems expedient, in describing phenomena which strongly affect pay. single point of importance, to enter largely into the concomitant circumstances ; since it is im- possible to foresee what may, or may not, become subservient to a more précise! determination of the truth. Anentia i$ * This instrument was a Clinometer, in its-¢arliest: form, without the brass: plate. Though it was by no means so accurate as the improved one, the obser- vations may, in general, be considered as within a few degrees of the truth. Some error may occasionally have arisen, from the-surface of the rock being ‘ra~ ther uneven, or from its not being quite parallel to the plane of. stratification.) For) a more convenient comparison of the various positions of the strata, the bearing of the line of stretch if throughout, indicated by the number of degrees east of north. ' As the line of dip is always at right angles to that of the stretch, it was thought sufficient to mark on which: side the depression lay, by mention- ing that of the four, or of the eight, principal points of the compass, which was, nearest to its bearing. 306 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES primary strata. Where observed by the side of the Tilt, it was between 20° and 30°; in the bed of the Banavie, it was 32°. 4, On the western bank of the Tilt, between two and three miles above its junction with the Garry, we observed some sie- nite in a scar, by the side of a walk through the Duke’s plan- tations; and in another, not far from it, some gneiss. The soil that covered the neighbouring ground, prevented us from ascertaining the geological relations of the sienite. The gneiss is singular for having its component substances so disposed, that the structure of the stone bears no marks of stratification ; but its structure differs from that of granite, in being less per- fectly granular, and less highly crystallised. 5. The strata in the bed of the Banavie, a little below a bridge, that crosses it about a mile above Blair, are cut by a vein, or dyke, of felspar-porphyry. The felspar base is chiefly of a red colour, but partly also grey. The vein is vertical, and about ten feet broad *. 6. There is a good road carried up Glen Tilt, as far as Fo- rest Lodge, one of the Duke of Atholl’s hunting-boxes, nearly seven miles from Blair. This road, after crossing two or three small streams, in the beds of which there is mica-slate, de- scends, about the end of the second mile, to the side of the ri- ver. There is here a bridge, called Gilbert’s Bridge, and about fifty yards below it, we found in the channel gneiss, interstra- tified with granular limestone. From the bridge the road fol- lows the bottom of the valley, and being often carried along the bank of the river, affords good opportunities of examining the ® Dr Horron mentions, (in a manuscript intended for his third volume, and sever published) that he found several dykes, both of grey and red porphyry, in the course of this stream. ta i ta . Bsa hyper siggn, ¥ Pe . IN GLEN TILT. 307 the rocks, which the violence of the stream has exposed in many parts of the channel.. The substances of which they consisted, to a point rather more than a mile and a quarter be- low Forest Lodge, and marked by the letter A in the map * (Plate XXI.), and the plan of the river (Plate XVI.), were, as far as we observed them, gneiss, mica-slate, and granular lime- stone. ‘7. On the west side of the valley, between Gilbert’s Bridge and the opening of Glen Merk, a great quantity of fragments, brought down by torrents from the steep bank of the moun- tain, consisted chiefly of mica-slate ; though there were among them a few small ones of sienite. Mica-slate may, therefore, be inferred to be the prevailing rock on this side, and some strata of it, near the brow of the declivity, were distinguishable: in the bed of a torrent, even from a distance. Strata of mica- slate occur also at the-falls of the Merk, near its junction with. the Tilt. Farther up, on. the same side of the valley, where. the road crosses the Criny, that stream flows aver some beds of” granular quartz. 8. On the eastern side of the valley, we often-found granular: limestone near the road, between Gilbert’s Bridge, and ano- ther about two miles farther up, called Gow’s Bridge; and a quarter of a mile beyond this, limestone is visible fides a dis- tance, in a scar on the same’ side, and three or four hundred. feet above the bed‘of the river. 9. Through all this part of the Glen, the stretch and dip of the strata are tolerably uniform. In four observations + made between a point a little below Gilbert’s Bridge, and Gow’s Bridge, '® The outline of the map is copied from Sronre’s Map of Perthshire. An at- tempt has been made to give a better representation of the mountains near Glen, Tilt ; some names have been added, and others have been differently spelt, with a view of conveying the Gaelic pronunciation more distinctly. + An observation at the falls of the Merk is included. 308 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES Bridge, the two extremes of the stretch were N. 38° E., and N. 51° E., and the angle of dip, which was southerly, varied from 26° to 38°.. As far as the eye could judge, we had no reason to suppose that the irregularity any where exceeded these limits. 10. Fifty yards below Gow’s Bridge, the strata, which are here of mica-slate, are cut by a vein of greenstone-porphyry. The imbedded crystals of felspar are few and small, and the base is very minutely crystallised, containing, in the place of hornblende, what seems to be common actinolite ; but this dis- tinction is, perhaps, of little consequence, since Havy has been induced to unite these two substances under the same species, on account of their agreement, both in the structure of the crystal, and in chemical composition, as proved by the analyses of Vavauetin. The vein is about ten feet thick, and dips westward at a large angle. 11. At the point A, the rocks in the bed of the river under- go a material change, and for upwards of three miles, they con- sist in some places of sienite, and in others of primary strata ; and sometimes they exhibit masses of gneiss, granular lime- stone, granular quartz, hornblende-slate, and other materials of primary strata, interspersed among unstratified masses of sie- nite. An idea of the irregular succession of the stratified and unstratified masses may be derived from the plan*, which in- cludes the course of the river between this point and a bridge above Forest Lodge. Appearances of the same kind occur for a mile and a half farther up. F 12. In * This plan was laid down, by taking bearings with the compass along the bank of the river, according to its changes of direction. and by pacing the dis- tances. The length of a certain number of paces was determined by measure- ment. IN GLEN TILT. 309 12. In some of these rocks, the sienite is seen in contact with various materials of the primary strata, and it was our particular object, to examine the phenomena in such cases. But, before I enter upon a detailed account of them, it ‘may be of use to give a general sketch of this part of the val- ley. 13. Glen Tilt, for about two miles below Forest Lodge, and for three miles above it, to the junction of the River Chlochan, runs nearly in a straight line, in the direction of N. from 46° to 480 E., and therefore not far from N. E. and S. W. _ 14. The sicigation of this part of the valley is considerable. ‘According to General Roy’s measurement, the lawn at Blair is 425 feet above the level of the sea; and Mr Pray- Farr’s observations with the barometer, indicated the dif- ference of level between Blair and Forest Lodge to be about 400 feet. At the time of these observations, the baro- meter was falling, and the result is consequently too great; but after allowing for any probable error in excess on this account, the height of Forest Lodge above the sea can hardly be esti- mated at less than 700 feet. 15. The bottom of the valley is narrow, rarely exceeding a fiailoing in breadth, and generally much less. The lowest - banks of the mountains rise on either side with very steep declivities; on the south-east, to the height of from 600 to 800 feet above the river; on the north-west, to between 1000 and 1200 feet. They are not cut by any lateral val- leys 5 except, that on the south-east side, two or three deep ravines, descending from the sides of Ben y Gloe, join Glen Tilt between Glen Chlochan and Forest Lodge ; and on the north-west side, a mile and a half above the Lodge, a brook, called the Crochie *, has deeply indented the ridge of the moun- Vou. Vi. P. IL. Rr ; tain, > This stream is called in the country Auld Crochie. Auld'signifies brook in Gaelic. ; . 310 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES tain; though it has still to find its way by a succession of falls to the Dioigcen of Glen Tilt. ‘Towards the upper end of the valley, the breadth of it-is contracted to that of the river, and the declivities are lower. 16. To thay cast of Forest Lodge, the lowest steep of the mountain is succeeded by a more gradual ascent to the top. of Cairn Joorchie, which is-from 1500 to 1800 feet above the valley. Beyond this, after a small intervening descent, an easy ‘slope leads to the top of Cairn Kin Callum, one of the three broad sunimits of Ben y Gloe, the ‘highest ridge in this neighbourhood. Cairn Gowar, the most lofty of the three, was ascertained by General Roy to be 3650 feet above the level of the sea, and Cairn Kin Callum cannot be much lower. The third summit is Cairn Leea, which lies at the south-west end of the ridge. 17. To the north-west of the Lodge, the bank that forms the valley, is immediately overtopped by another steep, of which the highest point is called: the Griurnon. Mr Prayrar deter- mined the-elevation of this above the valley, by means of ‘a base measured in a flat close to the Lodge, and found it to be 1590' feet. From the Griurnon, a broad ridge extends, in a © northwesterly direction, for nearly a'mile and a half, and rises a few hundred feet to the pointed summit of Cairn y Chlan- nan. The height of this’ mountain-above the ‘sea is probably about 2800 feet. 18. The opposite sides of this part of Glen Tilt present a striking contrast in their surfaces. Thesouth-eastern side is most- jy ie aa with’ soil, bearing either: good herbage, or heath;'and shews but little of the rock, either rifixletD sor loose. » Along’ the north-western side, the mountain ‘has in many places a cragey brow, the ruins of which lie’ thickly scattered over the decli- vity below, so as frequently to cover the -ground. This is particularly IN| GLEN TILT. , 811 particularly the case between the Crochie, and a point more: than three quarters of a mile below Forest. Lodge, and: opposite to M in the map, and the plan of the river. 19. Such a difference of aspect in the surface, gave reason to expect a difference in the nature of the rock beneath. Ac- cordingly, on the south or south-east side, we found it to con- sist of strata, of which the chief materials were granular lime- . stone, granular quartz, gneiss, and mica-slate. The general. stretch of these strata coincides nearly with the direction of: the valley, and their dip is towards the south-east, into the face. of the mountain, at a large angle ; though the stretch and dip. are occasionally somewhat varied by inflexions. On the north or north-west side, the mountain is chiefly composed of grey sienite, or rather sienitic greenstone, which bears no marks of stratification. In the bottom of the Glen, therefore, is the line of junction between the strata on the south-eastern side, and the unstratified masses on the north-western ; and it seems as. if the course of the Tilt had here been very much determined: by the position of the limestone strata, which occur frequently throughout the Glen, on the left bank of the river, and have been cut through by the stream. The facility with which limestone is worn away by water, in comparison with most of the other materials of a primary country, must have struck’ every mineralogist, who has met with it in that situation. 20. This general account of the rocks, that form the opposite sides of the valley, rests on the following observa- tions. Tv ns 21. We saw no sienite on the south side of the river, except immediately on its bank. The rock, where it appears, within a hundred feet above it, is stratified, and often of limestone. In order to ascertain its nature higher up, we ascended the moun- tain in two places, following, in each, a line almost at right Rr? angles 312 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES angles to the direction of the yalley, and therefore also at right angles to the stretch of the strata. 22. One of these lines was in the course of a brook, which. falls down the mountain within a quarter of a mile to the east- ward of the point A, and has made a deep section of the rock, though not in the immediate vicinity of the river, where the declivityis gentle. After passing over this declivity, I found granular limestone and mica-slate, from where the rock first appears, to the height of about two hundred feet above the ri- ver. For the next two or three hundred feet, there followed a gneiss, resembling that which I have already mentioned as, occurring near Blair, on the western side of the Tilt. It is. rarely stratified in its texture, and its stratification can only be. learned from the outgoings of its large beds. These, as well . as the limestone and mica-slate below them, dip into the. mountain to the south-east, at an angle sometimes considera-. bly more than 45°, and sometimes a little less. To the. gneiss succeeds mica-slate, conformably stratified ; and to that, another gneiss, a good deal similar in its texture to the last... Its beds are crossed by numerous slaty fissures, at right angles to their planes, which give it the delusive appearance of a stra~ tification dipping at-right angles to that of the rocks below; while, in fact, the beds lie conformably. Above, are distinct strata of granular quartz, also conformable. This quartz. was the highest rock that I examined, and might be about six hun- | dred feet above: the river. About a quarter of a mile farther , to the eastward, the strata are intersected by another brook ; and, as far as I could judge from a, distant view, they corres- pond with those in the first, as to the ipestonss and the lower» beds of gneiss. 23. The other line, in which the rock was examined, on this: aide of the valley, sets off from the Tilt, at a bridge near half a mile IN GLEN TILT. 313 mile above Forest Lodge, a spot remarkable for its distinct ex- hibition of a junction between the strata and the sienite, in the bed of the river. The southern bank of the river is here the foot of a declivity, several hundred feet in height, and excessive- ly steep, on which the rock appears only at intervals. 24. In the ascent of this declivity, Mr Prayrair saw nothing but granular limestone, to the height of perhaps more than three hundred feet. ‘Ihe beds of the limestone dip southerly, into the face of the mountain. Over the limestone is a bed of ” porphyry, twelve or fifteen feet’ thick. The base of the por- phyry is a grey compact felspar, and contains numerous small and imperfect crystals, of a reddish felspar, hornblende, and’ mica. At the foot of the declivity, and close to the bridge, there are lying many blocks of a porphyry, which has a base of grey compact felspar, and is singular for containing distinct crys-. tals, not only of white felspar and quartz, but also of mica in thin hexagonal plates.. From the sharp angles of theblocks, they must be supposed'to have fallen from the declivity above; but whether they are a variety of the bed just mentioned, or from another rock, we found no opportunity to determine. ' 25. Above the porphyry is mica-slate, alternating with beds of granular limestone ; and) Mr Prayrair observed granular limestone upon the brow of’ this steep face, where it changes: te a more gentle slope. This is the highest point that is vi- sible from the Glen below, and, by comparing its level with that of another on the same face, immediately above the Lodge; the height of which was afterwards determined by tri- -gonometrical measurement, he computed it to be about. eight hundred feet above the Tilt. _ 26. From hence the ascent is more gentle for a considerable distance, and the ground is covered with long heath. The rock is rarely seen; but what appears is mica-slate. The “ linesin which Mr Prayram ascended, conducted him to a . ridge, nad 314 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES tidge, formed on one side by the slope he had passed over, and, on the other, by the declivity of a deep ravine, through which flows a stream that rises in the higher part of Ben y Gloe, and joins the Tilt about three quarters of a mile above the bridge, by a. course almost due north, while that of the Tilt is to the south-west. On this ridge he fond mica-slate, stretching N. 38° E., and dipping to the south-east at an angle of about 35°. 27. In the direction of south, and perhaps a little west, from this spot, and at the distance of about a quarter of a mile, is a conical eminence, of considerable height, forming the point of Cairn Toorchie. All the way to its summit, he observed, the rock to be a granular quartz, in which there occur thin lay- ers of felspar and mica; and thus the stone is a gradation into. gneiss. The granular quartz lies above the mica-slate last mentioned, and, as far as he could judge, has the same stretch, and dip. Another high and bare point, at the distance of about half a mile on the other side of the ravine, appeared pretty evidently to consist of a similar rock, 23. Mr Puayrarr descended towards the north, along the sloping edge of the ridge, by the side of the ravine, and, in the course of his walk, went more than once to the bottom of the ravine, in order to examine the rock. At first, he found mica-slate upon the ridge, and, in the bottom of the ravine, granular quartz. Lower down, there was granular limestone: upon the ridge, of the same characters with that which he had seen in ascending the steep declivity above the bridge, and he had no doubt that it extended all the way to the side of the Tilt. The rock, on this part of the ridge, is indeed generally covered with a thick coat of earth ; but, in the bottom of the ravine, for several hundred yards before it opens upon Glen Tilt, there is limestone, which many falls in the stream have worn down, and scooped out, into a variety of irregular forms. . We yy Salli ew Pa ee lL IN GLEN TILT. 315 —We were prevented from examining the higher parts of Ben - y Gloe, by an unusually inclement season, which brought -showers of snow, for several days. together, before the middle of September. 29. On the northern side of Glen Tilt, there is not much, of _the fixed rock to be seen upon the lower parts of the declivi- ties. At the foot of the lowest fall of the Crochie, and.on the west. side of it, there is grey sienite, approaching to sienitic ) greenstone. In the bed of the first torrent to. the east of the _-bridge above Forest. Lodge, there is, on the lower part of the -mountain, granular. quartz, stratified, and dipping.at a large angle (ovens south-west, but irregular. Higher up the same stream, there is sienitic greenstone. 80. Lhe rock was examined in the bed of another torrent, which joins the Tilt between the bridge and a fall a few. hun- dred yards below it. On ascending the course of this stream, _the first fall in it discovers hornblende-slate, obscurely strati- fied, but, as far as could be judged, conforming to the ordina- ‘ry stretch of the strata on the south side of the valley. A -little higher, there is sienitic greenstone, and this. continues, -as you proceed, to a considerable distance. The hornblende- -slate seemed to lie over the sienitic greenstone. .In.a spot not far below thei Lodge, and at the height of perhaps three.or four hundred feet above the river, the rock is partly sienitic,green- _ stone, and partly granular quartz. 31.’ We examined the fixed rock of the crags:.on. the brow -of the mountain in one or two. places only, nearly opposite to. the point M, and it was there a small-grained sienitic green- ‘stone. But very satisfactory information, with respect to the nature of these erags, was afforded by the angular blocks, and loose fragments, strewed over the steep decliy ity below. We examined numbers of them through almost the whole length of the valley, and found them to consist chiefly of gradations between. 316 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES between grey sienite and sienitic greenstone, all bearing a strong resemblance to one another in chee general character, as well as to those which have been already mentioned, as occurring in the fixed rocks on different parts of the mountain. In these ageregates, the felspar is commonly whitish, but has various shades of colour, and is sometimes tinged with red. The pro- portion of the hornblende to the felspar is generally large. The grains are in some instances large and distinct, and in others extremely minute. Quartz is seldom an ingredient, and mica still more rarely. I conceive the most appropriate name for all the varieties to be Sienitic Greenstone, as the majori- ty of them approach more nearly to that substance, than to sie~ nite. ; $2. Among the angular blocks of sienitic greenstone, there occur also a few of gneiss and granular quartz; and a little below the point marked B in the plan of the river, I saw, on the side of the mountain, some fragments of hornblende- ‘slate and greenstone-porphyry. 33. Along the declivity, from a point over against M, to another a little above Forest Lodge, there are occasionally fragments of a sienite, similar to that which appears so often in the bed, and on the banks, of the river. This differs, in se- veral respects, from that which approaches to sienitic greenstone. Its chief ingredient is felspar, sometimes grey, but most com- monly red. It also contains less hornblende, and quartz in va- rious proportions. Nearly opposite to the point B, I found a few fragments of it a little below the crags, = about seven Sandred feet above the Tilt. 34, To these remarks on the northern bank of the valley, it may be added, that the Griurnon, a point several hundred feet above the crags of sienitic greenstone, consists of granular quartz, containing i %, IN GLEN TILT. 317 4 ee, containing specks of felspar, or small cavities, which may be et supposed to have been once filled by it. 35. I return now to a farther consideration of the rocks along the bed of the river, which consist partly of strata, and partly of sienite. Our examination of these, and indeed of the whole Glen, was much facilitated by the kind hospitality of the Duke of Atholl, who allowed us to fix our residence at Fo- rest Lodge for several days. 36. Among the substances that compose the strata, gneiss, _ hornblende-slate, granular quartz, and granular limestone, have already been mentioned. Mica-slate occurs more rarely. Be- sides these, there are many compounds of quartz, felspar, mi- ca, hornblende, actinolite, compact dolomite *, chlorite, talc, — steatite, and serpentine, which, in different rocks, are found in- timately mixed in a great variety of combinations, and in diffe- rent proportions. As examples of these compounds, I may . mention that, among the specimens we collected, one is a com- "pact dolomite, penetrated by chlorite and talc; a second, horn- _ blende-slate, penetrated by carbonate of lime; a third consists » of actinolite, felspar, mica, and carbonate of lime; a fourth, of —s ~ felspar, with hornblende and carbonate of lime; a fifth, of "quartz, © compact dolomite, and brown felspar; a sixth, of lartz, penetrated with chlorite, talc, and carbonate of lime; ee other varieties might be added. We found steatite ee Vox, VIL. Pp. IL Ss serpentine at ; fee iL wth i * By Compact Dolomite, I mean a magnesian limestone, differing from com- mon dolomite, in having its structure compact, and such as to render the frac- eae not. granular, as in common dolomite, but splintery, and passing to the ar . The fracture is thus well described by Mr Jameson, in his account of the dolomite of I-columb-kill, in his Mineralogy of the Scottish Isles ; and the name ae if Compact Dolomite has been used by the Comte de Bournon, in describing Cae specimens from that island, in the collection of Mr Auuay. Compact dolo- z is found also in GlenElg, 2 and in Kintail, on the coast opposite to the island 318. GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES serpentine in one or two places only. Almost all these com- pounds effervesce, more or less, with muriatic acid ; and of x course carbonate of lime, or carbonate of magnesia, perhaps both, are among their ingredients. Small specks of iron py- rites are frequent in them. One of the most common. of them consists of quartz and compact dolomite. ‘\ he quartz is in a large proportion ; but the dolomite renders the mass extreme- ly tough under the hammer, and imparts a little of its charae- ters to the fracture, which sometimes approaches to that of. compact felspar. It effervesces with muriatic acid, though of- ten feebly. Its colour is whitish-brown, where it is not de- composed. By decomposition, it assumes a rusty-brown colour near the surface, indicating perhaps that manganese is an in- gredient. Specimens from different spots present many varie- ties in these general characters. In some of the rocks consist-. ing of the aoregoen ds above mentioned, neither the form of a bad nor a stratified structure, is discernible; but we were led to consider them as parts of the strata, from the: imperfect — crystallisation of their ingredients, and their analogy to. others that are distinctly iputtGAs 37. The rocks of sienite do not indicate stratification, either by the form of a bed, or by the structure of the stone. Of the sienite there are two varieties, one grey, and the other red ; the colour of each depending on that of the felspar, which in both is the principal ingredient. Both contain quartz, and agree in: most other circumstances. We paid little attention to the grey, as we no where found it in contact with the strata; but the characters, which distinguish it from the grey sienite gra- duating into sienitic greenstone, on the northern side of the aa ley, have already been mentioned. In the red sienite, the fel- spar presents different shades of red, graduating into grey 5 the. hornblende varies much in its proportion, and in the size of its grains, * se a 7 ~, 4 IN GLEN TILT. 319 grains ; and so likewise does the quartz *. Minute crystals of ot _ iron pyrites are sometimes interspersed ; and our specimens ef- fervesce slightly with muriatic acid. Ata point marked C in theplan of the river, there is a variety of sienite, or rather sie- '-nitic greenstone, which I shall have occasion ‘to ‘describe here- after. t gis . 38. In the bed of the river there are four spots, that draw peculiar attention by affording a good exhibition of the rock, and three of them contain the most distinct phenomena of the junctions of the strata with the sienite. They are marked in the plan of the river by the letters A, B, 'C,-and D, and I shall employ these as names in describing them. 39. The spot marked A is the first place where the sie- nite is met with, in ascending the course of the Tilt. It may be readily found by a singularity in the channel of the river. Some large irregular masses cf rock project on either side from the banks, and through thém the water has cut a deep and narrow chasm. Above these rocks, the river holds a course nearly coinciding with that of the valley ; on meeting with them, it makes a sharp turn to the southward, and, after falling a few feet, in its passage through the chasm, expands into a pool at the outlet, and resumes its former direction, The direction of the channel through the chasm is near- ly N. and §, % Ss 2 40. At * This red sienite bears a close resemblance to that of the Malvern Hills in ~ Worcestershire, I do not remember to have seen one like it any where else, 820 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES “* 40. At the lower end of the chasm, the rock is a large bed of granular quartz, stretching across the river in the direction of about N. 56 E. Its stretch is indicated in the plan* of A (Plate XVI.) by a line expressing the water-line upon. its southerly face, and referred to by the figure 1. Its dip is to. the south-east, at an angle of about 45°. Its structure is not stratified. 41. Immediately below this, (at 2 in ihe plan), there appears a rock consisting of quartz, penetrated by compact dolomite. Little of it is visible on the southern bank, but what there is, agrees in its general character with the larger masses on the northern, and there is probably a bed of it, conformable to that of granular quartz.. The masses of it on the northern bank, are intermixed with others of granular quartz, but we could not pronounce them to be in alternating beds. 42. The rock on the north side is then concealed by the soil for a considerable distance down the river, except that, about forty yards below the quartz rock, (at 3 in the plan), there may be seen in the channel some small masses of gneiss, interstra- tified with, and graduating into, mica-slate. The stretch of — these strata is N. 63° I., and their dip to the south-east, at an angle of about 45°. Some of the gneiss is so highly. crystalli- ¥ sed, as to have entirely lost its stratified structure, and is here and there in the form of veins, one or two inches in breadth, and cutting the strata of mica-slate at a very small angle. . Fi- gure I, in Plate XIX, is a sketch. of. a, horizontal section of a forked vein of this kind.. 43. On the southern bank, the strata are much covered by soil et a short distance below the quartz rock, but granular limestone * In this plan the rocks were merely sketched in by the eye. So likewise in the plan of D. ae a can ah &., = ee Se 2 Se IN GLEN TILT: 7 32} limestone begins to appear about ten yards from it. Soom af- ter, the bank of the river turns to the westward, and exhibits the outgoings of the limestone strata for about a hundred yards. ‘Their average stretch may be considered as about N. 30° E., within 20° of the direction of the bank, and their dip is to the south-east., at an angle varying from 26° to 56°. On a close examination, some rapid inflexions may be obser- ved; and among them, a small one is remarkable for setting the planes of the strata at right angles to one another. This is in the slope of the bank, near to. where the limestone is first seen below the quartz rock. 44, Returning now to the large bed of quartz, we find next to it, on the eastward, a rock composed of quartz and brown. felspar ; and this is succeeded by an aggregate of quartz, brown __ felspar, and hornblende. The granular quartz is not bounded on this side by any tabular face,.or strata-seam ; and we had reason to think, that the granular:quartz passes into the quartz and felspar, and that again into the compound of quartz, fel- spar, and hornblende. Though the constituent parts of this last rock are those of a sienite, the mass differs from sienite in Having them less perfectly crystallised, especially the horn- blende. It may be considered as bearing the same relation to sienite, which the gneiss, already described as having an unstra- tified structure, does to granite, and perhaps may with proprie- ty be called Sienitic Gneiss. Some specimens of it effervesce with muriatic acid. Ne 45. In the rock of quartz and felspar, and in that of quartz, felspar, and hornblende, there are no marks of a stratified struc= ture, nor are there any of a formation in beds; except that, on the south side of the stream, the sienitic gneiss lies very dis- tinctly over, and conformable to, some strata that follow to the eastward of it, and dip to the south. This circumstance, as well a8 322 GEOLOGICAL AP NEAACSERP as the oryctognostic characters of these rocks, and the appear- ances of gradation from the granular quartz, induce me to re- gard them as parts of the primary strata. Yet, if they are so, they have been subjected to some peculiar cause of irregulari- ty; for the stretch of the face of the granular quartz, which forms their western boundary, is about N. 56° E., and that of the strata, which bound them on the eastward, is at least 80° E. of N., while the distance between these different lines of stretch, measured along the middle of the channel, is less than thirty yards. . 46. The strata to the eastward are a few feet in thickness, and consist, partly of hornblende-slate, and partly of granular dimestone, varying to a compact dolomite penetrated with quartz.. They appear on both sides of the river. Owing to some disorder in them, and a good deal of inflexion in one place, their position could not be well determined; but their average stretch was judged to lie between 80° and 90° E. of N., and their dip is southerly about 40°. It must be remarked, that these strata stretch from 17° to 27° more to the eastward than the gneiss and mica-slate lower down, and from 50° to 60° more to the eastward than the granular limestone on the southern bank. 47. Above this, the channel of the river opens into a broad and straight reach for a hundred and forty yards. On either side the bank is high, and exhibits the bare rock along its foot. 48. Beneath the northern bank, the strata last mentioned are succeeded by the red sienite, which may be seen on that side with few interruptions, through the whole of the reach, and for between forty and fifty yards beyond it. Low rocks of this substance often project into the water. 49. On the southern bank, nothing worth notice appears for near twenty yards, and then (at 4 in the plan) we meet with strata IN- GLEN TILT.. ' * 323 _ to the eastward. The strata have somewhat of the characters of. compact dolomite, and probably consist of this substance inti- mately blended with a large proportion of others. Their ¥ stretch is about N.73° I., and their dip southerly at a consi- derable angle. Near the junction there are portions of the ' Strata included in the sienite, so a: to produce some resems. blance to an interstratification of the two substances, y 50. From hence rocks of the sienite appear on this side also, near the water and beneath it, through the rest of the reach, ; and forty or fifty yards farther. For about sixty yards, and to . ef apoint marked 5 in the plan, a junction of the strata and the = e may be ed ete in the bank ; eta that, the ie f or | masses, dreontinting ‘of. grami- cin nics, and hornblende-slate. These larly me of them are imbedded in the by veins’ of it. _ Two instances. ( iculai y described. spel hha One ‘occurs in some strata of mica-slate, near the edge of the ‘water, in, a spo 1 eferre by the figure 6. In: stretch and dip, these were judge -d to. agree nearly» with the strata ly- 4 ‘ing under the sienitic gneiss lower down ; and this makes their q heey to be N: from 80° to ‘90° E., and: ‘their dip southerly q °°) about “Vif iar strata lying over the red sienite, of which a large mass follows © + x % 324 . GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES about 40°. These strata rest on the main rock of sienite; and from it small veins of the sienite proceed upwards into the strata, and intersect them, running sometimes parallel, and sometimes transverse, to their planes. I think that the veins do not any where exceed an inch in breadth, and that they cannot be traced for more than a foot, owing to a covering of soil ; but, though the fact is exhibited on so small a scale, it is very distinct. 53. The other instance is in a mass of gneiss and mica-slate, which stands detached, at a little distance from the bank, and close to the water, at 7 in the plan. Its form is somewhat py- ramidal, and its greatest dimensions may be about twelve or fourteen feet long, six or eight broad, and between four and five high. ‘The stratification is very distinct. This mass is cut by veins of the sienite, from half an inch to fourteen inches in thickness, which branch in various directions, and run in some places parallel, in others transverse, to the planes of the strata. The veins may be traced all round the mass, and, on the south- east side, to their connexion with the main body of sienite be- low. Figure II, in Plate XIX, is a sketch of this rock taken from the south-east, on the opposite bank of the river. There is no attempt at perspective in it, and it must be understood to represent an orthographic projection of the surface of the rock upon an inclined plane, dipping towards the spectator ; but care has been taken to convey a faithful idea of the rela- tive position of the strata and the sienite, as actually exhibited upon the surface. The strata on the west side, which rise to the top of the rock, have their stretch N. 168° E., and their dip westerly 51°. At the foot of the rock on the east side, the strata dip nearly at right angles to those on the western. The lines of junction between the strata and the sienite are marked with great precision. Near the top of the rock, the strata that dip to the west, where in contact with the sienite, are a gneiss containing ~~ On IN GLEN TILT. 325 *eontaining red felspar, but this extends only a few inches, and graduates rapidly into mica-slate. $4. Farther to the eastward, within about twenty yards of the end of this reach of the river, and at 8 in the plan, a cut lately made in carrying the road along the top of the bank, dis- plays a junction of the sienite with some strata of hornblende- slate. The strata lie to the eastward of the sienite, and are vi- ssible for about seventeen yards. The cut into the rock is of small depth, and, where the substances are in contact, there is. not much to be learnt. But the strata stretch about N. 130° E., and dip to the nor:h-east at an angle of about 60°, thus in- dicating a position very different from that of most of the strata already described. In these strata there are some veins of sie- nite. 55. Beyond this, we observed nothing remarkable on either bank of the river for a considerable distance. 56. The spot marked B lies about eight hundred yards, in a straight line, above A. Here we found considerable masses of rock, consisting of gneiss, granular quartz, hornblende-slate, granular limestone, and some of the compound substances al- ready described, in strata variously interposed. Some of the limestone is a fine white marble. Rocks of the red sienite al- so appear in many parts of the bed of the river’, and the face of the southern bank affords a clear view of a body of strata ly- ing over the sienite. 57. To shew the irregularity that prevails among the strata at this place, and how much their positions differ from that of the great body of strata along the south side of the valley, I shall mention the stretch and dip of several masses, within Vor. VIL. P. II. Tt small 326 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES small distances of each other. It must be recollected, that the ordinary stretch through the valley is between 30° and 60° E. of N., while the dip is uniformly to the south-east. Near the southern bank, a little below the face of rock in which the strata are seen lying over the ‘sienite, ‘are ‘some strata standing up in the river, which stretch N. 9'7° E., and ‘are almost verti- cal. Within twenty feet of these, there is, onthe north side of the stream, a large mass of strata ‘of gneiss and ‘limestone, which stretch N. 78° E., and dip to ‘the north at.an angle of 40°. Not thirty yards from ‘thence, the road, which runs along the edge of the*northern batik, hasbeen cut into’some strata, composed of actinolite, felspar, mica, and a little carbonate of lime; and these stretch N. 165° E., with an easterly dip of 24°, Within a hundred yards, on the southern bank, and far-. ther up the stream, are some strata, which stretch N. from 78° to 83° E., and dip to the north at a large angle. 58. Where the strata in the southern bank lie over the main: rock of sienite, we did not observe that they were cut by any veins of sienite. But such veins abound in most of the neigh- pouring masses of strata, of which the irregularities have been just described, and they ‘traverse them in every direction. Many of the veins contain little besides red felspar, but the fel- spar resembles that of the sienite ; and: .remarked, where the main rock of sienite was in contact with some strata of compact dolomite, penetrated by other minerals, that the substance of the rock was sometimes merely felspar for two or three inches from the line of junction. 1O rf ‘59. In the pure white granular limestone, there are veins consisting of reddish felspar, minutely mixed with quartz. The limestone has yielded more: readily to the action of the: water, and left the veins very distinctly exhibited in their pro- jections on the surface; but the fracture of the rock shews the substance ofthe vein to be intimately blended with ‘the IN GLEN TILT. 327 the limestone on its sides. .The outlines of these veins are often extremely irregular, and their breadth is rapidly va- ried. ‘ _ 60. The strata on the northern bank, described above as consisting of actinolite, felspar, mica, and carbonate of lime, are cut by small veins, partly of red felspar, and partly of the red sienite. The outlines of these veins are very regular and distinct. we 61. To the eastward of these strata is a greenstone porphy- ty; similar to that of the dyke below Gow’s Bridge. I con- ceive it to lie here in a bed conformable to the strata. _ 62. In many of .the veins at B, shifts, or slips, are very con- _ Spicuous, and they occur even in veins of large dimensions. __, 63. Within a hundred yards above B, the strata appear in the bed.of the river in several places, and are much intersect- ed by veins of sienite, or sometimes perhaps felspar. et yt $$$ a ; : . _ 64. The spot pointed out by the letter C lies about 260 yards above Forest Lodge. There is here a fall in the river, and large masses of rock appear on both sides of it, but they do not afford much information to the geologist. _ 65. Those on the southern bank are strata, which seem to consist either of granular quartz, or of compound quartzose ‘substances, similar to those at A. There is a mass of granu- Jar quartz standing up in the middle of the stream. _ 66. On the northern bank, the rocks are an aggregate of red and grey felspar, intermixed with black or greenish hornblende. ~The hornblende is in a large proportion, and the stone may be considered as one of those gradations between sienite and sie- nitic greenstone, which have been already described. The Tt? rocks 325 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES rocks of this substance have not a stratified structure, nor do they appear to form a bed. 67. From the nature of the place, the junction of the sieni- tic greenstone with the adjoining strata cannot easily be tra- ced, and the rocks of either kind present few remarkable cir- cumstances. We found, however, some pieces of granular quartz and gneiss imbedded in the sienitic greenstone, and there is an appearance of veins of sienite cutting the large mass of granular quartz-in the middle of the river. | 68. At the foot of the fall, there is a vem of granular lime- stone approaching to compact dolomite, which cuts the rock of sienitic greenstone for three or four feet, and varies in thick- ness from an inch to less than half an inch. Its fracture is splintery, but passing to the foliated. Its hardness is consider- able; and from this, as well as from the appearance of its de- composed surface, it is evidently penetrated by some siliceous substance. Its colour is a dark greenish-grey ; its greenish hue - being probably derived from chlorite. It does not graduate into the sienitic greenstone that forms its walls, and there are small pieces of the sienitic greenstone imbedded in it. Its ter- mination could not be seen in either direction. en 69. The bridge over the Tilt, rather more than half a mile above Forest Lodge, stands at the place referred. to by D. Twenty yards above the bridge, there is a. fall of the river, and the arch is thrown between two of the nearest points of the precipices, which extend for a short distance on both sides of the deep pool below the fall. This is by far the most interesting scene in the whole valley for its geological pheno- mena. Fora plan of it, see Plate XVIII. 70. On the southern bank, seventy or eighty yards below the bridge, is the eastern extremity of a high scar, extending from. ee —.- IN GLEN TILT. 329 from this point for about a hundred yards down the river, and forming at once the bank of the river and the foot of the mountain, which rises about eight hundred: feet above it, with more than usual steepness.. The rocks, that appear in this scar, are strata, consisting for the most part, either of mica-slate, or, more frequently, of granular limestone penetrated with mica. On a close view, they were found to.be much bent: however, their general stretch may be estimated. at about N. 33° E., and is nearly parallel to the course of the channel at this place. ‘Their dip is to the south-east, commonly at an angle of from 30° to 40’, but in one place they are almost ver- tical, 71. Over against a point fifty yards below the east end of the scar, (at 1 in the plan) the rock begins to shew itself un- der the northern bank. The substance of it has here a base of grey compact dolomite, which serves as a cement to angular pieces of quartz, sometimes so numerous as to constitute the largest portion of fhe stone. The pieces vary in size, from that: of a nut tothe smallest grains. This stone: lies in a bed stretching about N. 48° E.; and nearly in that direction from | hence, there is on the other side (at 1) a rock of a similar cha- racter, near the east end of the scar, close to the water’s edge ; so that the bed probably extends across the river *.. The ned of the bed.we ‘could not determine. . 72. On the northern bank, a little farther up the stream, (at 2 in the plan) the rocks present characters that are various and complex. From near the same spot, I have. one specimen consisting of quartz, penetrated with talc, chlorite, and carbo nate ' * In the plan, the bearings of the corresponding substances on the southern bank have in every instance been laid down more to the east of north, than is stated in the description. Perhaps, in sketching the channel of the river, it was made too broad, which would account for the error. 330 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES nate of lime or magnesia, and another composed of red felspar, hornblende, and carbonate of lime. The latter is very similar to the red sienite ; but the substances are not so highly crystal- lised, as is commonly the case in the sienite. Within twenty yards, these are succeeded (at 3) by a compound of brown fel- par, quartz, and a small proportion of compact dolomite. The decomposed state of these rocks, and their complex cha- racters, make it difficult to ascertain their ingredients with much precision. The rock last described bears some slight marks of stratification, but the stretch indicated by them is in a direction nearly at right angles to that of the strata on the _opposite side of the river, for it is nearly at right angles to the course of the channel: it must be observed, however, that the planes of these strata, if such they are, are much bent. Far- ther up, on the southern bank, (at 3 in the plan) and in the di- rection of between 43° and 53° E. of N. from this point, there are rocks of substances similar in character to some of: those hereabouts ; and these are in distinct strata, dipping south-east, conformably with the neighbouring strata of limestone. 73. About the place where these strata appear on the north- ern bank, the line of the bank turns to the northward; and from hence to the bridge, a distance of near a hundred yards, there is a straight reach of the river. On both sides of it, the banks are high and steep, and the margin of the water is indented by many projections of the rock. 74. In proceeding towards the bridge about twenty yards along the foot. of the northern bank, the rock is found to va- ry considerably. It is often a mixture of compact felspar and quartz, and sometimes a pure granular quartz, but the fel- spar is generally the predominant substance ; sometimes also it approaches to a gneiss. Specks of pyrites occur among these substances. Their structure is not stratified, and, if they are eaters nc cane «. het IN GLEN TILT. 33F are in beds, the small quantity of the rock, that appears, would hardly discover them to be so. 75. These compound substances are succeeded (at 4 in the plan) by ared sienite, very similar to that at A. Owing to a covering of lichens, which makes every thing obscure, aig a reddish tinge, which pervades the rocks last described as well as the sienite, the one appeared on a first view to pass into the other ; but, on a closer examination, the lines of junction be- tween the sienite and the granular quartz, even where the lat- ter | approaches to a gneiss, were distinctly traced, and veins of the sienite observed to run through the granular quartz. ‘The sienite first shews itself on the southern bank a little far- ‘ther up, (at 4 in the plan) in the direction of N. between 48° ‘and 53° E. from where it first occurs.on the northern. 96. From these points, to the fall above the bridge, a dis- ‘tance of about ‘sixty yards on the southern bank, and between ‘eighty and'ninety on the northern, the prevailing rock is the ‘red sienite; but it is interspersed, especially on the north side’ of the river, with masses of gneiss, granular limestone, horn- -blende-slate, and granular quartz, from the size of a hazel- nut, to that of several feet in every dimension. The strati- ‘fication of these masses is for the most part distinct. Many ef them are imbedded in the sienite; and others are inter-. ‘sected by veins of it, varying in their breadth from a small fraction of an inch to more than a foot. © 77. The appearances throughout these rocks are closely -analogous; but it may be more satisfactory to give a separate description of the most remarkable of them, subjoining at the same time, that in such spots as are not particularly dwelt ‘upon, we observed, no facts materially different from what I -have to state. ivery thing that I have to notice below the bridge is on the north side of the river. ak rf i ftmntr 78, The B32 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES 78. Fifty yards below the bridge, measuring along the north- ern bank, there is a large rock, (at 5) which projects farther ‘into the water than any in its neighbourhood. A little to the ‘west of this, is another rock, containing a mass of limestone imbedded in the sienite. The junction of the two substances takes place without any gradation, or, if there is act itis a very rapid one. 79. The most prominent part of the large projecting rock has its base formed by the main body of the sienite, and its top by several considerable masses of strata, consisting chiefly of hornblende-slate, with some interstratified felspar. These masses appear to rest entirely on the sienite, as the sienite can be traced below all round them. Some of them dip to the north-east, and others at large angles to the south-west. They are intersected by veins of the sienite, several of which were observed to be continuous with the main body of sienite below. One of these, which, though small, was very dis- tinctly traced, is near the top of the rock, on the side to- wards the bank. Three others may be discovered by a close inspection in the steep face of the rock towards the river. The mass of strata intersected by them consists of hornblende, felspar, and quartz, and may perhaps with propriety be called Sienitic Gneiss. One of the veins is from six to eight inches broad, another about four inches, and the third about an inch and a half. The substance of the two larger veins has precise- ly the same characters with the sienite of the continuous main rock beneath them. Where the small vein joins the main bo- dy of the sienite, the substance of the main body, along the edge of the stratified mass, is chiefly felspar, and so is that of the vein for three or four inches ; but above this, the vein is of a sienite similar to the common sienite of the rock below. The stratified masses separated by the larger veins exhibit no remarkable IN GLEN TILT. 388 vemarkable correspondence in their outlines on the opposite sides of these veins; but there is a distinct correspondence in those divided by the small vein. 80. Adjoining to this projecting rock, but nearer to the bank, are several masses of gneiss. Along the lines of junction be- tween the gneiss and the sienite, there is sometimes an appear- ance of gradation, owing toa large proportion of felspar in the gneiss, and an irregular structure in its stratification. We be- lieve there are instances, in which they may be justly said to graduate into each other, but more commonly the line of junc- tion is pretty well defined. 81. Among the rocks immediately to the eastward, we ob- served an imbedded mass, which, from its general aspect, might be considered as a granular limestone, but exhibited in some parts a singular siliceous character, especially near its junc- tion with the sienite, though the line of junction is precise- ly marked. This character consists in a fracture that is rather ‘splintery than foliated, a hardness so considerable as to yield with difficulty to the knife, and a greasy lustre. Yet its de- composed surface shows that it contains carbonate of lime, and it effervesces when pulverised. Its colour is a light greenish- grey. 82. Not far from this, there is a vein of limestone, less than an inch in thickness, running between two masses of sienite, and connected with an imbedded mass of limestone. The im- bedded mass and the vein have similar oryctognostic charac- ters. The fracture approaches more to the foliated, than that of the substance last described, and the hardness is less. The lustre is greasy, and the stone appears to contain a good deal of magnesia, but not a large proportion of silex. _ 83. A part of these rocks (near 6 in the plan) is formed by some large masses of granular quartz, containing numerous Vou. VIL, PIL Uu specks = 334. GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES specks of a reddish felspar, which give their tinge to the whole substance. The coincidence of colour, and that want of a stra- tified structure which is common in granular quartz, made it easily mistaken, on a superficial view, for a gradation from the sienite ; but a more minute examination proved the line of junc-. tion to be well defined. 84. Nearer to the bridge, and from fifteen to twenty yards: below it, the northern bank is formed by a rock, that rises al- most perpendicularly from the edge of the water. This rock consists principally of the red sienite ; but, near the level of the water, there appears in the face of it (at 7 in the plan) a mass of granular quartz, interstratified with hornblende-slate, about ten feet long, and four thick. The stretch of these strata is nearly the same as that of the strata of limestone in the scar lower down on the other side of the river, about N. 33° F. But their dip is at an angle of 47° to the north-west, and there- fore in a direction opposite to that of those strata, and oppo- site to the common dip of the strata on the south side of the valley. They dip immediately into the face of the rock, and, as the sienite may be traced completely round them, they are evidently imbedded in it. These strata are traversed by two veins, composed of quartz and red felspar, in large grains, and not intimately mixed. The veins run almost vertically. They are visible for some feet in the sienite beneath the strata, and under the surface of the water, and one of them is continued in the sienite above the strata. There is a shift in one of these veins. 85. At the bridge the breadth of the river is much contract- ed, and the rocks on both sides rise many feet above it, with precipitous and irregular faces. Those immediately under the bridge, and to the east of it, are free from lichens, and their -surfaces either retain that coarse polish, which they received, when - eae ee 4 ~ ee IN GLEN TILT. 835 when formerly cut through and rounded off by the stream, or have had it occasionally refreshed by the action of the water in time of floods. They are thus well prepared to show the con- trasted colours of the red sienite, and the blackish hornblende- slate, and to render the phenomena attending the junction of these substances extremely distinct. 86. From the east side of the bridge, there may be seen ly- ing under the road that leads to it from the northern bank, a large body of granular limestone, mixed with felspar, and pe- netrated by chlorite, and: often approaching in its characters to a-serpentine. The position of the mass, with respect to its stratification, cannot, I think, be well determined ; but I was inclined to consider its stretch as parallel to that of some stra- ta, which rise, a few feet to the eastward of it, on the other side of an intervening chasm, and the stretch of these is N. 115° E. Veins of the sienite appear in the limestone. A part of the main body of sienite also lies over it, and the plane of their junction dips towards the southern bank. 87. The rock, in which the sienite thus lies over the lime- stone from the south, terminates towards the river (at 8) in a bold projection, affording a distinct section on its top, and on the three sides of its perpendicular face. Its substance is a part of the main body of the sienite, but it contains many im- bedded masses, of various sizes, particularly about its summit. Two of them are of granular quartz, and the lines of junction between these and the sienite are perfectly distinct. In the _rest we observed nothing but hornblende-slate, consisting en- tirely of pure black hornblende, except that it is here and there interstratified with a small quantity of red felspar. The angles of the imbedded masses are always quite sharp, even when the ~ mass does not exceed half an inch in its largest dimension. “In these masses there are numerous veins, of which the sub- en Uu?2 stance 336 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES stance is often quite the same with that of the main body of the sienite, but they also exhibit a variety of gradations trom: it. The crystallised grains are often larger in the veins; in some of them there is a little mica; and sometimes, though rarely, they contain white felspar mixed with the red. ‘there: are small veins of red felspar and hornblende, running parallel to the stratification of the hornblende-slate, and veins of the same sort occasionally traverse the strata. The lines of junc- tion between the veins and the hornblende-slate are generally well defined, and often extremely so; sometimes, however, the substances are blended. I imagine that, by a nice selection of small specimens, a series of gradations might be made out be- tween the hornblende-slate and the sienite ; but in the general: aspect of the two substances, even where in close contact, there is a marked distinction of character. The veins are sometimes reticulated, and display the greatest irregularity in. their outlines and direction. I believe that those parts of the veins, which are near the main body of the sienite, may im almost every instance be traced to be continuous with it. 88. The southern abutment of the bridge rests on a rock, which projects considerably under the arch. The larger part of it is formed of the main body of the sienite, but it contains many masses of hornblende-slate, in which felspar is some- times interstratified. A large one, on the east side of the rock, contains, much felspar, and is penetrated with carbonate of lime. Of the larger masses, some cannot be traced to rest en- tirely upon the sienite ; but others can, and some of the small- er, which dip into the face of the rock, are manifestly imbed- ded in the sienite. There are adjacent masses, in which a cor- respondence of form argues that they were once connected, The position of the masses, with regard to their stratification, — is ‘very irregular; and as instances. of it I may mention, that on the. IN GLEN TILT. 337 the top of the-rock, in an area of about ten feet by eight. there is one having its stretch N, 143° E., and its dip south-west at: an angle of 40°; a second having its stretch N. 36° E., and its dip north-west at an angle of 55°; a third, which appears to hase been once united to the last, stretching N. 13° E., and dipping west at an angle of 58°; and a fourth, stretching: N. 108° E., and dipping north at an angle of 55°.. The obser- vations were taken in an order from the west to the east side of the rock. Of the four masses, the first and last extend to. an unknown depth into the rock below; but the second and: third rest entirely upon the sienite. Veins of sienite and fel- spar, and of gradations. between them, are frequent in most of: the larger masses, and many of them may be traced to be con- tinuous with the main rock of -sienite below. In the small. veins there is generally white felspar intermixed with the red. . As in the rock last described, there are small veins of felspar mixed with hornblende, running sometimes parallel, and some-. times transverse, to the planes of the strata. The veins also re-- semble those in the rock at 8 in their reticulation, in the great irregularities of their direction and outlines, and. in having: | their lines of junction commonly distinct. There is here too» | the same marked difference in the general aspect of the sub- stances of the sienite and the hornblende-slate. Sometimes perhaps the parts in contact are blended, but this is rare.. They are usually bounded by lines that are well defined, and. some of the imbedded pieces are remarkable for the sharp- S of the angles, which they exhibit in the common sec-- tion of them and the sienite, afforded by the surface of the ‘rock. 89. At the bridge, the channel-of the river makes a sharp. to.the eastward. The rocks about the bridge are chiefly. formed of the main body of the sienite ; but, near the fall, this is . succeeded. 338 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES > succeeded by a body of strata, stretching obliquely across the stream, which is cutting its passage through them. They ex- tend about twenty yards along the northern bank, and twenty- five along the southern, and consist for the most part of gneiss, hornblende-slate, and granular limestone. Some of the horn- blende-slate on the north side of the river, is a pure ‘schistose hornblende, similar to that which forms the pieces imbedded in the rock at 8. The average stretch of these strata is about N. 115° E., and their dip to the south-west at an angle so large as 64°; but there are some irregularities from shifts and bend- ings. In the strata of limestone there are many small undu- lations, which are clearly marked on the horizontal surface, by parallel curved ridges of interstratified hornblende and felspar : these harder substances have been left projecting, while the softer limestone has been worn away by the water. Fig. 11, in Plate XIX, shews the curved line of oneof these undulations on the north side of the river. I think that the breadth from « to y may be about a foot. 90. The strata along the northern bank are not much inter- sected by veins of the sienite ; but those along the southern are so in the most striking manner, especially in the neighbour- hood of the main rock of sienite. A blast in the rock on the southern bank procured us specimens of these veins, where they run through some strata of a dark colour, consisting of hornblende, intimately mixed with talc and carbonate of lime, and shewed us that a section of this part of the rock, in any di- rection, would exhibit a complete net-work of them. The spot, where the blast was made, is near 9 in the plan. From hence I traced the veins in an oblique direction towards the bridge, irregularly branching, and again uniting, among the se- parated masses of the strata, to their junction with the main body - a IN GLEN TILT. 339. body of the sienite, which forms the lower part of the perpen- dicular face of rock over the river, a few yards below the fall. In tracing the veins, an interruption, even of a few inches, in their actual substance, was scarcely any where passed over ; and. where any interruption was passed over, it was owing to a fis- sure, or some other circumstance in the surface of the rock, of such a nature as to cause no doubt of a perfect continuity of ’ the substance of the vein in its original structure. I believe that the various and complex ramifications of the veins, be-- tween the spot in which the blast was made, and the main bo- dy of the sienite, would allow the -connexion to be traced in more lines than one.. As the veins approach the main body of the sienite, they grow larger, but contain many masses of the strata imbedded in them. Some of the imbedded masses are of granular limestone. One of these stands nearly vertical, . and has its stretch about north-east ; while the stretch of ano- ther, which is within a foot of it, and also nearly vertical, is at right angles to this. . ° 91. The main body of the sienite appears on the horizontal surface of the rock for some yards to the east of the bridge ; and it has been already mentioned that, where the adhoinitig part of the rock exhibits, on its upper surface, strata intersect- ed by veins of the sienite; the main body of the sienite is to be seen in the lower part of its perpendicular face over the river. These strata, where thus intersected, appear therefore to rest upon the main body of the sienite. ens. Sometimes it is a sienite consisting of felspar, horn- lende, and a considerable proportion: of quartz, and pr ecisely ‘ = The substance of the veins varies much in our speci- we ‘from a rock only eight yards nearer to the bridge. This forms the larger veins ; but some of the smaller contain only felspar and quartz; and felspar occurs here and there alone in the smallest. e . > 840 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES smallest. There is an evident gradation in these ageres gates. 93. In the spot where the blast was made, the veins are so numerous, as to destroy in a great measure the character of stratification in the rock, and in our specimens some of the pieces cut by the veins do not exhibit a stratified structure ; but, about six yards farther to the eastward, there are some di- stinct, and almost undivided, strata, from which we obtained specimens precisely similar, in their oryctognostic characters, to many of the pieces in our specimens of the veins. Among the pieces of strata intersected by these veins, we found also some specimens of serpentine. 94. The lines of junction between the veins and the strata are in general clearly defined, even in some veins of which the breadth does not exceed the sixteenth of an inch, and the angles of the pieces of strata are often sharp. However, there are partial instances of gradation, by an intermixture of sub- stances, along’ the sides of some of the veins ; and, in the small- est of them, the felspar of the vein occasionally assumes the appearance of a streak of red spots, upon the dark ground of the stratified mass. The connexion of such streaks with the compact veins was traced in a number of cases, without any exception. 95. On the south side of the river, the limestone among the more entire strata is intersected by veins of felspar, which are sometimes interrupted, so that pieces of the felspar appear in- sulated in the surface of the rock. Both the veins and pieces of felspar are very irregular in their form and outlines. These appearances of the felspar resemble those of the veins in the limestone strata at B. 96. The strata of gneiss, on the same side, are in some places traversed by thin veins of white calcareous spar. One of these, about IN GLEN TILT. 34H. about half an inch broad, at length meets a thick stratum of grey limestone, in which, after penetrating for an inch or two, it branches out into small tapering veins, and is lost altoge- ther. 97. On the northern bank (at 10) a large vein of white fel- spar crosses a part of the strata. Its thickness varies, but is in some places between one and two feet. 98. In the veins of sienite, or its gradations, throughout the - rocks I have been describing, shifts are not uncommon. 99. Beyond the body of strata last described, the rock on the southern bank is lost beneath the soil for a considerable distance, and on the northern it appears only in some small portions of strata, in’ which we did not observe any thing of importance. ; 100. It will be seen, from the plan of the river, that both the strata and the sienite occur frequently in the intervals be~ tween the spots upon which I have dwelt so long; but there is no other considerable section of the rock, nor are the strata and the’sienite often seen in contact. In every other rock, in which we observed a junction of them, the appearances are: quite analogous to those that have been described. 101. Above the bridge also, for about a mile and a half, and considerably beyond the junction of the Crochie, the rock, where it appears in the bed of the river, consists either of sie- nite, or of granular quartz, gneiss, and other stratified substan- ces, of the same characters with those already mentioned. d ? The strata are occasionally intersected by veins of the red sie-- " ; Ma Vou. VIL P. IL. X x 102. The ie bate |, Wiha ? } 7 ' 4 J 342 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES 102. The preceding details afford grounds for the following. general statement of some of the most important facts. 103. The mountain along the southern side of Glen Tilt consists almost wholly of primary strata; that on the northern is formed chiefly of sienitic greenstone, with gradations into sienite. Through the bottom of the valley the rocks consist partly of stratified substances, and partly oi crystallised aggre- gates, which are commonly sienite, but im one or two places sienitic greenstone. (Paragraphs, 11 to 34, 66.) 104. The great body of strata on the southern side of the valley, forming the base of Ben y Gloe, dips towards the south- east; and some stratified rocks on the southern bank of the ri- ver, which, from their situation and general conformity, appear to be connected with this great body, have main rocks of the sienite lying under them. (Parag. 49, 50, 56.) The sienite may therefore be considered as occupying a position - lower than that of these strata *. is 105. The lines of junction between these stratified rocks and the sienite are in most places distinct. (Parag. 49, 50, 56, 58.) 106. The strata, which occur, with scarcely any visible inter- ruption, through the lower part of the Glen towards Blair, and * Tt must be observed, that the fact of the sienite lying under these primary, or primitive, strata, is inconsistent with the geognosy of Werner, who assigns to sienite a place in his Overlying Primitive Formation, that is, in a class of stra- ta, which, according to him, always rest on the primitive strata, when those of the two classes are found in contact. ee ee ee IN GLEN TILT. B48 along the slope of the mountain on the south side of the val- ley, preserve a considerable degree of uniformity in their stretch and dip, and vary their position slowly by large undu- lations ; on the other hand, some stratified rocks on the south- ern bank of the river, which appear to be connected with this great body of strata, but are adjacent to the main rocks of sie- nite, exhibit great varieties of position within a small distance, and rapid changes in the curvature of their planes. (Pa- rag. 9, and from 19 os 27, compared with 43, 45, 46, 50, 70, 89.) 107. Adjacent to some spots, where the main rocks of sie- nite, and the great body of strata, appear either in contact, or -near to each other, there are numerous masses composed of substances which are stratified, and closely resemble those that form the great body. These masses do not touch each other at the present surface, and sections of the rocks in every direc- tion prove that many of them must be completely separate. The smallest of these masses are not larger than a hazel-nut ; the larger would measure several feet every way. From the numerous sections of these masses, afforded by the indented and water-worn surfaces of the rocks, we farther learn, that the eoneealed surfaces of the masses are rough; that their shapes are irregular, and that they often terminate in sharp angles. In position, as to stretch and dip, they often differ extremely from the great body of strata, as well as from each other; and this difference prevails even among such as lie nearest toge- ther, (Parag. from 51 to 53, 76, from 78 to 81, 84, 87, 88, 90.) 108. Some of these masses rest upon the main rocks of sie- nite. (Parag. 52, 53,79, 87, 88, 91.) 109. The intervals between such of these masses as appear adjacent on the present surface, vary in breadth, from the small ox 2 fraction B44 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES fraction of an inch, to many feet. The intervals exhibit great diversity and irregularity in their forms; but an ap- proach to parallelism between the surfaces of the masses, that lie nearest together, often gives to the interval the form of a vein. In all the various sections of the rock formed by the present surface, the intervals, whether above, below, or on the sides of the masses, appear, with few exceptions, to be completely filled, either with a sienite similar to that of the main rocks, or with felspar, either pure, or mixed with other substances, so as to present evident gradations from that sie- nite. (Parag. from 51 to 54, from 58 to 60, 76, from 78 to 81, 84, 87, 88, 90, 92.) 110. This appearance of separate masses of strata, with the intervals filled with sienite, was observed only where the great body of strata, and the main rocks of sienite, were each of them at no great distance. (Parag. 3, 6, 7, 21, 22, from 24 to 98.) One or two exceptions, however, occurred farther up the Glen *. # 111. In several instances, the sienite and its gradations, which appear, in the form of veins, among the stratified masses resting upon the main rocks of sienite, were observed to join to the main rocks of sienite, without any abrupt change of cha- racter between the substance of the vein, and that of the main rock below. (Parag. 52, 53, 79, 87, 88, 90.) 112. The lines of junction between the stratified masses, and the sienite, or its gradations, are in most cases definitely mark- ed. (Parag. 50, 53, 59, 60, 75, from 78 to 81, 83, 87, 88, 90, * See the latter part of parag. 135, and note D at the end of the paper. IN GLEN TILT. 345 90, 94.) The principal exceptions are, where the strata are of gneiss, or of granular limestone *. 113. Shifts occur in the veins of sienite, and its gradations. (Parag. 62, 84, 98.) rE OO 114. These appearances afford grounds for some inferences respecting what took place in the formation of these rocks. 115. A crystalline character in a rock is generally admitted to proye, that it was once in a state to a certain degree fluid. An opposite notion has indeed been advanced by Dotomiev, and Mr. Grecory Wart; but, both the mineralogical appear- ances, which suggested this opinion to Dotomigv, and the ex- perimental results, which led Mr. Warr to it, admit of an easy explanation, from what Sir James Haut ascertained by experiment, with regard to the varieties of structure produced by cooling under different circumstances; and no sound ar- gument against the common opinion can be drawn from what either of them has described. We may therefore in- fer, that the main rocks of sienite have been in a state to a certain degree fluid; whether by aqueous solution, or igneous fusion, 1 do not now consider. We may make a similar inference for the sienite, and the gradations from it, which now occupy the intervals between the separate masses of the strata, often assuming the form of veins. I would farther infer, that the fluid from which the main rocks of sienite crystallised, and the fluid from which the veins of sienite, or its gradations, crystallised, were one and the ; same 5 _* The least real gradation may in appearance be a considerable one, where the surface of the rock cuts the plane of the junction at a small angle. This is a source of deception to be guarded against in observation. 346 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES same; and that so far the main rocks and the veins are of the same formation, or have a common origin. This infer- ence will probably be disputed by some, and I shall therefore offer a few remarks in support of it. 116. All would admit, that every part of one of the main rocks of sienite in the bed of the Tilt was of the same forma- tion. As in any other case of a rock of a crystallised aggre- gate, such as granite, greenstone, &c. the continuity of the mass, and its uniform, or gently varied, characters, are the grounds for the inference. It is the most simple hypothesis, and the rule that “ No more causes are to be admitted than “ are sufficient to account for the phenomena,” authorises us to conclude in favour of one productive process, where no rea- sons can be shown for inferring more than one. We have seen, however, that among the veins there are some con- sisting of a sienite precisely similar in its characters to that of the main rocks; and that some such veins are con- nected with the main rocks, without any abrupt transition. Now, where both these circumstances occur in the vein, the vein and the main rock are parts of one continuous and ho- mogeneous mass ; and every reason for admitting that any two parts of the main rock are of one formation, goes equally to prove that the main rock and the vein are of one formation, except in what regards the difference of form in the vein. But this difference affords no just ground of distinction. In several places, especially about the bridge, there are separate masses of the strata imbedded in the sienite. When ‘such masses lie far asunder, the sienite between them is regarded as a part of the main rock: if we look out for such as have still smaller and smaller intervals between them, we shall by and by find the intervening sienite to obtain the form, and the name of a vein; and the sooner, according as we select larger masses IN GLEN TILT. ; 347 masses of the strata, and such as have their adjacent sides more nearly parallel. The gradation thus pointed out removes any objection from the extreme case of difference in the form of the vein, where the vein is in substance precisely similar to the main rock, and visibly continuous without any abrupt tran- sition. . . 117. In the next place, we have the evidence of close analo- gy, for extending the inference of a common origin to those veins in the neighbourhood of the main rocks, which consist of a sienite similar to that of the main rocks, but between which and the main rocks no connection can be traced on the pre- sent surface. These veins are in substance similar to the for- mer, and they intersect similar strata in a similar manner. Their proximity to the main rocks therefore argues that they either are, or have been, connected with the main rocks, though that connection does not now appear. 118. With respect to all the veins which consist of a sienite stead to that in the main rocks, an argument may be derived from stating the question in a aitdinins between a common origin and a different one ; and the probability of the former must be proportionate to the improbability of the latter. Now a sienite of these precise characters is by no means common, either among minerals in general, or among those of the adja- cent district ; and it must appear highly improbable, that two separate processes should have agreed in producing it, with such perfect similarity of substance, in these contiguous spots, and there only. . 119. Among the hypotheses, by which a separate formation ie! been ascribed to veins analogous i in character, and situa- tion, to those in Glen Tilt, is that of a cotemporaneous forma- tion by secretion from the strata, while yet in a soft state. Should this hypothesis be applied to those veins of sienite in Glen Tilt, which are of a substance precisely similar to that of the 348 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES the main rocks, it may be opposed with peculiar force by the last argument. The formation of the main rocks of sienite: cannot be explained by secretion; and the improbability that two. separate. processes should have agreed in producing in: contiguous spots a substance so rare elsewhere, as this sienite, is materially increased, when those two processes are supposed: to have differed in. kind. 120.. From the veins, which consist of a sienite similar to that of the main rocks, it is easy to extend the argument to al- most all those veins, which: consist of various aggregates of fel- spar and quartz, or felspar and hornblende, with a little mica. in one or two places, and those whieh contain felspar only. These present a great diversity in their ingredients, and in the size of the grains; but their continuity with the veins of sie- nite, and the gradation of the substances composing them into: the sienite, were traced in many instances, even where the veins were most minute and obscure, and their ramifications most complex. These circumstances furnish sufficient grounds: for referring their origin to the same fluid mass. Above the bridge, where the specimens were procured by a blast, we found many of the most minute and complex veins of this kind to graduate into veins of sienite, which again were joined to the main rock of sienite, and grew larger as they approach- ed it; while we observed that in a stratified rock, of precisely similar characters, a little farther to the eastward, there were no such veins, or scarcely any. (Parag. 90, 93.) This, while it seems to exclude every explanation of those veins from. circumstances, attending the formation of the strata, points strongly: to the once fluid substance of the main rock of sienite for their undoubted. origin *.. ‘i 121, We % Sée note, B at the end-of the-paper. IN GLEN TILT. - B49 121. We may likewise recur to the argument, that veins of these substances appear rarely in the strata of the adjacent country, where no main rock of a crystallised aggregate is near. 122. It may farther be remarked, that the substance of the main rocks of sienite is not quite uniform in its characters, for in them the proportion of hornblende and quartz varies a good deal, and is in some places small. A main rock at B was mentioned, (parag. 58.) which, where in contact with strata of compact dolomite with other ingredients, consists sometimes of felspar only, for two or three inches from the line of junction. A similar fact occurs at D. (Parag. 79.) While, however, we admit, that the substances thus graduating into one avatiiee were formed by crystallisation from the same fluid, the simi- larity in the other circumstances of these veins forces us to conclude, that some very trifling difference of cause was suffi- cient to determine, whether hornblende and quartz should en- ter into the composition of the vein, and in what proportions. 123. It must at the same time be allowed, that there are cer- tain veins of similar substances among these strata, of which it may be doubted if they have been formed from the same fluid mass with the main rocks of sienite; such especially are the large vein of white felspar on the east side of the bridge, and the veins of red felspar with quartz, intersecting a rock of sie- nite, and an imbedded mass of strata, at the foot of the north- ern bank, below the bridge. 124, The similarity of the stratified substances, lying in se- parate masses among the sienite, to those which compose the - base of Ben y Gloe, and occupy a wide district to the south and west, leaves no room for doubting that both are of the same formation. But if this be admitted, and likewise the common origin of the sienite in the main rocks, and in the Vot. VII. jet II. Yy veins, 350° GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES veins, the intermixture of the stratified masses with the sienite remains to be accounted for, and the case seems to admit of only two hypotheses. One is, That after the sienite had assu- med its present form, the stratified substances were deposited in the cavities of its surface. But the forms of these supposed cavities,—the absence of crystals on their sides, as now exhibited in the lines of junction,—the structure also of the veins, divid- ing upon the sharp angles of the interjacent masses, branching with every. variety of size and direction, and crossing each other among the stratified masses,—all these circumstances make it difficult to imagine, that the sienite would have receiy- ed its present appearance, if at perfect liberty to assume that which crystallisation tended to give; and the diversities in position among the stratified masses, relatively both to the sie- nite and to one another, furnish the strongest objections to the idea that these positions were original. . This hypothesis there- fore, though it has been adopted by some to explain analogous appearances elsewhere, may be rejected without hesitation. The hypothesis which remains, is, That the masses of gneiss, limestone, &c. are portions of strata once continuous, and ly- ing conformably with those which form the base of Ben y Gloe; that these strata were bent and broken by some violent shock; and that the fluid, from which the sienite crystallised, was in- troduced among the fragments. 125. Admitting this as the most probable, the nature of that fluid comes immediately into question. It may be supposed to have been some unknown aqueous fluid, which held the substance of the sienite in solution, and deposited it by crystallisation. To account for the various positions of the fragments, and the height at which they are now found resting upon the main rocks of sienite, it may be supposed, that the fragments fell at various times from the sides of a chasm, in which the deposi- tion. IN GLEN TILY. 351 tion of the sienite was going on. But an objection to any idea of a crystalline deposition from. an aqueous fluid, arises from the compactness of the rocks consisting of stratified mas- ses intersected by the sienite. This circumstance has been ur- ged by Mr Prayrarr, as an objection to the aqueous origin of granite rocks * ; and the argument may be applied with greater force to the veins of sienite in Glen Tilt. Had an aqueous solvent deposited this substance among fragments, in some places so confusedly heaped, in others so closely fitted, toge- ther, we might have expected to have found occasionally what - so frequently occurs in a calc-tuf, a porous structure, and ca- vities, perhaps lined with crystals. On the contrary, in all these veins, however complex and minute, scarcely a single in- terstice appears unfilled. 126. It is to heat then that we may with more probability ascribe the fluidity of the sienite. This hypothesis is farther supported by the affinity of sienite to trap, or whinstone ; and, in proportion to that affinity, we may extend to sienite the in-- ference of an igneous origin, which, with respect to trap, seems established by so many convincing arguments. The crystallis- ed aggregates of Glen Tilt afford excellent examples of gradations between these substances, and the first. steps of the series from trap may be traced in the sienitic green- stones of the northern side of the valley; some of which very nearly resemble the most highly crystallised specimens of common greenstone from Salisbury Craigs. The sie- nite in the bed of the river may be considered again as a step in a continuation of the series to granite +. But, though these Yy2 gradations _ * See Huttonian Theory, art. 81. a + This series of gradations, in composition as well as structure, between trap and granite, does not appear to have been duly noticed ; and I would parti- _ ularly recommend it to the attention of those geologists, who, while they admit the 352 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES gradations afford a presumption in favour of the igneous origin of all granitic substances, that presumption must always dimi- nish, as the affinity of the substance grows. more remote; and we have yet to wait for proofs, as strong as those which the valuable experiments of Sir James Hau have furnished for trap, to be drawn from direct experiments, in the same way, upon sienite and granite. 127. Even admitting the sienite to have been introduced in a state of fluidity from heat, it is still difficult to account for its having completely filled up every interstice among the frag- ments; and it seems necessary to infer, that it flowed with a strong impulse, while at the same time a pressure of superin- cumbent matter, confining the adjacent bodies, opposed its in- troduction. Indeed, if the sienite be inferred to have been fluid from heat, compression must be admitted to have modi- fied the action of that heat, since the carbonate of lime in the sienite appears to have suffered no decomposition. If we ascribe the fracture of the strata, the disorder in which the fragments now lie among the sienite, and the wide separation of some of them, to the force of the impelled fluid, we shalt adopt a simple, and connected, explanation of the phenomena. In favour of this it may be further urged, that the fracture and dislocation of the strata are confined to the neighbourhood. of the sienite, while those at a distance are comparatively un- disturbed. 128. Even close to the junctions, the large masses of strata on the southern bank, similar in their component substances ; PS to. the igneous origin of trap, cannot bear the idea of violating by any such hypo- thesis the dignity of a rock, which has been so long venerated as the first founda- tion of the earth. The specimens, required to exhibit the whole series, would not be numerous, though the shades of difference, in every step, were slight. Perhaps our island does not afford a better field for illustrating the subject than Glen Tilt, and the mountains to the north-west of it. IN GLEN TILT. 353 to those among the sienite, but more nearly conforming in their position to that of the stratified base of Ben y Gloe, do not contain veins of sienite, or its gradations; (parag. 40, 43, 50, 56, 70.) and this fact, while it goes to exclude the idea of secretion, or any other tranquil process, attending the forma- tion of the strata, as the source of the veins, argues that the force, which disturbed the strata, was one which impelled the fluid against, and among, them. 129. Some of the main rocks of sienite were observed to lie underneath large masses of strata, which are comparatively un- disturbed, exhibit no veins of sienite, and are probably con- nected with the great body to the south. This circumstance favours the inference, that the direction of the impelled fluid was either lateral, or from below.—That the direction of the impulse was in some degree from below, may be inferred from another circumstance. On the top of some of the rocks of sienite, near the bridge, there are imbedded masses. of horn- blende-slate:. Among these rocks, that referred’ to in the plan by the figure 8 is one which exhibits such masses with ‘peculiar distinctness ; and, in its perpendicular face, the sienite of the main rock is seen to the depth of several feet below them. The sienite of this rock was found to have its specific “gravity 2.67; and of two masses of hornblende-slate resting upon it, one has the specific gravity of 3.00, the other that of 3.01. Hence it appears, that the specific gravity of the horn- blende-slate i is to that of the sienite, as 100 to 89. Now the ‘specific gravity of the sienite, when fluid, whatever may have been the cause of its. fluidity, was probably less than it is at present, and supposing it to have been somewhat greater, it must have been considerably less than that of the hornblende- slate : it can hardly therefore be imagined, that, if the fluid sienite came from above among the fragments, it would have buoyed 354 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES ‘buoyed them up, and raised them to their actual position *. Nor can’ this be explained even by supposing, that these mas- ses of hornblende-slate were attached to others of gneiss, and limestone; for, while the heaviest specimen of sienite has the specific gravity of 2.67, the lightest of two specimens of gneiss was found to have that of 2.68, and the lightest of three speci- mens of limestone that of 2.70. A fluid impelled from below, though of a less specific gravity, might raise them; and that they should have remained suspended till the sienite crystallis- ed round them, may be accounted for by the supposition, that the sienite was in that state of viscid fluidity, which earthy bodies, when melted, are known to assume at a temperature not far above their point of crystallisation ; joined to the consi- deration, that the difference of specific gravity could not be great. 130. Any theory ascribing the origin of the sienite to an in- troduced fluid, of whatsoever kind, would lead us to account for the gradations, which in some places appear upon the lines of junction, by supposing that the stratified masses were acted upon by the fluid, so as to admit of their being penetrated by it, or at least by some of its ingredients. After having ascrib- ed the fluidity of the sienite to heat, it is obvious to refer the mutual action of the substances to the same agent, and to sup- pose that it softened the strata, so as to enable certain ingredi- ents of the fluid to penetrate them to a small depth. Some instances of gradation, where carbonate of lime is one of the substances, * The large projecting rock below the bridge furnishes a similar argument. The specific gravity of one specimen of hornblende-slate, from the top of this rock, was found to be 2.95, that of another 2.97: the specific gravity of its sie- ‘nite was not tried, but the mean specific gravity of two specimens of sienite from D is 2.66. IN GLEN TILT. 355 substances, agree very well with an igneous theory. Sir Jamzs Hatz found carbonate of lime, when fused under compression, to be a powerful solvent of silex. This offers an explana- tion of the gradation on the sides of the veins of felspar in the strata of limestone at B, and of some similar ap- pearances at D, (parag. 95.) ; also of the siliceous character in the mass of limestone adjacent to the sienite at D, below. the bridge, (Parag. 81.). In these cases, it may be supposed. that the carbonate of lime, when fused by heat, derived a portion of silex from the felspar in contact. ‘The siliceous character of _ the vein of granular limestone, or compact dolomite, at C, may be accounted for in the same manner. On the other hand, it may be supposed.that the sienite of the main rocks derived its small portion of carbonate of lime by solution from the ad- jacent strata». But;.whether we adopt an igneous theory, or - any other, there are facts that it will appear difficult to ex- plain ; for we have seen that there are masses of hornblende- slate, and other substances, which, though penetrated by the felspar of the sienite, have still preserved a stratified texture, and the sharpness of their angles; and it is not easy to con- ceive a state of aggregation soft, or porous, enough for the for- mer circumstance, and at the same time firm enough for the latter, or what agent could have produced it*. I have heard rate rhe Six - * A remarkable example of fragments’ of a rock penetrated by an extraneous substance is mentioned by M. Davusutsson, as having fallen under his own obser- vation. In a note to § 72. of his translation of Werner’s Theory of Veins, he tells us, that near Freyberg a metalliferous vein was found divided into several small veins, containing between them fragments of gneiss, th ‘rough which gale.’ _ na was disseminated in ‘so large a quantity, that the quintal of gneiss contained! thirty pounds of lead» He adds, as something more remarkable, that it was, only the gneiss of the vein, which contained galena; for the gneiss of the rock, . even where adjacent to the vein, contained none at all. - 356 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES Sir James Hatt mention the aggregation of curd and jelly, as an analogy to obviate similar difficulties. Perhaps the pene- tration of a fragment still retaining its shape may in some cases have been effected, by one more soluble component having been withdrawn by the action of a fluid in contact, and having thus left the pores it occupied to be filled with a new substance, derived from the fluid. It is clear, however, that where there is gradation on the lines of junction, it has been owing in some cases to a trifling difference of circumstance ; for, among the specimens procured by a blast at D, the lines of junction are precisely marked in some, while in others the red_ felspar appears disseminated through the same blackish strati- fied compound for an inch, or more, from the side of the vein. 131. An igneous theory for the sienite might lead us also to ascribe the high state of crystallisation, in some of the stratifi- ed masses, to a slow reconsolidation after having been soften- ed by the heat. Sir James Harx’s experiments upon. the fu- sion of carbonate of lime under compression, make it more easy to admit this hypothesis with respect to the limestone, than in the case of the gneiss, and some other substances. The important information respecting the properties of carbo- nate of lime, which we have derived from Sir James Harx’s experiments, may assist us in explaining some other appear- ances in these rocks. Thus we may conceive that the vein of limestone proceeding from an imbedded mass, (par. 82.) was produced from a part of the mass which had been completely melted, and remained so, after the sienite had grown so hard as to admit of a crevice being formed. A similar origin may be ascribed to the vein of hard granular limestone at C, (par. 60.). The veins of calcareous spar, cutting strata of gneiss, (par. 96.) may have been formed, either from fused por- tions Fate] IN GLEN TILT. 83% tions of the adjacent limestone, introduced into crevices in the gneiss, or by secretion from the strata themselves, in which carbonate of lime is frequently an ingredient, and limestone an interstratified substance. Sir James Hau observed that carbonate of lime, when fused under compression, is a viscid substance. In some limestone strata not far from the sienite, on the eastern side of the bridge, (par. 89.) there are rapid in- curvations, without fracture, which strongly suggest the idea of a viscid state in the rock, at the time of their formation. _ 132. It has been mentioned, that there are shifts in some of the veins *. Whatever theory be adopted respecting the man- ner in which the sienite, and the stratified masses, assumed their present relative position ; the shifts prove that, after they had done so, there was a dislocation among these rocks, in which the stratified masses, and the sienite between them, were moved together. But the fact that these rocks are now com- pact, and without cavities, can hardly be reconciled with the idea of such dislocation ; unless by admitting that, when it took place, a certain degree of softness pervaded their whole sub- stance, both the strata, and the sienite. It accords with an ig- neous theory to explain these circumstances by supposing, that* the dislocation occurred not long after the introduction of the sienite, while the heat continued sufficient to maintain a softness whole. But the difficulty of conceiving such a soft- Vou. VIL P. Il. ~ “2g ness * In a rock near the bridge, there was noticed (par. 84.) a shift in one ef two veins, which are apparently of posterior formation to the sienite. It may _ be worth while to observe, that these veins dividing both the sienite, and the imbedded mass of strata, can hardly be ascribed to secretion ; for it is highly improbable, that the strata, which are of granular quartz and hornblende-slate, should have agreed with the sienite in secreting the same substance; nor is it likely, that a secretion from the one, should have filled that part of the crevice, which had been formed in the other. 358 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES: ness in all these substances recurs upon us; and the advocates of an igneous theory cannot pretend to furnish a satisfactory explanation of these, as. well as many other more common phenomena of a primary country, till they have acquired a far- ther knowledge of the properties of bodies composed of fel spar, quartz, hornblende, carbonate of lime, mica, &c. when subjected to high temperatures, and regulated cooling,—with. compression also, where there is any volatile ingredient. It is to an igneous theory, however, that we may look with the most confident hope, and it seems in vain to expect as- sistance from any hypothesis of aqueous solution and ries sition. 133. The various inferences, for which I have been seria ing, have been separately considered, both for the sake of keep- ing the argument distinct, and because I conceive the evidence. to be much stronger in favour of some, than of others. The: whole hypothesis may be briefly expressed thus: That the sie- nite, in a state of igneous fusion, was impelled from below, by a violent force, against the strata; that it bent them, broke _ them, dispersed them, and filled up the intervals, which it now éccupies ; that the fragments of the strata were in some degree: softened by the heated sienite, so as to admit of a inathaly ac- ‘tion; that, while the whole intermixed mass was still soft, some farther dislocation took place in it, and that all this oc- curred under a great confining pressure of incumbent matter. This hypothesis coincides, in the main, with that by which Dr Horton explained the phenomena in Glen Tilt, in a paper read before this Society in the year 1790, and published in its. Transactions. If it differs widely from the speculative views concerning these phenomena, which have been more recently given by ners Jameson and Dr Macxnicut, I must leave it to the candid inquirer to decide between us ; , if I have diftered: IN GLEN TILT. 859 differed also in my description of the facts, Professor J amEson’s extensive experience, and acuteness in the discrimination of minerals, might seem to claim submission on my part; did I not consider that his observations must have been liable to a certain degree of bias from a favourite theory,—a bias, from which I can scarcely flatter myself that my own were kept en- tirely free *. 134. I proceed now to describe the rocks in the bed of the Tilt, as far as the junction of the Tarff, and shall subjoin some observations on the mountains to the north-west of the Glen. : 185. For about a mile below the junction of the Chlochan, the channel of the Tilt is perfectly straight, and the bottom of the Glen is contracted to its breadth. The channel is here formed on both sides by rocks of a singular aggregate, ap- proaching in its characters to sienitic greenstone. The colour of the mass is a dark greenish-grey, but varying according to the proportion of its ingredients, which are intimately mixed, and seem to be hornblende, felspar, sometimes compact, and sometimes allised, steatite or chlorite, and a good deal of carbonate of lime, or magnesia, perhaps both. The presence of these last ingredients is inferred from its effervescing brisk- ly with muriatic acid. It may not be improper to consider the mass as a compound of hornblende, felspar, and compact dolomite, with a little chlorite, or steatite. Its hardness is not great, but it is very tough under the hammer. It is neither » Zz 2 stratified, —_? 7” a ws 360 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES: stratified, nor in beds. Sometimes it presents an appearance of veins, a few inches in breadth, and consisting of a brown- ish-red compact felspar, hornblende in large distinct grains, with a curved foliated fracture, and a little quartz. These veins, if they deserve that name, differ from those of the red sienite already described, in the irregularity of their outlines, and in a slow gradation on their sides into the contiguous mass. In the bed of the Tilt, not far from where it receives the Crochie, there is a rock of a similar character as to its consti- tuents, which is in some places cut by veins of the red sienite, and the lines of junction are there precisely marked. 136. On the east side of the foot of the fall of the Crochie, and nearly on a level with the grey sienite, or sienitic greenstone on the opposite bank, (par. 29.) the rock is of a character similar .to that last described, though its structure approaches to slaty: It effervesces slightly sii muriatic acid, and seems. to be a compact dolomite, penetrated by tale and chlorite. I is pro- bable that a great part of the base of the mountain, between the Crochie and the head of the Glen, consists of similar agere- gates ; for a cut made by a brook farther up, shewed the rocks, to the height of two, or three hundred feet, to have a strong re- semblance to those that form the channel of the Tilt*. I consider all these congenerous rocks as belonging to the pri- mary strata. In their constituents they resemble some of the compounds that I enumerated in the general sketch of the stra- ta through the a: ; and one of them, which has been men- tioned as, occurring in, the bed of the Tilt, not far from the junction: * Some of these substances bear a considerable resemblance to those which, appear on the Malvern Hills, in the cut made by the road to Ledbury. The latter are in a state of decomposition, which makes it difficult to discern their in; gredients, ¥e & IN GLEN TILT . . 861 junction of the Crochie, and as cut by veins of the red sienite, has in some parts a stratified structure. Their imperfect cry- stallisation, the small proportion of the felspar, and their brisker effervescence with acids, are the characters which dis- tinguish them from the sienitic greenstones, that form so con- siderable a part of the riesttiiesre bank of the valley. Along the foot of this bank, between the Crochie and the junction of the Clochan, angular blocks of sienitic greenstone, with similar varieties, still occur at intervals in great numbers, and shew that the higher parts of the ridge contain a large quantity of. this substance. 137. On the south side of the long straight reach of the ri-- ver, granular limestone appears in two or three places. Near the lower end, there are some beds of it extending about sixty yards close upon the edge of the water, in a face of rock that is nearly vertical, and a few feet in height. The lines, that mark the stratification of the beds, run horizontally in the face of the rock; but at each end the beds are curved upwards in a remarkable manner, so that at the eastern, the lines of stratifi- cation make an angle of between 30° and 40° with the hori-. zon, aid at the western, an angle of from 40° to 50°. At the. west end, the rock immediately in contact with the limestone: is concealed, but the dark-grey aggregate appears s within a few: yards of it on the brink of the river. irae the east end, ‘this ag-- gregate lies’ Peasatiancly under the curved extremities of the» beds of limestone. See Fig. rv, in Plate Xe me 138. On the same aii) not a hundred and fifty yards be-: low the junction of the Chlochan, and’ within fifty feet above: the river, there are beds of limestone, dipping, as usual, into: the face of the declivity, but perhaps rather more to the east~- ward., BS = tie: te © 139. At: 362 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES 139. At the junction of the Chlochan, the channel of the Tilt turns ata large angle to the northward, and preserves nearly the same iecabias to the junction of the Tarff, a distance of about half a mile. The Tarff flows from the west, and, imme- diately before it joins the Tilt, issues from a deep chasm form- ed by precipices on either side of the channel, which, near the outlet, is broken by two considerable falls. This spot is called Pull Tarff. Between the junction of the Chlochan and Pull Tarff, there appear at intervals various stratified rocks, consist- ing of granular limestone, mica-slate, the dark-grey aggregate, and granular quartz. Out of five positions observed with the clinometer, if we omit one that appeared to be owing to a con- volution, the rest argue that these strata lie round, and lean against, the base of the mountain, which separates the valleys of the Tarff and the Tilt. Four observations gave successively N. 150° E., 128° E., 133° E., and 101° E.; while the dip was getting round by the east to the north *. Our observations in this quarter terminated at Pull Tarff. Dr Hurron mentions f, that to the eastward of this, near Falar, he found both granite and primary strata between Glen More and Glen Beg, In fol- lowing up the course of the Tarff to the westward, he observed that the strata disclosed by that river, while they stretched about east and west, dipped to the northward. In Glen Tarff he met with many tumbled stones, which he describes as - “ composed of broken schistus, including white granite,” by which he of course means fragments of cae strata, inter- sected by veins of white granite. He also ascended to the summit of the ridge that separates the Tarff from the Tilt, where he found almost every thing to be granite, and but little of the primary strata. 140. The * See note D. * + In the manuscript, of which some account is given in note C. IN GLEN TILT: . 363 140. The extent of the granite, and other crystallised agere- gates on this side of Glen Tilt, was farther confirmed by our observations on the mountains more to the south, about Glen Criny and Glen Merk. These mountains do not shew mucli of the fixed rock, and we were therefore left in most cases to infer the materials of which they consist, from the loose blocks that are scattered on their sides, and along the higher parts of. the courses of the streams. In order ‘to make the account as faithful as possible, I shall enumerate the substances that we met with, in the different lines of our walks, beginning with what lies nearest to Forest Lodge. 143. For a considerable distance from the Griurnon towards. Cairn y Chlannan, along the broad ridge that joins them, I * found fragments of granular quartz, and a few of granite. The- summit of Cairn y Chlannan is granular quartz. To the south-- west of it, the ground falls into the head of Glen Criny, which opens into Glen Tilt.. 142. In ascending frony the lower part of Glen Criny to-- wards the Gener but winding to the north, so as to gain the ridge that joins it to Cairn y Chlannan, I saw loose blocks. of granular quartz, and sienitic greenstone graduating into grey sienite. This sienitic greenstone, and its gradations, resemble - those so abundant on the northern side of Glen Tilt, nd im: the following pages the terms always denote similar substances. . Through the lower part of Glen Criny, the stream runs with a very rapid fall, for between one and two miles, over red gra- © nite; which, as far as I could judge from where the observa- tion was made, extends to a point within two or three hundred feet in perpendicular height, and perhaps a furlong in horizontal distance, from the granular quartz that appears at the bridge over the Criny in Glen Tilt. We regret that we had no opportunity of examining the junctionyof the strata and the granite, in the channel. 364 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES channel of the Criny. Dr Hurrown relates, that he with some difficulty climbed up the precipitous bed of a rivulet, which comes from the mountain on’ the north side of Glen Tilt, and which, from his description, I can only conceive to have been the Criny. He there obtained a view of a section of the rock. “ We first,” he says, “ found the alpine schistus inclined as on “ the south side, and heading, or rising up, to this north hill; immediately after which, we found the granite under the al- pine schistus, seemingly bedded in like manner, and run- ning parallel to the alpine strata.” It did not strike me that the granite in Glen Criny was in parallel beds; though I own that my examination was hasty, and I had only a distate view of the lowest part of the Glen. 143. In following up the course of the Criny, many blocks of grey sienite, or rather sienitic greenstone, are seen, and many also of granular quartz. The granular quartz on Cairn y Chlannan AS in Glen Criny, contains almost always either specks of felspar, or minute cavities similar to those already mentioned in the granular quartz of the Griurnon. Round the head of the Glen, the blocks of sienitic greenstone lie in great numbers, both on the side of ‘Cairn y Chiannan to the east, and on that of Cairn Vardenoch to the west. 144. I ascended Cairn Vardenoch from the lower part of Glen Criny, and kept along the broad ridge of it, winding round to the westward, till I mearly reached that part which overlooks Glen Merk ; and returning by a different track, on ‘the west side of the same ridge, crossed over it, and came - down into Glen Criny at a point higher up. In the whole of this walk, except on that part of the ridge which lies towards Glen Merk, I met with scarcely any thing but a small-grained granite, having its felspar red. It appears in loose blocks, “ the “ “c « IN GLEN TILT. 365 the soil is formed of the decomposed ingredients. On that part of the ridge which lies towards Glen Merk, the loose stones are partly mica-slate, and partly grey porphyry.—On Cairn y Chlannan and Cairn Vardenoch, there occurred also a very few loose fragments of gneiss. 145. Glen Merk merits more attention, as it exhibits a junc- _ tion between the strata and the granite. The name of Glen Merk is confined to a part of the valley along that stream, ex- tending about two miles above its opening into Glen Tilt. At some distance from the opening, the Merk receives the Deery from the west ; and, above this, the Glen has the direction of due north, being formed on the east by the declivity of Caim Vardenoch, and on the west by that of Ben y Venny. The head of the Glen is closed in by a rocky steep, about three hundred feet high, connecting the two mountains, but deeply cut by the stream, which falls through the dark chasms of a narrow channel. . 146. At the falls of the Merk, where the Glen opens into Glen Tilt, there are strata of mica-slate, stretching N. 48° E., and dipping to the south at an angle of 27°. They agree ene. fore with the general position of the strata through the adjoin- ing part of Glen Tilt. In following up the side of the Merk, .to where it receives the Deery, the channel affords a transverse section of the strata. They seem to be either mica-slate, or - gneiss ; and, as far as could be judged from a distance, they conform in stretch and dip with those at the falls. 147. Before I proceed up the channel of the river, I shall mention what we noticed respecting the mountains on each side. Along the declivity of Cairn Vardenoch, at the distance of more than a mile from the head of Glen Merk, the loose fragments shew the higher part of the mountain to consist ei- ther of gneiss, or of a granite, nearly the same in character Vou. VII. P. IL. 3A with 366 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES with that which occurred so abundantly upon it towards Glen Criny. Farther up, the fragments are chiefly of gneiss; and near the head of the Glen, they are either gneiss, or sienitic greenstone, with its gradations.—On the side of Ben y Venny, near the head of the Glen, we met with. sienitic greenstone in the fixed rock, and the loose blocks. that had fallen‘ from this mountain were either gneiss, or sienitic greenstone; the latter afforded gradations into grey sienite, for quartz occurred in it frequently. Some of the blocks consisted of felspar, horn- blende, ‘and mica.—In ascending the steep at the head of the Glen, on the western side of the stream, we found. the rocks, that projected in different places from the surface, to be alter- nately gneiss, and sienitic greenstone, but could not determine their relative positions. . 148. I now resume the description of the bed of the river. On the eastern side of the Merk, a furlong above its | junction with the Deery, the strata are of gneiss, stretching N. 85° E., with a southerly dip at an angle of 22°. Fifty yards farther up, the gneiss stretches N. 105° E., and dips to the south at an angle some degrees larger. An hundred and fifty yards far- ther, there is gneiss interstratified with beds of felspar porphy- ry; the stretch is here N. 46° E. and the dip southerly at an angle of 28°. Three hundred yards higher up the stream, the strata are again gneiss, stretching N. 63° E., and dipping south- erly at an angle of 27°. There are here some appearances of bendings in the strata. We saw nothing but gneiss, with its dip southerly, in the fixed rocks, till we came within a quarter of a mile, or somewhat more, of the head of the Glen; when we met with a junction of gneiss and granite, close to the east- ern side of the streani. The strata of gneiss are much disor- dered ; and are cut by veins,—some of granite, that is to say, a compound of felspar, quartz, and mica, and some of felspar and mica, IN GLEN TILT. , 367 mica only. We saw here no hornblende. ‘The granite is small-grained, and its felspar reddish, of the same colour with that of the gneiss. The veins in some: places run parallel to the planes of the strata, and in others cross them. ‘Some- times there is a gradation between the vein and the gneiss, but the line of junction is often quite distinct. Detached pieces of gneiss, much bent, are imbedded in the granite focksibius od Jno 149. The junction is exhibited with remarkable distinctness in a rock, which lies on the brink of the stream, and has re- ceived a polish from it. The surface here exposed measures a few feet each way, and is nearly in the same plane, sloping ra- ther obliquely to the water, at an angle of about 20°. (See Plate XIX, Fig. v.) The part next the water is granite; that next the shore is gneiss, of which the strata stretch N. 83° E., dipping northerly at an angle of 42°. It will be observed, that the dip of these strata is in an opposite direction to that of all the strata through the lower part of the Glen. The line of junction runs for about four feet, nearly straight, in a northerly direction, and thus crosses the lines of stratification. It is marked with the greatest precision. About the middle, the line is interrupted by a small vein of granite, which projects from the principal mass, intersecting the gneiss parallel to the lines of stratification, and tapering away, till it is lost in the course of a few inches. Near the line of junction, is a small fragment of gneiss imbedded in the granite.—In the loose blocks along the declivity of Cairn Vardenoch, we met with many junctions of granite and gneiss, exhibiting facts analogous to those now described. 150. Eighty yards below the fall of the Merk at the head of the Glen, we found gneiss, dipping about north-east, or per- haps still more to the north, at an angle of between 40° and 45°. Near this there are large masses of granite rock, and a 3A 2 i also also veins of granite; but the circumstances of the ground render it difficult to trace the junctions of the granite with the gneiss. At the foot of the fall there is gneiss, lying nearly as that last mentioned. 151. There is an obvious analogy in the appearances, at this junction of granite and gneiss, to those at the junctions of the sienite and strata in Glen Tilt, and they afford strong grounds for adopting a similar hypothesis with respect to their ori- gin. ADDITIONAL u PLAT FE XVE Hagrawed ly RED Ltrs PARE PLATE XYL s i6< 1B 0 Goer | "OF THE COURSE 0r THE RIVER IN oY - aps SCALE A TERT. —~ote. ei ——— 1} ~ ¥——__——il Hi | 1 | ) | 4 | : ‘ ~ PLATE XVIL —eaeses— = = = — _ - = = PbA wy oe OF THE = og ID ow ancy 0 aS bL S atA. Seale 50 Peet to an inch. we » * WX PLAN ALI OW. $. denotes Sent. Lut _. Vitnestone strata. at - Strata. Mca. gran. tines: ‘ <7 a fait ‘a S Neier \ \ i A PLA wy OF THE \ vw S. oly DD oy wee’ 1h at D. Seale $0 Feet to an Inch. & At, Rete witcha iil aica Slate or Gueiss Fig. eens | | “1h, Mica Sdate | —= - — | } | | } | | | \]| ! | ! 1h \) 1} | I 1 | \]) i il i Mien Shite or Gneiss | | | slenite “Granite | mera of the Slope of the surface t_ ~ a = = weak = By the Garry. y Near Blau; By the Tile. In Glen. Tilt, at D. In Glen Merk. By the Be of the POSITIONS of STRATA. YB The ‘continned ting indicates the stretch € the dottest ine the chp. Bythe Garry. By the Tite. By the Bannavey. Lower part of Glen Tilt, in Glen Tiltat B. as \ = i >. ‘) } ~ | 3 \ £ x ——_* __ or \ a : we (te | s X, eee + =s4 In Glen Merk. 7. ee ee 20° 29 23" ar" 26° 25" 24 com iT iii = EO To PLATE .XXI. Me MTs 57 ecaadienteeieciemannepenannmmiccanapaiamares = ~ aS allan \ ah \ Pathe weltovate GLEN BROCK HITE Dalvagaldte +, Calrio Hill Craig - loist Fails Kinder i n Crettdew het Inverslaniey : h Krrendrow } pe bt 5 Whol les m Glidure teho ll plese ¥ [Bridie of Tilt 3 J aioe : a Till Leinart Pu eCoppayach iKionayhilean 3 Onggansviler Reneqalloch = Ln Drian na driuch Bavbhracke > 3 Si dea =i RS Barstow Riennet PART O* } DEP 1s, ESB E Ss EC ERS: | Shewing iI CS ALAL BS lel iL and the ADIACRNE COUNTRY |) Auld Davie CUrn-g . : IN GLEN TILT. 369 ADDITIONAL NOTES. Note A, parag. 2. In tracing up the course of the Bruar, we made the following obser- vations. About a hundred yards north from the road to Dalnacardoch, the rock by the side of the river is mica-slate, stretching N. 36° E., and dipping south-east at an angle of 37°. Immediately above this, the river, in its descent through a long succession of falls, crosses the stra- ta, and displays a deep section of them at the battos of a ravine.. The prevailing rock is mica-slate. (At the first bridge in the walks made by the Duke of Atholl, there a bed of grey porphyry interposed between the strata of ‘mica-slate. a chief ingredient is a brownish-white felspar, in crystals that are © 4 ae together, and not very distinct; and these are imbedded in a. e of compact felspar, penetrated by mica and hornblende. Near: a second bridge, the mica-slate. st etches N. aif: E, and dips. S. E. 39°. About a mile and a half from the coal Fad not ea fro the river, - there appears another bed of grey porphyry interposed between the strata of mica-slate. The base of this porphyry seems to be compact -felspar, minutely penetrated by hornblende; and there are imperfect - crystals of hornblende interspersed. The stretch is here N. a7v’E, ¥ and the dip S. E. 53%. if af __ A quarter of a mile farther up, the rock is of mica-slate ‘and gneiss,. sti etching N. 16° E,, and ee to the eastward 23°. _ About 370 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES About four miles from the road, we found mica-slate, stretching N. 8° E,, and dipping eastward 23°. About two miles to the north-east of this, lies Ben y Chat, the nearest of that group of mountains, which spreads between the Bruar, the Tarff, and the Tilt; but we found no opportunity of extending our examination farther towards it. Among the rolled stones in, and near, the bed of the Bruar, we saw a few blocks of sienite, both grey and red, and one large block of granite. The course of the river Garry, aboye its junction with the Bruar, lies a good deal farther to the west of Blair. In following it up, along the road to Dalnacardoch, for between six and seven miles from Blair, we had frequent opportunities of seeing a fine section of the rock in the channel. The banks are abrupt, and the stream crosses the strata almost at right angles to their stretch. Our examination of them was very cursory ; but they seemed to be chiefly mica-slate, and pretty uniform in their stretch and dip. About five miles from Blair, the stretch was N. 18° E., and the dip easterly 28°. Six miles and a half from Blair, the stretch was N. 29° E., and the dip easter- ly 29°. From a comparison of the observations in the beds of the Tilt, the Banavie, the Bruar, and the Garry, it appears that the strata, which would be crossed by a line passing through Blair a little to the north of west, and extending about seven miles in that direction from the Tilt, are conformable in dipping towards the south-east; but vary in the extreme differences of their stretch about forty degrees. The strata in the channel of the Garry are intersected by veins, or dykes, of porphyry. About five miles from Blair, there is a remark- able one crossing the river, and between twenty and thirty yards broad. The base of this porphyry is a reddish brown compact felspar, in which there are imbedded small crystals of white felspar, and very imperfect crystals of hornblende. Where the porphyry joins to the mica-slate, the colour of the base changes to black by a gradation in the course of a few inches. Of this circumstance I can offer no ex- planation. Six miles and a half from Blair, there is a bed of porphyry perfectly parallel to the strata, and uniform in its thickness, which is eae eet. hie ae. {2a BS ow Te IN GLEN TILT. 371 feet: This porphyry has for its base a brownish-red compact felspar, which is well characterised, and contains crystals of quartz thinly in- terspersed. Its red colour makes it very conspicuous on the banks of the river, and the outgoing of the bed may be traced on both sides in the slopes of the mountains. Note B, Parag. 120. ‘ The minuteness, and intricate reticulation, of the smaller veins, may be urged in support of the hypothesis of secretion. In these points indeed they resemble those veins of quartz, and of calcareous spar, which are often found running in all directions through various stratified substances, and which it is difficult to conceive any other process, but secretion, to have produced. However, after having re- jected the hypothesis of secretion for the larger veins of sienite, it would be absurd to have recourse to it for the origin of small veins,, which are evident ramifications, and gradations, from them. The gradation on the sides of the veins in some places may also be insisted on, as favouring the hypothesis of cotemporaneous formation by secretion. But distinctness, or gradation, on the sides of veins, are equivocal circumstances in a question about their formation That distinctness will not prove posterior formation, is evinced by its oc~ curring in veins, which there is every other reason to suppose secret- ed; as in the minutely ramified veins of quartz running through clay-slate ; in the small veins of calcareous spar in limestone; in the veins of calcareous spar, which cross dykes of whinstone, and do not penetrate their walls * ; also in the lenticular veins of brown spar, or spathose * A good example of this occurs in the dyke that crosses the Water of Leith,, above St Bernard’s Well. 372 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES spathose iron-ore, in nodules of argillaceous iron-stone. On the other hand, that gradation is no decisive mark of secretion, is proved by instances of it on the sides of veins, of which the posterior forma- tion is undoubted. Werner meutions examples of it*; and Mr Ja- MESON observes in his Geognosy, where treating of such veins, that there are “‘ cases in which the substance of the vein is intimately mix- “ ed with its walls.” A fact of this kind was met with in Corn- wall in the year 1799, when Mr Prayrair and myself were in that country. A mine near Redruth, called Toll Carne, was then work- ing in a vein containing tinstone. The walls were of granite, and crystals of tinstone were found disseminated through the granite, for a few inches from the sides of the vein. It was regarded by some ex- perienced miners of that district, as quite a singular instance; but WERNER mentions similar facts concerning tinstone }. An analogous example of gradation was described to me by Sir Humeury Davy, as having been seen by Mr GreEnovucn and him- self, on the shore of Loch Erne in Ireland. A projecting rock of con- siderable height, so as to render it a conspicuous object from a dis- tance, was found to consist of a large vein of trap, or dyke of whinstone, traversing strata of limestone nearly horizontal. At the distance of some yards from the vein, the limestone presented the usual characters of that substance; but, on approaching the vein, it grew more in-~ durated, and to all appearance siliceous, and was highly so, where in contact. The softer parts of the strata were much worn away, and had left the harder parts on the sides of the vein, to form with it a pro- jecting mass. ~ At Beadnel Bay, on the coast of Northumberland, there is a whin- stone dyke, cutting strata, some of which are of limestone, and exhi- bit near the dyke a change of. character very analogous to that just described. * See Theory of Veins, § 58, 72, 75. + P. 232. See also p. 239. t See Theory of Veins, § 72. | | q ¥ fl \ IN GLEN TILT. . 373 described. An account of this dyke was laid before the Geological Society of London, in a paper by Mr Bennert, read in March 1812. A notice of it appears in Nicholson’s Journal, for April 1812, which is the source of my information. Note C, Parag. 133. When Dr Hurron communicated his views respecting Glen Tilt to» the Society, he signified his intention of giving at some future time a: full description of the phenomena he had observed ;. and, in the first volume of his Theory of the Earth, he promised to introduce it in the course of the work. At his death he left.a third volume of this publi- cation nearly ready for the press) Mr Prayrarr has favoured me with a sight of the manuscript, which contains a more particular ac- count of the author’s observations upon the junctions of granite and: primary strata, in Glen Tilt, in Arran, and in Galloway. His descrip- tions are not minute, but were to have been illustrated by en-- gravings, from drawings made on the spot; partly by the late Mr- Cuierx of Eldin, who accompanied him in two or three of his minera- logical excursions. When describing the appearances in the bed of the Tilt, he says, “ The granite is here found breaking, and displa- “ cing the strata; in every conceivable manner, including the frag- “ ments of the broken strata, and interjected in every possible. direc- “ tion among the strata, which appear. This is to be seen, not in one “ place only of the valley, but in many places, where the rocks ap- “ pear, or where the river has laid bare the strata.” If Dr Hutton has called the sienite granite, this can hardly be considered as a mis- take in nomenclature at the time when he wrote; and, though the Wernerian School have insisted much upon the distinction of those substances, it appears of little consequence in forming a theory for the- origin of that great tribe of crystallised aggregates, to which they. Vou, Vil. P. TL 3B both: 374 GEOLOGICAL APPEARANCES both belong. Dr Hurron’s chief error in describing ‘Glen Tilt is, that of stating the mountain on the northern side of the valley to con- sist of red granite. He was probably led to this false inference, -by what he saw in the deep cut made by the Criny, and by loose blocks near its entrance into Glen Tilt. a” : = * Note D, Parag. 139. About sixty yards above the junction of the Chlochan, there are “seen, in the bed of the Tilt, strata of a white granular limestone, high- ly crystallised, interstratified with, and penetrated by, mica and felspar, and containing pyrites. The mica gives it a slaty fracture in the large. The greater facility with which the carbonate of lime is worn away by the water, has caused the felspar to stand up in some places, in a rough and porous crust, on the surface of the rock. The position of these strata differs much from that which is most common in Glen Tilt; for their stretch is N. 150° E., and their dip north-east at an angle of 41°. Those on the eastern bank of the river are cut by red veins, either of felspar or sienite*. A hundred yards farther up the stream, I again fell in with the -orey ageregate. : 4 ys wateieds i fifty yards higher, there are strata in the face of. the hill above the southern bank, which seem to be,limestone. _ They — dip to the eastward into the face of the hill, but are much bent. In the course of another hundred yards, the dark-grey aggregate again occurs in the bed of the river. ' A hundred and fifty yards farther up, there is mica-slate, stretch- ing N. 128° E., and dipping to the north-east at an angle of 45°, The stretch and dip of the strata, where distinct, continues much the same for a hundred and fifty yards, when there appears ii slate, This is one of the exceptions alluded to in parag. 110. IN GLEN TILT. | 375 slate, stretching N. 133° E., and dipping to the north-east from 30° to 35%. About a hundred and fifty yards above this, is the junction of the Tarff and the Tilt. On the southern bank of the Tarff, fifty yards below the fall nearest the junction of the two rivers, the rock is of granular quartz, contain- ing some felspar, and steatite in the er fissures. It effervesces Siahies and seems to be penetrated with carbonate of lime. The stra- tification of this rock is indistinct, but, as far as I could determine it, its stretch is N. 93° E., and its dip southerly 46°. On the opposite bank the rock is of the same character. Its stratification is very indi- stinct, but appears to be horizontal, or rather dipping to the north, On the southern bank, nearer to the fall, there are strata of mica- slate, very ‘distinct, stretching N.101° E. and dipping northerly 38°. Some of these strata are only thirty yards trom the granular quartz, which has nearly the same stretch, and dips at nearly the same angle, but in an opposite direction. As these strata were, no doubt, once conformable, there is reason to imagine that they have undergone an extraordinary convolution, and some fraces of it may be discovered in the intervening face of the bank, though it does not afford so clear a section of the rock, as could be wished. % 3B2 XII. usdawny 3a, on Be pipe ontke odfr liar To A “dt id Bhatia Fea i . Ahaig acca ne ebay Ae et a. Lees ape hignd Bae tt son pwn ig a Py ior tee: heheh sO Ns aan at Alc th OEE ese me paieagh sige aut 1 pap Uy Oe 8 boca je iprans a : wa 3h pee Ce Ie Chee ok wisthererteha Cue Bie: sab teguuig ion Apel bib lay = IAS, Msn Oe ADEN rnbey wel mre : “oid vadings | PUSS ames cae “if Boe ia 7 "153 j neve yt at Pas ¥ “her verti Y ; a ae a ass 4. eer y sieAr Ad : 1 a vey is > se SS—~—~:S SII. \On certain Appearances observed in the Dissection of the Eyes of Fishes. By James L. Drummonp, M. D. of Belfast. Communicated by Dr Tuomas Brown, Pro- _ fessor of Moral Philosophy in the University of Edin- burgh. (Read 2d May 1814.) NOME months ago, in investigating the anatomy of the eyes ‘KY of fishes, I washed off the back silvery part of the choroid coat of the haddock, with a hair pencil, and about half a tea- spoonfulof water. The latter became ofa milky colour, and on ex- amining a drop of it, with an Exxis’s aquatic microscope, I found the milkiness to be owing to innumerable slender, flat, silvery spicula, which had composed the substance of the choroid. They seemed to be in constant motion, apparently rolling up- ‘on their axes, but having no degree of progressive movement. The light reflected from their surface was very brilliant, like that from polished silver, and often disappeared, and again re- turned, with alternations so rapid, as to produce a twinkling, very like that of a fixed star. Sometimes, on examining an individual specimen, it would ‘disappear altogether, but in a few minutes return, renew its twinkling, and apparent revolution on its axis, and again dis- “appear, to return as before. ‘ Frequently 378 APPEARANCES OBSERVED IN THE Frequently also, some were observed to be in the fluid, or on its surface, for a long time motionless, but very brilliant ; then they would give a few slight twinkles, seem to turn round, and almost disappear; then resume their original situation for a moment, appear more brilliant than at first, partly disappear again, and again return, and so on, for a number of times, till at length they would disappear entirely ; but, after a time, per- haps: five or ten minutes; shew themselves in the same spot as before. These observations could be made only on the larger spicula ; the minute ones being in incessant motion. On the first examination of this appearance, it seemed pro- bable, that the motion might be communicated by animalcula swimming through the fluid, and that these had been propaga- ted after the death of the fish, as the eye was not quite fresh. Soon afterwards, however, I examined the choroid in the same. way, from a flounder before it was quite dead. The same ap- pearance presented itself, if possible still more lively ; and I found also, sf it continued in many of the spicula, aves ex- posure to the heat of boiling water- Since that period, I have observed the same phzenomena in the choroid of all the fishes which I have examined, in the cartilaginous as well as the bony. ‘ The motion continues. in a great many of the aided even after the fluid containing them has become putrid; but it is then more slow. The addition of ardent spirit deadens, but does not destroy the motion. After exposure to a heat of boiling water, the number of spicula seems much diminished, and those which remain move less rapidly than before. The addition of vinegar, in a quantity equal to the fluid containing the spicula, suddenly causes a great diminution of the number ef moving ones, probably from Balaalened the albuminous mat- ter, nels had been washed from “oe eye’ along with the spi- cula, = ‘YES AND SCALES OF FISHES. 379 « eula, and entangling them in it. Many, however, continue their motion as before. hint off : wae: these bodies really. turn upon their axes, or whe- have the pro operty, of producing a rapid renewal and ction ‘of the rays of light, from their surfaces, 9 as to produc e only the appearance of rotation, I cannot po- sitively determine. In the larger spicula of the choroid of the herring, I have certainly, sometimes, been able to trace the ee his tobe an. individual spiculum, after it had ceased its twinkling re flection ; but, in neral, the appearance of ro- HT so distinct, as almost t to preclude the supposition of its not really taking place ; anc d these bod ies are not so mi- nute as to admit of much optitadl dec eception ; for in those from “some fishes, the herring in_ particular, the reflection, and ap-— arent motion penis evident, in the sunshine, to the pala SEAR: (IPN PAA NTY PRET ab st ke the eye ‘of the herring are jointed, being ge- nerally thus divided. into three distinet portions, of which that “which forms the centre is much larger than the two others. In common day-light, the entire spiculum is silvery ; ; but if it ‘be}observed'1n the sunshine, it will be found to reflect different rays, from the different jointed portions; the end-joints being generally of a light straw colour, while the central one is steel- blue, like the main-spring of a watch, or ‘of a a red or light rose colour, sometimes silvery, green, or purple ; but never. of ll _ same colour as the extremities of the “Spiculum, The of the different joints do. not shade into each other, but eg minate abruptly by a well-defined line, © . . To account. for the motion of these ‘spicula ig,’ ‘ep mult. There seems no reason to suppose it to depend, either on elec- trical or galvanic influence. The motion of each spiculum is otis itself, nothing like attraction, or repulsion, subsisting between ‘ 880 APPEARANCES OBSERVED IN THE* between it and any other, or between it and either the surface or bottom of the fluid. -. , Evaporation, causing an intestine motion in the particles of the fluid, cannot be the cause; for the addition of ardent spi-~ rit, which increases the evaporation, deadens the motion, and. the motion continues when the liquid is covered over with ple mond oil, or inclosed in a glass 1 tube. = The spicula are a little heavier than water ; for, on i stadia they slowly settle at the bottom ; but the slow manner of their subsiding, and consequent turning, from side to side, is not the cause of the motion mentioned ; for when a stratum is spread: on a piece of glass with a ee as thin as possible, the motion continues till the whole water is evaporated ; and if a drop of oil is let fall on such a stratum of. fluid containing the spicula, the motion continues under the oil without interrup~ tion for many hours, The transmission of caloric will in no way account for it. The motion is totally different from that of particles of dusty, &c. caused by the currents formed during the cooling or heat~ ing of alcohol or other fluids. ‘Phosphoreseence has no connection with it; the reflection: being apparent only when light falls on the surface of the. fluid ; and the stronger the Heb the more brilliant, as in other eases, is the reflection. To suppose that these spicula are animated, would, for ma~ ny reasons, seem a wild and improbable idea. First, They resist a heat of 212°, which no animated Being is known to do. om |i This alone might at first seem conclusive, yet, perhaps, it is not entirely so. The experiments of naturalists prove, that the ova of animalcula resist a boiling heat, as, in various ve- getable decoctions, which, although poured hot into a an ‘EYES AND SCALES OF FISHES. _ 381 yy and immediately corked up or sealed over, yet are found, after some hours ays, to be replete with myriads of animalcu- les ; but I believe no experimerit goes to shew, that any ani+ malcule could itself withstand such a-degree of heat. In these obscure departments of natu e, however, there is no reasoning with certainty from mere ola Before Tremsiey’s disco- very of the nature of the polypus, it could scarcely have been credited, that there existed any animal which might be multi- plied almost ad infinitum, by cutting it into pieces; and there are many other phaznomena in the animal kingdom, which stand as it were insulated and independent of the laws which govern the ‘chain of animation to which they belong. Thus vinegar proves an instantaneous poison to all animalcules found in other fluids, yet the. vibrio aceti is found in vinegar, and in italone, Some animalcules, after being dried up for years, as the eels in blighted wheat, revive upon the application of moi- sture ; and the insect named the puceron, or vine-fretter (as discovered by Bonner), contrary to all analogy, propagates without sexual intercourse down to the ninth generation. From these, and many other similar occurrences, it must be evident, that analogy, in our researches into the lowest classes of animal life, must be a fallacious guide. Perhaps, therefore, without too far transgressing the bounds of probability, we may admit the possibility of the existence of a being possessed of animation, and yet capable of resisting a heat as high as 212°. Second, It appears very absurd to suppose, that any organ of a living body should be ind of a congeries of other mi- nute schtwbilitad beings or animale But, at one time, it would!perhaps have seemed nearly as great an absurdity, to suppose that such beings existed in any of the secretions ; yet the discovery of ee reactive: and the Vou. VII. P. IL 3C observations 382 APPEARANCES OBSERVED IN THE Z bd observatlons of succeeding philosophers have es that im the seminal fluid animalcules do exist in 1 atest abun- dance. , Third, These spicula, contrary to. have no power of progressive motic This is no argument whatever against their vitality ; for how many animals are fixed to- ot from the first moment of their existence till that of their dissolution. I need only mention some of the Lestacea, as the lepas, anomia, and ser- pula; and the numerous zopph tes, the inhabitants of which remain for ever fixed, each to the cell which gave it birth. Even in the human. body, we find the various species of hy- datids under the same circumstances. ~~ ‘ Fourth, Animalcules increase in number by long keeping and putrefaction ; on the contrary, these spicula, by the same: means, become greatly diminished in number. Here it may be observed, that when animalcula thus in- erease, they are in their natural and proper element ; but the spicula, when removed from the eye, are in the same circum- stances as.intestinal worms. or hydatids, which, when removed. from the body, soon die. Besides, the life ofsthe animal which they infest, seems necessary to the continuance of their being ; for after the death of the animal, (as‘in the case of removal,). they soon die also.. Hence, allowing these spicula to be ani- mated, the wonder may rather be, how they retain their ani- mation so long after being removed from their natural situa- tion. It would, however, only be another instance of the ex- traordinary power by which. some animals retain vitality, as is strongly evinced in the fr e, which are said to leap or move about even twenty-four h after the head has been ta- ken. off, or the heart eut out, . . With ulin of animalcules, EYES AND SCALES OF FISHES. 383 With regard to the little effect which ardent spirit produces on the spicula, it may be remarked, that scarabzei, and other coleopterous insects, often remain a considerable time immer- sed in spirits befére they become motionless, and, when taken out after a lapse of four or five hours, frequently recover. Fifth, Are not these spicula formed and nourished by blood- vessels as the other parts of the fish are; and, if so, how can they be considered as distinct animals? This question, it must be confessed, is almost unanswerable. To prove that vessels cannot be traced into them, would be to prove nothing ; for in many parts of the body, as cartilages of the joints, ves- sels cannot, even by the finest injections, be detected. The spicula are chiefly abundant in the cellular substance which connects the outer layer of the choroid to the sclerotica, and there they seem to have little or no adhesion, at least not more than would seem to arise,from their confinement among cellu- lar substance. Hence, in merely separating the choroid from the sclerotica, they are obtained. in thousands. When the choroid also is dissected off, and gently shaken in a phial with a little water, the liquid very soon becomes milky, from their dispersion through it. This looseness, or want of connection, is, However, of little consequence with respect to the present argument, since the brain or the pulpy retina may be diffused through water with almost as muchiease, yet both are perfectly vascular. The particles, however, into which the brain or retina is broken are quite irregular, and of different sizes or clusters, and of pulpy _ consistence, and exhibit no appearance of motion. The spi- cula, on the other hand, 8 to be rigid, are always distinct, and of a constant | r form, and keep up a perpetual motion and reflection of light. 3C2 Perhaps 384 APPEARANCES OBSERVED IN THE Perhaps many other objections. may be opposed to. the sup- position of animalcular life in these bodies ; and yet the strong expression of animation, if I may so term it, and air of seeming, design, with which the varying motions, sometimes slow, and sometimes rapid, are performed, and the difficulty of otherwise, accounting for their motion, whether real or apparent, lead, upon the whole, I think, to this supposition, not as one which, we can admit with confidence, but as the east improbable con- jecture, which, in the present limited, state of our knowledge, - we can venture to form. In managing the microscope, thie reflector must not be used ;; for when. a strong light is transmitted through the fluid, the spicula become cataliies or are only poncaicls seen. The fluid, therefore, containing them, should be placed upon some-. thing of a dark, colour, as a piece of glass, with its underside blackened; and, the stronger the ‘a which can be thrown upon the surface, the better; hence they appear uncommonly brilliant and distinct when placed in the sunshine ; and, in this situation, with a high ae they present one of the most brilliant and lively microscopic objects that can be imagined ; each spiculum scems like a long bar of light, constantly twink- ling, with a reflection almost too strong ras the eye to sustain. They may be also well seen in a strong candle light, so mana- ged, that it may fall upon the surface. Perhaps this phenomenon may have been “already, pointed: out; but it is not noticed by Apam, Cuvier, | BiuMensacu, or. any author with whom J am acquainted. Poe Sinee _ EYES AND SCALES OF FISHES. 385 Since these observations were originally made by me on the spicula of the eye, I have been led to extend my inquiries to other parts of the fish ; and though I have not yet had time to vary my observations as fully and widely as with more leisure I would have done, I may state even now, that I have ascer- tained beyond a doubt, that the brilliant colours of the surface - of this splendid tribe of animals are not owing, as Cuvier sup- poses, to a mucous * substance, but to bodies in every respect the same as the spicula of the choroid coat of the eye. The- scales of fishes are pellucid ; and their brilliant appearance is owing toa = film, which ‘covers the underside of each scale, and is itself é entirely formed of spicula, as is easily proved by scraping off a quantity of scales, and agitating them in water with a stick or other body, so as to detach the films. The wa- ter will then be found to contain thousands of moving spicula, . which, in the sunshine, may be discerned with the utmost ease by the naked eye. i The scales of the salmon answer best for this purpose, as they are large and easily tee Se + , ‘hil ‘ * << Of all vertebral animals,” says this illustrious physiologist, ‘ fishes-are the most remarkable for the brilliant and metallic colours which their rete muco- sum exhibits. We) find i in thém gold, silver, and copper, tin, lead, and even all the tints which these ‘metals assume in different degrees of oxydation. But as the description of these colours is the province of Natural History, properly so ealled, we wish merely to point out in this place, that they are produced by the mucous substance which adheres closely to the internal surface of the scales, and : with, which. it is frequently ‘Sh He XL. XUE. 4 5 hha sae: eee o ‘it abied sae oy nee se 9 b Ay: {ai rennin af oie & y i analawaabadat tal ah orion anieanial “Hi +8; tad ieee a. Tee 2 XIN... Observations on the Theory of “Language. ’ By Henry - Dewar, M. D. Fellow of the Royal College of Physi-- cians of Edinburgh. (Read 2d January 1815.) HOSE philological. studies which have been cultivated ’ among polished nations, for their subserviency to litera- - ry.taste, and their influence on the formation of correct habits - of speaking and writing, have gradually suggested the more - profound science of Universal Grammar. The business of this , science is, not merely to dictate the best manner of connect- ing words with one another, but to. investigate the origin of . : the various distinctions existing among re and to Toc: ver in what instances these Tuhietons are dictated by occa- sional convenience or partial caprice, and in what instances they are essential to the purposes of language. By the aid of | these investigations, philosophers have even hoped to trace some of the most important laws of human thought, and to - obtain a solution. of the most. difficult mbblens of me-. : taphysies. Some of the attempts made to realise these expec-. tations. have displayed great ingenuity; but, even. with this. qualification to recommend them, they have. often failed to. establish principles on a foundation sufficiently sure to preclude: controversy. Amids¢ “388 OBSERVATIONS ON THE Amidst the equilibrium of sentiment on such subjects, and the consequent indifference to the investigations themselves which previously prevailed, Mr Horne Tooxe published his Di- versions of Purley,—a work which must be acknowledged not only to exhibit a brilliant display of the genius of the author, but to afford a luminous explanation of some points in the’ sci- ence that were formerly obscute. This author has refuted some of the errors of his predeces- sors with so much clearness of argument, and exposed their incongruities with such forcible effect, that it might naturally have been expected that these errors would not have been re- peated. But his lucubrations have laboured under some disad- vantages. The circumstance of his declining to deliver his - opinion on some important points has prevented his readers from appreciating the merits of his doctrines, or even from perceiving whether or not he was in possession of a complete system on the subject : while the boldness of his asseverations, the acrimony of his polemics, and the delight which he betrays in confounding the self-ecomplacency of those whom he regards as less. enlightened, have probably cherished, in many of his readers, a prejudiced attachment to errors which might other- wise have been considered as exploded. Tt is on all hands allowed, that Mr Tooxr had the merit of giving this department of inquiry a more interesting character than it formerly possessed ; and those who are disposed to read his work with a view to information, and to pass over all that is dark or uncertain in it, cannot fail to be much instructed. Even where he appears to aim at the subversion of sound and highly valued principles, the facts on which he proceeds are deserving of careful attention ; and though we may for a time fail in endeavouring to account for chen they are worthy of being Shax. —— : : . THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 389 being recorded for more complete investigation, as promising to lead us to new and unexceptionable conclusions. The design of the following paper is to suggest a few consi- derations for the purpose of solving some difficulties in which the Theory of Language is involved. It will be requisite, in the first place, to consider minute- ly the ogsecr or purrose of Language,—a_ subject which the greater part of writers, and Mr Tooxe himself, seem to have thought liable to no diversity of opinion, and which is in- troduced at the beginning of every treatise on universal gram- mar, rather for the sake of form than with a view to establish any peculiar doctrine. No grammarian seems to have disputed the justness of this account of the object of language, that it is “ to communicate “ our thoughts to one another.” We communicate our thoughts, sometimes by presenting the objects of them to the senses of another; sometimes by sug- gesting them through the medium of signs. When we hold out an apple or a stone, when we point to a river or toa mountain, we communicate to another a thought which exists in our own mind. This act has been reckoned a specimen of natural language. It is, however, with signs, and only with that species of signs called words, that universal grammar is conversant ; and, in our inquiries into this subject, we are to consider the use that is made of these signs, as completely se- parate from any immediate exhibition of the objects of our thoughts themselves. Words are, indeed, objects of thought, and are perceived, like other objects, by the senses. They are not, however, pre- sented on their own account, but only for exciting different ideas, for which they conventionally stand as signs. The ori- Vox. VII, P. IL 3D ginal 396 OBSERVATIONS ON THE ginal objects must have been at some time presented, in order that the words may be understood ; but, when once understood, they perform their office without that aid. All thoughts which are communicated, must either be affec- tions received immediately from the perceptions of external objects, or affections which become communicable in conse- quence of certain relations wii, existing betwixt them and external objects. Tn communicating thought, we sometimes merely recall thoughts which had on some former occasion existed in the mind of the person addressed ; at other times we convey new ones. This last is the case when we give a person new infor- mation. It is not, however, possible, that any thought which is com- municated by words should consist of new materials ; because every word, in order to serve the purpose of communication, must be previously understood. All new thoughts, therefore, communicated by language, consist of new conjunctions of ideas, produced by new arrangements among the words that are used: From differences of arrangement given to the same ideas, new feelings may arise. The varieties of sentiment, depending on the varieties of these arrangements, constitute, in a great mea- sure, the varieties of character and of intellect that exist among mankind. By the use of language, as subservient to these ends, the great fabrics of science and literary taste are erected. We must, therefore, understand by the communication of thought to which language is subservient, the act of commu- nicating new arrangements of such ideas as were formerly pos- sessed. The resulting feelings are subsequent consequences, which we have it in view to produce ; but the conveyance of them is not the immediate act of language itself: Mr THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 391 Mr Tooxe does not explicitly say, that he considers all Jan- guage as consisting in expressing the connections of ideas ; but he seems to make some approach to this doctrine. He ac- knowledges only two essential parts of speech, the Noun and the Verb. The Noun he defines to be “ the simple or com- “ plex, the particular or general sign or name of one or more ideas.” The Verb, according to him, is “ the word by which ** we make our communication.” In the outset of his speculations, he denies that the mind has any farther concern with language than to receive impres-_ sions, that is, to have sensations or feelings. What are called its operations, he says, are merely operations of language. This distinction is perhaps rather frivolous. If language is a human contrivance, both the creation and the application of it must be operations of the mind. He must therefore mean, that it implies no farther operation of the mind than what consists in the contrivance and employment of the means of communica~- tion: a F “ The consideration of ideas, or of the mind, or things, rela- “ tive to the parts of speech, will,’ he says, “ lead us no far- “ ther than to Nouns, that is, the signs of these impressions, “ or names of ideas: The other part of speech, the Verb, must “be accounted for from the necessary use of it in communi- “ cation. The Verb is, guod loquimur ; the Noun, de quo.” This author, however, has not given a full account of the doctrine which he entertained respecting the nature of the Verb. In the end of his second volume, he seems to concur with other grammarians in believing that the idea expressed by most verbs may be expressed also by means of a noun. He says, “ the verb always contains a noun, but, besides this, “ contains something more ;” and he proposes it as an enigma for exercising the acuteness of the metaphysical world, “ what 8D2 ' : « is 392 OBSERVATIONS ON’ THE “ js that peculiar differential circumstance which, added to the “. definition of a Noun, constitutes the Verb?” In ano- ther part of his work, he refuses to the: infinitive mood of the verb the character of a noun, although it appears to be the mere name of the idea contained in the verb. The infinitive mood, indeed, is connected with some of the words in a.sen- tence in a manner differing a little from other nouns; but in more important points of syntax it agrees with them. Mr Tooxr, however, appears to have considered the radical use of the infinitive. mood’ as the same with that of the verb as dise tinguished from the noun, and not as, in this respect, analo- gous to the noun itself. It is difficult to reconcile this doc- tring, not only with other doctrines of Mr Tooxer, but with one obvious fact in language itself,—that, wherever the infinitive of a verb occurs, an additional. Verb will serve the purpose of eom- pleting a sentence, but the addition of a Noun will not. If we take the infinitive of the Verb.“ to deceive,’ we never can complete a sentence by adding the Noun “ man,” “ friend,” or “ stranger:” but we. can complete one by adding the Verb “ dishonours.” ‘ ‘To deceive dishonours,”’ is a complete sen- tence, though not an elegant one. It is not easy to form even a probable conjecture what views Mr Tooxe could enter- tain of the Verb, in strict consistency with other doctrines which he advances. The theory adopted by some grammarians who have availed themselves very fully of the improvements of Mr Tooxs is, that the proper business of language is AFFIRMATION OF ASSERTION 3 that all sentences, when analysed, are resolved into assertions ; that assertion is the connecting. of one idea with another ; and that the office of the verb is to. serve as the sign of connection betwixt different ideas. The Substantive Verb is, in this theo- vy, considered as the only pure verb, and all other verbs are supposed to be made up of the Substantive Verb and a a In ' THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 398 ‘In fact, the substantive verb is considered as the simple ex- pression for “ that peculiar differential circumstance which, “ added to thedefinition of a Noun, constitutes the Verb.” This is the view adopted by the learned author of the article Universal Grammar, in the later editions of the Encyclopedia Britannica. This doctrine does not seem, however, to be acquiesced in by ali The ingenious author of the corresponding article in Rees’s Cyclopedia, though he does not directly oppose it, seems not to consider affirmation as essential to language. He casually speaks of the verb as losing its power of affirmation in the Imperative: Mood. He has not, however, substituted any other theory of the general object of language, nor laid down any general doctrine on the nature of sentences. He does not, indeed, shew himself to be aware, that since, in this instance, he denied a doctrine reckoned by others fundamen- tal, it was incumbent on him either to substitute another, or to prove that none could be obtained. The theory which considers the business of language as con- - ‘sisting in affirmation, and which considers all sentences as as- sertions, is certainly recommended by some:share of plausibi-. lity. We feel, for the most part, that.this.is our object. We use the noun as the sign of an idea, and the verb as a sign by which we communicate a new connection betwixt one. idea.and another. The substantive verb, placed betwixt. two nouns, signifies that the ideas expressed by these nouns have a cer- tain order of succession in our thoughts,—an order which we endeavour, by means of this sign, to produce in the thoughts of the person to whom we speak. “ This cloth is green,” when’ addressed to any person, signifies merely that we con- ~nect the idea expressed by “ this cloth” with that which is-ex- “pressed-by the-term “ green.” The assertion made is, that a. green: 394 OBSERVATIONS ON THE green colour is an object which has a definite connection with that congeries of other qualities to which we attach the name or description of “ this cloth.” From sentences expressing the simpler combinations of ideas. we ascend to the formation of others of a more compli- cated kind. Of this we have an instance in describing the lo- cal situation of any object. We still only use nouns and verbs for expressing a certain order of ideas. We mention one or more objects to which the chief object of our interest bears some local relation. It makes no difference in the general nature of the act of language, whether these others are previously known, or are now first brought into view for the sake of specifying the relations sustained by that which we intend to describe. The series is still more complicated, when we give an account of a change of place which any object has undergone. We now describe a series of ideas composed. of two or more sim- pler series. We assign to the object a particular situation at one moment, and describe its situation as different at a succeeding moment. This is implied in all our ideas of motion, on which the greater part of Active Verbs are founded,—simple as they appear, in consequence of the instantaneous resulting senti- ments which habit has led us to attach to them. The verbs “ to go,’—* to run,” — to strike,’ to kill,’—derive their difference of meaning from varieties of arrangement which the same original ideas are intended to assume. These doctrines concerning the Noun and the Verb, and the universality of the character of Assertion in the composition of sentences, cannot, however, be maintained, unless it can be shewn that all the differentgkinds of sentences are actually re- solvable into assertions, and are originally possessed of that character. Its application to such sentences as I have now al- luded to is sufficiently obvious. It might also be shewn to be applicable es eta THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 395. applicable to Negations. But how will it apply to Imperatives and Interrogatives? This is a question which deserves parti- cular attention. © The author who writes in the Encyclopedia Britannica, re- duces Imperative sentences to Assertions, by placing before them the affirming words, “ I command you,” or, “ I request “* you.” The imperative “ veni,” he says, is exactly equivalent to the assertion “ jubeo te venire.” If all imperative senten- ces are assertions, Interrogatives will easily fall under the same denomination, as they are only imperatives in a different form. By interrogatives, we request the person whom we ad- dress to give us information. ‘“ What is your name?” and “ Tell me your name,” are equivalent ; and both are resolved: by this theory into the affirmative sentence, “I beg that you: “ will tell me your name.” The Imperative mood is thus con- sidered as an abbreviation.. This doctrine, as applied to Imperatives, however, is unsatis- factory. The brevity of Imperatives has every appearance of being part of their original character. The words prefixed by the author now mentioned do:not seem. natural to such sen-. tences, and tend rather to encumber than explain them. The- sentences into which they are then reduced are, strictly speak- ing, mere assertions of a command or request, and no longer the giving of a command itself: But a command must exist before it can properly be asserted, and no command exists be- fore the Imperative is used.. With a view to substitute a different doctrine on this: sub- ject, I shall premise a few general considerations which are- necessary to give us right notions respecting the mutual influ- ence of thought and language. I begin with remarking, that. ‘we should avoid the error of supposing that language is mere- _ lyasimple and spontaneous expression of our thoughts. A. notion 396 OBSERVATIONS ON THE notion has of late obtained general currency among metaphy- sicians, that, wlien we speak, we merely think aloud, and that, when we think, we merely speak in secret. ‘The closeness of the connection betwixt thought and language has thus been overrated. The origin of this error may be traced without much difficulty. It is to Language that we owe the greater part of our information. This circumstance creates an attach- ment to Language which sometimes leads us astray. Another circumstance possessed of the same tendency is, that when we are engaged in private thought, we very generally have some nearer or more distant view of expressing our ideas to others. It is also to be remarked that, independently of any direct inten- tion, we are prone to indulge the pleasure of associating our men- tal exercises with the imagery of conversation. Thoughts which are thus associated are most apt to be attended to and revolved in the mind. But it ought to be recollected that many thoughts pass through the mind which are never expressed, and have no necessary connection with language whatever.—We sometimes hear it maintained, that we cannot think except.through the medium of language, ‘This is to suppose that we never think of an object, before the name of that object occurs to us. Ac- cording to this theory, the name and the thing represent- ed by it are not even allowed to be strictly collateral. The precedence in point of time is given to the name. A little reflection on the varieties which take place in the usual current of thought will soon lead us to regard the opinion now mentioned as immature. It will probably be found that, though the occurrence of a word sometimes suggests the ob- ject elit it signifies, the occurrence of the object to the mind as frequently suggests the word which is employed as its name. Whether we ik of words or of things, both the one and the other are to be equally considered as Objects of thought, and in neither THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 397 neither case can we be said to think through the medium of | Language in any other sense than that which is implied in the - familiar fact, that one kind of thought readily suggests another _with which it has been associated. The cause of this error seems to be, that our thoughts about words and things are in- - timately mixed, and the transitions :from the one to the other - too rapid to be perceptible. Another cause is, that our most considerate speculations are generally subsequent to- some looser movements of the mental faculties, in which many words are revolved, for the aid which they afford by suggest- ing a variety of views. Men, to be sure, very often imagine themselves to be speaking when they are thinking ; but, in pro- portion as this is the case, their thoughts are bewildered and imperfect. Hence persons who are detected speaking aloud in private, are ashamed of having employed language where it could not be subservient to its appropriate uses... When we observe a person’s lips moving during his private thoughts, we conclude him to be deficient in presence of mind, and sub- jected for the moment to a certain degree of hallucination. Reverie is a common failing of human nature. Even. the strongest minds.are: subject to it. That species of it which is called verbal. reverie. is incident. to those whose relish for _ conversation. is accompanied with vanity. It is also extreme. - ly prevalent among literary men, in consequence of a peculiar share of their attention: being directed to the meaning and — choice of words. We find a great difference betwixt the va- ue which an illiterate man of natural: good sense and the man . of letters attach to words. ‘The former thinks of things with- out words, and merely employs. words from acquired habit when he has occasion to address others: he is satisfied in this BENS when he knows that he is fully understood, and despises the direct study of words as.an idle occupation... But, with literas Vou. VII. P. IL | 3 E. ry. °398 OBSERVATIONS ON THE ry men, thinking of things, and thinking of the signs of things, are peculiarly apt to be co-existent. This co-existence, gene- rating confusion, has probably biassed the estimate which me- taphysicians have formed of the universal and necessary influ- ence of language. It has been said in’proof of the necessity of language even to the act of thought itself, that there are many mental pro- cesses which cannot be conducted without the intervention of signs similar to those of language. Examples of this kind in the mathematical sciences are considered as occurring in great abundance. The signs in such examples become indeed pro- minent and useful objects of thought to the student of science, but they are perhaps in no greater degree the instruments of thought than land-marks are the instruments of navigation, or milestones the instruments of travelling. When we have com- pleted a mathematical calculation, resulting in a precise and comprehensive theorem, this result is expressed by a more or less complicated sign. The sign in its various uses employs our active thoughts; but we have numerous thoughts about this sign itself, for which we do not in our private meditations use any signs. The leading sign, which we in this instance employ, enables us to refer with facility to our past operations, so as to secure precision in our further studies; but such thoughts as merely serve the purpose of the moment are not even accompanied with the silent use of speech or of signs. We may perhaps fiud the same fact illustrated in a different way, by attending to the state of our thoughts, in so far as lan- guage is concerned, when we exercise the understanding on a moral subject. We shall probably be conscious that, when we obtain a new idea, this often exists for some time in the mind before we can find an appropriate expression for it, and, after all, our best expressions are rather regarded as hints for elicit- ing ne Gis a _—————— LS LUC mC THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 399° ing a similar idea in others, than signs fully fitted to convey our meaning. It is in this case that we are most certain: of having performed an act of understanding. This fact may convince us that language is not the medium of private thought. Another mistaken view seems in some degree to influence the speculations of metaphysical writers on language, though it is not expressly maintained :—That man is originally prone to communicate all his thoughts to others, and that language: is nothing else than the spontaneous catenations of our thoughts put in words. No analytical inquiry is necessary to demonstrate the fallacy of such an opinion ; but it may be useful to keep in mind some facts on the subject, which will serve to put us on our guard against any unconscious leaning to it, in estimating the justness of particular theories of lan- guage. A person whose conversation consists of mere think- ing aloud is always considered as betraying weakness by an: imprudent deviation from the original purposes with. which language is employed. We expect a speaker to have some. other object in view, than merely to gratify a proneness to communicate his thoughts. Many thoughts whieh it is reckon- ed allowable and laudable for him to entertain cannot be ex- pressed to others, without subjecting him to the charge of im-- pertinence. -There is one fact in the history of man; which is certainly worthy of more attention than it generally receives, being too: often overlooked in its relation to some other views with which we are occasionally occupied,—that thought is of much earlier. date in the life of the individual than language, Inattention: to this fact appears to be the reason, that those who have ex-. pected to find in etymology a developement of the first prin- - 3E2 ciples. - 400 : OBSERVATIONS ON THE ciples and the earliest history of human thought have not met with adequate success. The origin of thought and the origin of language form distinct subjects of inquiry, the difference betwixt the eras that belong to them:not being accidental but essential. There is nothing in the general nature of the thinking faculty of man that implies a prone- ness to communicate his thoughts to ethers. His inclina- tion to speak to his neighbour is not the consequence of the simple existence-of thought, but arises from a particular kind of thoughts which occupy his mind. His motives for . employing any sort of language are to be found in the mu- tual relations subsisting among the species. “The ideas re- ceived from inanimate nature might exist in full vigour, and the sensaticns of pleasure and pain might be varied and lively, and yet never lead to the employment of language. Before language can have existence, a ‘man must perceive that he is surrounded by other sentient beings ; he must know that some analogy subsists betwixt their perceptions and his own; he must be acquainted with the principles of mutual attention and imitation, which characterise human nature; and, he must know. that..it-is practicable to influence the thoughts of -others by means of signs. -Afier possessing all this knowledge, he must, before he can use language, feel the influence of some particular motive. These circumstances not only enter into the first contrivance of language, but perpetually accompany the employment of it. In speaking to our neighbour, we employ a certain power of which we find ourselves possessed to rouse his thoughts from a state of inaction, or to direct them to objects different from those which have previously engaged them. The exercise of this power is properly an rmrerarive Act, and the original and ‘most natural expression of it, is in the Imperative mood of the verb. THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 401 verb. I may here observe, by the way, that I do not use the the word Imperative as meaning the exercise of a power im- plying positive superiority in one individual to another, but as expressive of the general characteristic circumstance of per- sonal influence, and including all its forms,—solicitations, for example, as well as commands. An Imperative is implied both in the use of Nouns and of Verbs. A grammarian may call a noun a simple sign of an idea, implying no further move- ment of the mind ; but he will find, on closer consideration, that every person, in making use of a noun, expresses some inten- tion, and that this intention gives to the simplest word the force of an animated sentence. When we pronounce the name of an object, we desire the person addressed toythink of it, and this itself implies an Imperative act along with the par- ticular idea pointed out. ‘ The tendency of the preceding observations. is to establish two positions in the theory of grammar, which are connected with each other, and which differ from the doctrines usually entertained. The first is, that the object of language instead of being described as consisting in the communication of our thoughts, should be made to consist in propucine THOUGHT, or in INFLUENCING THE THOUGHTS OF OTHERS, BY THE MEDIUM oF worps. The other is that, instead of considering all Lan- GUAGE aS AFFIRMATIVE, we ought to consider it as originally IMPERATIVE. Those who are averse to think favourably of this doctrine will, on consideration, find it at least to be less liable to some exceptions than that to which it is opposed. These exceptions they may indeed despise as founded in verbal quibbles ; but it ought to be recollected that, in the doctrine of words, the pre- cluding of quibbles is a very important object. I hope to shew that this doctrine will, with the aid of a little illustration, throw 402 OBSERVATIONS ON THE. throw some light on the general nature of Language, and prove materially subservient to the purposes of a. rational ety- mology. Fa Imperatives seem to be deprived of their characteristic ani- mation when we attempt to resolve them into affirmations. Affirmations, on the other hand, will preserve that. interest which originally belongs to them by being considered as im- perative directions for regulating the thoughts and volitions of others. The etymology of verbs in every language illustrates the primary importance of Imperatives. The first purpose for which a man naturally employs language is to implore the as- sistance @f his fellow-creatures. The first ideas, therefore, for which he wishes to have signs are those of locomotion. Words expressing locomotion are employed for a variety of purposes; but that purpose for which a man is likely soonest to call the attention of another to the idea by means of the oral sign, is to solicit him to perform the motion. For this reason, the Imperative is in all languages the shortest part of the Verb. In the English language, it consists in the mere use of the syllables which distinguish each verb from all others. It is in the Imperative that we say, “ walk,”—* run,”— and “ go.” The other uses of the verb, such as that of descri- bing our own motions or those of a third person, are subse- quent to it in the order of etymology, as they are in the or- der. of nature. In such cases, we find the Verb receiving a Nominative, a Termination, or some sort of additional sign. For example, “I go,’ —“ thou goest,”—“ he goes.” Even when the definitive idea expressed by any verb is introduced as an Object concerning which an assertion is to be made, an addi- tional sign is employed besides that which is used for the impera- tive. The simple act is not called “ walk,” —“ run,”’—or “go ;” but, “ro walk,” —“ rorun,”—* ro go;” or “ walk-rne,”—* runn- ING, ee BES OAR THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 403 ING,—go-1ne. “ He likes ro walk,” or, “ he likes walk-rne :” * to walk or walking is conducive to health.” This principle of etymology is equally conspicuous in the Latin language. In the imperatives “ ama,” “‘doce,” “ lege,’ “ audi,’ we have merely the letters essential to each verb, together with the terminating vowel corresponding to their respective conjugations. In some imperatives even this vowel is want- ing, as in “ dic,’ “ duc,’ “ fac,’ and “ fer.” Gramma- rians. call these imperatives irregular, and seem to sup- pose that, at some period, they have been deprived of the terminating vowel. Unless we had good proof of this, it might perhaps be with equal probability supposed that these words retain a simplicity originally belonging to all impera- tives. At all events, they illustrate the tendency to brevity in this form of the verb. It is not necessary to recur to uncer- tain points in the antiquities of any language, in order to find out the principles of etymology. They are exemplified in eve- ry modern language. They are abundantly displayed in those cases in which a new language has been formed from materials surviving that destruction of pre-existing languages which is naturally occasioned by the competition of several of them for current use, in the mingling of different tribes. The same ra- dical principles are even found to operate in the diversities of provincial dialects, and in the variations produced by the rest- less spirit of novelty. The imperative of the Latin verb e0, is as short as can be imagined, as it consists of the single let- teri. When the definitive idea represented by any verb is considered as ‘an object concerning which an assertion is to be made, intimation of this circumstance is given in the Latin language by the termination “ re” added to the imperative. From the preceding imperatives we have “ ama-re,” “ doce- “rE,” “ lege-re,” “ audi-re,’ and “i-re.” This termination seems 404 OBSERVATIONS ON THE seems to be nothing else than the noun “ res” in an inde clinable form. J signifies “ go;” Lre, “ go-thing;” go con- sidered as a thing, or Object of thought. Vult i-re, “ he wills going, or the thing to go.” Those inarticulate sounds which express strong sensation, which are not originally addressed to any hearer, and are ut- tered even by the deaf and dumb, such as laughing, crying, and expressions. of surprise, are the. only sounds that precede Imperatives. They are in the first place involuntary, and af- terwards uttered from design. A man desirous of impressing another with a particular passion first contrives to excite it in his own mind, and then utters the sound by which it is ex- pressed, Some sounds bearing a resemblance to these are conveyed by articulate syllables, and ranked by grammarians under a head by themselves, to which they give the name of Interjections.. Mr Tooxer refuses them any place in human language, because they are common to us with. brutes, and are in some degree symptoms of the wildness of mental dereliction. Language, however, must include every sound addressed by one man to another, from the lowest to the highest state of mental cultivation. Interjections may be considered as a mix- ture of involuntary expression with social discourse. In the use of this part of speech, man is seen.to rise from the charac- ter of an animal impelled by passion, to that of a reflecting be- ing, who discovers intelligence and address in influencing his fellow-creatures. Interjections, in so far as they partake of the nature of social discourse, are real imperatives. The imperative influence which mankind, by. means of lan- guage, exert over the thoughts. of one another, is. subject to a variety of modifications, which depend not so much on the di- yersities of their thoughts themselves, as on the different forms of the relative situation in which the speaker stands to the per- son Mio pee Sc aKa —_—_— Oe THEORY OF LANGUAGE.. 405 son addressed. It is by examining these modifications. that we may expect to make the most successful advances in acquiring a philosophical knowledge of the parts of speech. They may be distributed im the following manner : 1. We desire another to perform some voluntary: motion. This gives rise to. Imperatives in their acknowledged form. 2. We direct his attention to objects that are independent of himself. This gives rise to words that designate External Ob- jects; and. to words which connect these with imperatives. Under this head we shall probably be obliged to rank not only substantive and adjective nouns, but -participles, adverbs, pre- positions, and some conjunctions... 3. We direct him to combine and arrange his ideas in a de- - finite manner. This gives rise to those parts of speech which | are: subservient to Affirmation. Lastly, We desire him to give us information. This gives rise to Interrogatives. Perhaps it would be rash: to assert. that the different parts of © speech would be most advantageously treated in the-order now mentioned. It is probable that the analogy subsisting be- twixt the inflections and uses of the imperative and the indica- tive of the verb, would render it advisable to consider them in conjunction. Similar considerations might perhaps justly in- duce us to give the other parts of speech an arrangement near- -er to that which they receive in our common grammars, We shall find, however, that when we trace the prevalent etymolo- gies among éach of those kinds of words which are referred to different parts of speech, the radical importance of the impera- tive of the verb every where appears. This fact: will be illus- trated by a few observations on the progress of etymology. Vor. VIL P. If. 3 | As 406 OBSERVATIONS ON THE As few objects of our knowledge have a natural connection with such sounds as the human voice can imitate, the choice of the respective oral signs appropriated to the expression of our different ideas, is for the most part entirely arbitrary. Hence the origin of the first invented words must have been regulated by such slight and momentary views, that their his- tory was lost before they received an established application. Words strictly original, however, are probably few. The greater part are derived from others previously existing, which receive such modifications as are sufficient to distinguish the various shades of their application. In coining new words, mankind have always a wish to employ materials to which some sort of meaning was previously attached. Under the operation of this law, there is one very extensive: feature of etymology, which we are obliged to Mr Tooxe for pointing out more fully than was done by his predecessors, and which he seems inclined to regard as universal,—that nouns, or the names of objects, are derived from Verbs. To this we may subjoin, that the verbs from which they are derived signi- fy some sort of action, and, as has been shown, exist in the simplest form in the Imperative. This position is illustrated in the Diversions of Purley, by a very copious induction. Mr Tooxe shows that many English nouns, which we had been in the habit of considering as origi- nal words, are derived from verbs. A “ passage” receives its name from the verb “ pass ;” a “ gate” from the verb “ go ;” a « yoad” from the verb “ ride.” “ Spot,” “ spout,” and “ spite,” are from the verb “ spit.” “ Snout” and “ snot” are things “ snited.” “ Head,’ from the verb “ heave,’ means some- thing “ heaved” or elevated above the neighbouring objects to which it is referred. ‘“ Heaven,” from the same verb, means the same thing. A “ flood” is something that has “ flowed.” “ Bread” receives its name from the verb to “ bray” or “ bruise,” THEORY OF LANGUAGE.. 407. “ bruise,’ because it is made of grain’ which, among other- operations, has undergone that of being “ brayed.” A “ joint” is something “ join’d.” The word “ gift” is the same: with * oiv’d” or “ given:” “ thrift” is from.“ thrive,” “ drift” from “ drive,” “ weft” from “ weave.” The “ haft” of a tool is the part “hay’d.” The “ hilt” of a sword, the part “ held.” A “ clock” is an instrument that “ clicks.” “ Doom’ means “ deemed,” from the Saxon verb “ daeman,” to “ deem” or “judge.” “ Brood,” ‘ breed,” brat,” mean something che- rished, from “ bredan” to “ eherish.” ‘ Hand” and “ hint’ are from “ hentan,” to “ take hold of.” “ Fang” and “ finger” from “ fingan” to “ take.” “ Truth” comes from the verb “true,” because it is that which a man “ tru-eth” or “ belie- “-veth.” “ Wealth” is that. which “ weal-eth;’ “ growth” that which “ grow-eth ;” “ birth” that which “ bear-eth ;” “ warmth,” that which-“ warm-eth ;”” “earth” that which a man: “ ear-eth” or “ plougheth.” Nouns derived from Latin verbs are more familiar in their etymology, as, an “ act,” “ aliquid “ act-um,’ a “ debt,” “ aliquid debit-um ;” “ rent,” “ aliquid “ rendit-um ;” “ tribute,” “ aliquid tribut-um ;” “ expense,” “ aliquid expens-um ;” “ merit,” “ aliquid merit-um ;” “ aco. “ cent,” “ aliquid accent-um ;” “ fruit,” “ aliquid fruit-um ;” “ fate,” “ aliquid’fat-um.” Some words of French derivation - are obviously formed on the same principle, as “ alley,” from the ao “ aller” to go; “ view,’ something seen,” from. “vu,” the passive participle of “ voir ;”' destiny,” “ quelque-. “ chose destinée.” As Mr Tooxz seems inclined to maintain that a// nouns are - formed from verbs, and as the induction which he has brought forward is more extensive than his readers were prepared to an- ticipate, some have been struck with an apprehension that this doctrine would prove injurious to some of the most satisfacto-- 3EF 2 ry 408 OBSERVATIONS ON THE ry conclusions that prevail among mankind. Its tendency has appeared to be to shake our belief in the existence of a mate- rial world. Verbs have been considered as mere expressions of certain temporary modifications to which matter is liable, and therefore a subordinate class of words compared to the names of substantial beings. It has been thought a degrada- tion of the truths received by the testimony of our senses, to suppose that permanent objects should derive their names from words of so fugitive a character as verbs, which represent mere events, or phenomena that disappear the moment after they are presented. This apprehension will vanish if we attend to the distinction betwixt the early history of thought and the early history of language. Our first ideas are acquired, and extensively combined, long before we express them. The first words of which language consists represent, in the form of compendious signs, assemblages of ideas, or features of these assemblages, mutually understood among men. The etymo- logy of each derivative word depends on the motives which di- rect us to select those definite assemblages to which it will be useful to assign names. Accordingly, we find that the volun- tary motions of mankind, which have already been considered as the earliest objects that suggest the use of language, and which are first used in the form of Imperatives, have a predo- minant influence in regulating the interest which we take in directing the attention of those around us to other cbjects, and in contriving names to represent them. Let us take for an example the word “ road.” The surface of the earth presents us with one continued series of colours and tangibilities which we call the qualities of matter. We wish to direct the atten- tion of another to a part of this scene, which has the form of a lengthened stripe, differing somewhat in appearance from the adjoining parts; and we know that the difference which we observe die amas THEORY OF LANGUAGE. 409 observe is produced by the action of travelling, or is made for promoting the conyenience of this voluntary motion. The ma- terials of which it is composed do not radically differ from those which compose the parts in its immediate vicinity, and the same sensations are communicated by the ultimate parti- cles of each. But the characteristic mode of assemblage which they exhibit, suggests the idea of the cause which has produ- ced it, or the purpose to which it is subservient. Hence we derive its name from the action of travelling or riding. This is the origin of the word “ road.” It signifies a place which has been “ rode” upon. On the same principle, an uninhabi- ted country is called a “ desert,” because it is “ desert-um,” a place forsaken or avoided by men.